Samsung Centralized Workflow Solution Scx 6545n User Manual

SCX-6545N Series  
Multi Functional Printer  
User’s Guide  
imagine the possibilities  
Thank you for purchasing a Samsung product.  
FEATURES BY MODELS  
The machine is designed to support all of your document needs – from printing and copying, to more advanced networking solutions for your business.  
Basic features of this machine include;  
FEATURES  
SCX-6545N  
 
USB 2.0  
USB Memory  
 
 
 
 
 
O
DADF (Duplex Automatic Document Feeder)  
Hard Disk  
Network Interface Enthernet 10/100/1000 Base TX wired LAN  
Duplex (2-sided) printing  
FAX  
O
Stacker & Stapler (Finisher)  
Stand  
O
( : Included, O: Optional, Blank: Not Available)  
ABOUT THIS USER’S GUIDE  
This user’s guide provides information about basic understanding of the machine as well as detailed explanation on each step during the actual usage. Both novice  
users and professional users can refer to this guide for installing and using the machine.  
Some terms in this guide are used interchangeably, as below:  
Document is synonymous with original.  
Paper is synonymous with media, or print media.  
The following table offers the conventions of this guide.  
CONVENTION  
DESCRIPTION  
EXAMPLE  
Bold  
Note  
Used for texts on the display or actual prints on the machine.  
Start  
Used to provide additional information or detailed specification of the machine  
function and feature.  
.The date format may differ from  
country to country  
Caution  
>
Used to give users information to protect the machine from possible mechanical  
damage or malfunction.  
Do not touch the green underside of  
the print cartridge.  
Used to show the steps of selecting or pressing items in order.  
The example means; press Copy from the Main screen, press the Advanced tab,  
and then press Clone Copy.  
Copy > the Advanced tab > Clone Copy  
Footnote  
Used to provide more detailed information on certain words or a phrase.  
a. pages per minute  
(See page 1 for more  
information)  
Used to guide users to the reference page for the additional detailed information.  
(See page1 for more information)  
2
FINDING MORE INFORMATION  
You can find information for setting up and using your machine from the following resources, either as a print-out or onscreen.  
Quick Install Guide  
Provides information on setting up your machine and this requires that you follow the instructions in the guide to prepare the machine.  
Online User’s Guide  
Provides you with step-by-step instructions for using your machine’s full features, and contains information for maintaining your  
machine, troubleshooting, and installing accessories.  
This user’s guide also contains Software section to provide you with information on how to print documents with your machine in  
various operating systems, and how to use the included software utilities.  
Network Website  
Printer Driver Help  
You can set the network environment from your computer using network-managing programs, such as SetIP, SyncThru™ Web Admin  
Service, AnyWeb Print etc. SyncThru™ Web Admin Service will be convenient for network administrators who need to manage many  
machines simultaneously. AnyWeb Print helps personal users to screen-capture the website screen in Windows Internet Explorer  
easily. You can download the SyncThru™ Web Admin Service or AnyWeb Print on http://solution.samsungprinter.com. SetIP program  
is provided in the software CD.  
Provides you with help information on printer driver properties and instructions for setting up the properties for printing. To access a  
printer driver help screen, click Help from the printer properties dialog box.  
Samsung website  
If you have Internet access, you can get help, support, printer drivers, manuals, and order information from the Samsung website,  
3
safety information  
IMPORTANT SAFETY SYMBOLS AND PRECAUTIONS  
What the icons and signs in this user manual mean:  
Hazards or unsafe practices that may result in severe personal injury or death.  
WARNING  
CAUTION  
CAUTION  
Hazards or unsafe practices that may result in minor personal injury or property damage.  
To reduce the risk of fire, explosion, electric shock, or personal injury when using your laser MFP, follow these basic safety  
precautions:  
Do NOT attempt.  
Do NOT disassemble.YTU  
Do NOT touch.  
Follow directions explicitly.  
Unplug the power plug from the wall socket.  
Make sure the MFP is grounded to prevent electric shock.  
Call the service center for help.  
These warning signs are here to prevent injury to you and others.  
Please follow them explicitly.  
After reading this section, keep it in a safe place for future reference.  
1. Read and understand all instructions.  
2. Use common sense whenever operating electrical appliances.  
3. Follow all warnings and instructions marked on the machine and in the literature accompanying the machine.  
4. If an operating instruction appears to conflict with safety information, heed the safety information. You may have misunderstood the  
operating instruction. If you cannot resolve the conflict, contact your sales or service representative for assistance.  
5. Unplug the machine from the AC wall socket and/or telephone jack before cleaning. Do not use liquid or aerosol cleaners. Use only  
a damp cloth for cleaning.  
6. Do not place the machine on an unstable cart, stand or table. It may fall, causing serious damage.  
7. Your machine should never be placed on, near or over a radiator, heater, air conditioner or ventilation duct.  
8. Do not allow anything to rest on the power. Do not locate your machine where the cords will be abused by persons walking on them.  
9. Do not overload wall outlets and extension cords. This can diminish performance, and may result in the risk of fire or electric shock.  
10. Do not allow pets to chew on the AC power, telephone or PC interface cords.  
11. Never push objects of any kind into the machine through case or cabinet openings. They may touch dangerous voltage points,  
creating a risk of fire or shock. Never spill liquid of any kind onto or into the machine.  
12. To reduce the risk of electric shock, do not disassemble the machine. Take it to a qualified service technician when repair work is  
required. Opening or removing covers may expose you to dangerous voltages or other risks. Incorrect reassembly could cause  
electric shock when the unit is subsequently used.  
4
 
13. Unplug the machine from the telephone jack, PC and AC wall outlet and refer servicing to qualified service personnel under the  
following conditions:  
When any part of the power cord, plug or connecting cable is damaged or frayed.  
If liquid has been spilled into the machine.  
If the machine has been exposed to rain or water.  
If the machine does not operate properly after instructions have been followed.  
If the machine has been dropped, or the cabinet appears damaged.  
If the machine exhibits a sudden and distinct change in performance.  
14. Adjust only those controls covered by the operating instructions. Improper adjustment of other controls may result in damage, and  
may require extensive work by a qualified service technician to restore the machine to normal operation.  
15. Avoid using this machine during a lightning storm. There may be a remote risk of electric shock from lightning. If possible, unplug the  
AC power and telephone cord for the duration of the lightning storm.  
16. The Power cord supplied with your machine should be used for safe operation. If you are using a cord which is longer than 2 m with  
a
110 V machine, then it should be 16 AWG or bigger.  
*
17. Use only No.26 AWG or larger telephone line cord.  
18. SAVE THESE INSTRUCTIONS  
19. This machine can be operated only in the country you have purchased. (Due to different voltage, frequency, telecommunication  
configuration and etc.)  
a.AWG: American Wire Gauge  
LASER SAFETY STATEMENT  
The printer is certified in the U.S. to conform to the requirements of DHHS 21 CFR, chapter 1 Subchapter J for Class I(1) laser products, and  
elsewhere is certified as a Class I laser product conforming to the requirements of IEC 825.  
Class I laser products are not considered to be hazardous. The laser system and printer are designed so there is never any human access to  
laser radiation above a Class I level during normal operation, user maintenance or prescribed service condition.  
WARNING  
Never operate or service the printer with the protective cover removed from Laser/Scanner assembly. The reflected beam, although invisible,  
can damage your eyes.  
When using this product, these basic safety precautions should always be followed to reduce risk of fire, electric shock, and injury to persons:  
5
OZONE SAFETY  
During normal operation, this machine produces ozone. The ozone produced does not present a hazard to the operator. However, it is  
advisable that the machine be operated in a well ventilated area.  
If you need additional information about ozone, request your nearest Samsung dealer.  
MERCURY SAFETY  
Contains Mercury, Dispose According to Local, State or Federal Laws.(U.S.A. only)  
PERCHLORATE WARNING  
This Perchlorate warning applies only to primary CR (Manganese Dioxide) Lithium coin cells in the product sold or distributed ONLY in California  
USA.  
Perchlorate Material - special handling may apply.  
POWER SAVER  
This printer contains advanced energy conservation technology that reduces power consumption when it is not in active use.  
When the printer does not receive data for an extended period of time, power consumption is automatically lowered.  
ENERGY STAR and the ENERGY STAR mark are registered U.S. marks.  
RECYCLING  
Please recycle or dispose of the packaging material for this product in an environmentally responsible manner.  
CORRECT DISPOSAL OF THIS PRODUCT (WASTE ELECTRICAL & ELECTRONIC EQUIPMENT)  
(Applicable in the European Union and other European countries with separate collection systems)  
This marking shown on the product or its literature, indicates that it should not be disposed with other household wastes at the end of its  
working life. To prevent possible harm to the environment or human health from uncontrolled waste disposal, please separate this from other  
types of wastes and recycle it responsibly to promote the sustainable reuse of material resources.  
Household users should contact either the retailer where they purchased this product, or their local government office, for details of where and  
how they can take this item for environmentally safe recycling.  
Business users should contact their supplier and check the terms and conditions of the purchase contract. This product should not be mixed  
with other commercial wastes for disposal.  
6
CORRECT DISPOSAL OF BATTERIES IN THIS PRODUCT  
(Applicable in the European Union and other European countries with separate battery return systems.)  
This marking on the battery, manual or packaging indicates that the batteries in this product should not be disposed with other household  
waste at the end of their working life. Where marked, the chemical symbols Hg, Cd or Pb indicate that the battery contains mercury, cadmium  
or lead above the reference levels in EC Directive 2006/66. If batteries are not properly disposed of, these substances can cause harm to  
human health or the environment.  
To protect natural resources and to promote material reuse, please separate batteries from other types of waste and recycle them through  
your local, free battery return system.  
RADIO FREQUENCY EMISSIONS  
FCC Information to the User  
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:  
This device may not cause harmful interference, and  
This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.  
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class A digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These  
limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses  
and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference to  
radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause  
harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to  
try to correct the interference by one or more of the following measures:  
Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.  
Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.  
Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is connected.  
Consult the dealer or experienced radio TV technician for help.  
Change or modifications not expressly approved by the manufacturer responsible for compliance could void the user's authority to oper-  
ate the equipment.  
Canadian Radio Interference Regulations  
This digital apparatus does not exceed the Class A limits for radio noise emissions from digital apparatus as set out in the interference-causing  
equipment standard entitled “Digital Apparatus”, ICES-003 of the Industry and Science Canada.  
Cet appareil numérique respecte les limites de bruits radioélectriques applicables aux appareils numériques de Classe A prescrites dans la  
norme sur le matériel brouilleur: “Appareils Numériques”, ICES-003 édictée par l’Industrie et Sciences Canada.  
FAX BRANDING  
The Telephone Consumer Protection Act of 1991 makes it unlawful for any person to use a computer or other electronic device to send any  
message via a telephone facsimile machine unless such message clearly contains in a margin at the top or bottom of each transmitted page or  
on the first page of the transmission the following information:  
(1) the date and time of transmission  
(2) identification of either business, business entity or individual sending the message; and  
(3) telephone number of either the sending machine, business, business entity or individual.  
The Telephone Company may make changes in its communications facilities, equipment operations or procedures where such action is  
reasonably required in the operation of its business and is not inconsistent with the rules and regulations in FCC Part 68. If such changes can  
be reasonably expected to render any customer terminal equipment incompatible with telephone company communications facilities, or  
require modification or alteration of such terminal equipment, or otherwise materially affect its use or performance, the customer shall be given  
adequate notice in writing, to allow the customer an opportunity to maintain uninterrupted service  
7
RINGER EQUIVALENCE NUMBER  
The Ringer Equivalence Number and FCC Registration Number for this machine may be found on the label located on the bottom or rear of  
the machine. In some instances you may need to provide these numbers to the telephone company.  
The Ringer Equivalence Number (REN) is a measure of the electrical load placed on the telephone line, and is useful for determining whether  
you have “overloaded” the line. Installing several types of equipment on the same telephone line may result in problems making and receiving  
telephone calls, especially ringing when your line is called. The sum of all Ringer Equivalence Numbers of the equipment on your telephone  
line should be less than five in order to assure proper service from the telephone company. In some cases, a sum of five may not be usable on  
your line. If any of your telephone equipment is not operating properly, you should immediately remove it from your telephone line, as it may  
cause harm to the telephone network.  
The equipment complies with Part 68 of the FCC rules and the requirements adopted by the ACTA. On the rear of this equipment is a label  
that contains, among other information, a product identifier in the format US:AAAEQ##TXXXX. If requested, this number must be provided to  
the telephone company.  
FCC Regulations state that changes or modifications to this equipment not expressly approved by the manufacturer could void the  
user’s authority to operate this equipment. In the event that terminal equipment causes harm to the telephone network, the telephone  
company should notify the customer that service may be stopped. However, where prior notice is impractical, the company may  
temporarily cease service, providing that they:  
a) promptly notify the customer.  
b) give the customer an opportunity to correct the equipment problem.  
c) inform the customer of the right to bring a complaint to the Federal Communication Commission pursuant to procedures set out in  
FCC Rules and Regulations Subpart E of Part 68.  
You should also know that:  
Your machine is not designed to be connected to a digital PBX system.  
If you intend to use a computer modem or fax modem on the same phone line as your machine, you may experience transmission and  
reception problems with all the equipment. It is recommended that no other equipment, except for a regular telephone, share the line with  
your machine.  
If your area experiences a high incidence of lightning or power surges, we recommend that you install surge protectors for both the power  
and the telephone lines. Surge protectors can be purchased from your dealer or telephone and electronic specialty stores.  
When programming emergency numbers and/or making test calls to emergency numbers, use a non-emergency number to advise the  
emergency service dispatcher of your intentions. The dispatcher will give you further instructions on how to actually test the emergency  
number.  
This machine may not be used on coin service or party lines.  
This machine provides magnetic coupling to hearing aids.  
You may safely connect this equipment to the telephone network by means of a standard modular jack, USOC RJ-11C.  
REPLACING THE FITTED PLUG (FOR UK ONLY)  
Important  
The mains lead for this machine is fitted with a standard (BS 1363) 13 amp plug and has a 13 amp fuse. When you change or examine the  
fuse, you must re-fit the correct 13 amp fuse. You then need to replace the fuse cover. If you have lost the fuse cover, do not use the plug until  
you have another fuse cover.  
Please contact the people from you purchased the machine.  
The 13 amp plug is the most widely used type in the UK and should be suitable. However, some buildings (mainly old ones) do not have  
normal 13 amp plug sockets. You need to buy a suitable plug adaptor. Do not remove the moulded plug.  
If you cut off the moulded plug, get rid of it straight away.  
You cannot rewire the plug and you may receive an electric shock if you plug it into a socket.  
Important warning:  
You must earth this machine.  
The wires in the mains lead have the following color code:  
Green and Yellow: Earth  
Blue: Neutral  
8
Brown: Live  
If the wires in the mains lead do not match the colors marked in your plug, do the following:  
You must connect the green and yellow wire to the pin marked by the letter “E” or by the safety ‘Earth symbol’ or colored green and yellow or  
green.  
You must connect the blue wire to the pin which is marked with the letter “N” or colored black.  
You must connect the brown wire to the pin which is marked with the letter “L” or colored red.  
You must have a 13 amp fuse in the plug, adaptor, or at the distribution board.  
DECLARATION OF CONFORMITY (EUROPEAN COUNTRIES)  
Approvals and Certifications  
The CE marking applied to this product symbolizes Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. Declaration of Conformity with the following applicable 93/  
68/EEC Directives of the European Union as of the dates indicated:  
The declaration of conformity may be consulted at www.samsung.com/printer, go to Support > Download center and enter your printer name  
January 1, 1995: Council Directive 2006/95/EC Approximation of the laws of the member states related to low voltage equipment.  
January 1, 1996: Council Directive 2004/108/EC (92/31/EEC), approximation of the laws of the Member States related to electromagnetic  
compatibility.  
March 9, 1999: Council Directive 1999/5/EC on radio equipment and telecommunications terminal equipment and the mutual recognition of  
their conformity. A full declaration, defining the relevant Directives and referenced standards can be obtained from your Samsung Electronics  
Co., Ltd. representative.  
EC Certification  
Certification to 1999/5/EC Radio Equipment & Telecommunications Terminal Equipment Directive (FAX)  
This Samsung product has been self-certified by Samsung for pan-European single terminal connection to the analogue public switched  
telephone network (PSTN) in accordance with Directive 1999/5/EC. The product has been designed to work with the national PSTNs and  
compatible PBXs of the European countries:  
In the event of problems, you should contact the Euro QA Lab of Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. in the first instance.  
The product has been tested against TBR21. To assist in the use and application of terminal equipment which complies with this standard, the  
European Telecommunication Standards Institute (ETSI) has issued an advisory document (EG 201 121) which contains notes and additional  
requirements to ensure network compatibility of TBR21 terminals. The product has been designed against, and is fully compliant with, all of the  
relevant advisory notes contained in this document.  
OPENSSL LICENSE  
Copyright (c) 1998-2001 The OpenSSL Project. All rights reserved.  
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:  
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.  
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the  
documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.  
3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must display the following acknowledgment: "This product includes  
software developed by the OpenSSL Project for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit. (http://www.openssl.org/)"  
4. The names "OpenSSL Toolkit" and "OpenSSL Project" must not be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software  
without  
5. prior written permission. For written permission, please contact [email protected].  
6. Products derived from this software may not be called "OpenSSL" nor may "OpenSSL" appear in their names without prior written  
permission of the OpenSSL Project.  
7. Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following acknowledgment: "This product includes software developed by the  
OpenSSL Project for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit (http://www.openssl.org/)"  
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE OpenSSL PROJECT ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT  
NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN  
NO EVENT SHALL THE OpenSSL PROJECT OR ITS CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,  
EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR  
9
SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY,  
WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE  
USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.  
This product includes cryptographic software written by Eric Young([email protected]). This product includes software written by Tim  
Hudson ([email protected]).  
ORIGINAL SSLEAY LICENSE  
Copyright (C) 1995-1998 Eric Young ([email protected]) All rights reserved.  
This package is an SSL implementation written by Eric Young ([email protected]). The implementation was written so as to conform with  
Netscapes SSL.  
This library is free for commercial and non-commercial use as long as the following conditions are aheared to. The following conditions apply  
to all code found in this distribution, be it the RC4, RSA, lhash, DES, etc., code; not just the SSL code. The SSL documentation included with  
this distribution is covered by the same copyright terms except that the holder is Tim Hudson ([email protected]). Copyright remains Eric  
Young's, and as such any Copyright notices in the code are not to be removed. If this package is used in a product, Eric Young should be  
given attribution as the author of the parts of the library used. This can be in the form of a textual message at program startup or in  
documentation (online or textual) provided with the package.  
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:  
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.  
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the  
documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.  
3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must display the following acknowledgement: "This product includes  
cryptographic software written by Eric Young ([email protected])" The word 'cryptographic' can be left out if the rouines from the library  
being used are not cryptographic related:-).  
4. If you include any Windows specific code (or a derivative thereof) from the apps directory (application code) you must include an  
acknowledgement: "This product includes software written by Tim Hudson ([email protected])"  
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY ERIC YOUNG ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED  
TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT  
SHALL THE AUTHOR OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR  
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE,  
DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT,  
STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE,  
EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.  
The licence and distribution terms for any publically available version or derivative of this code cannot be changed. i.e. this code cannot simply  
be copied and put under another distribution licence [including the GNU Public Licence.]  
10  
contents  
Machine Setup button  
Job Status button  
Power Saver button  
Interrupt button  
Machine Setup button  
Job Status button  
25  
11  
contents  
Basic tab  
Advanced tab  
Image tab  
Basic tab  
Advanced tab  
Image tab  
Output tab  
Set Scan Button tab  
Change Port tab  
57 Duplex  
12  
contents  
Resolution  
Original Size  
Original Type  
Color Mode  
Darkness  
Erase Background  
Scan to Edge  
Quality  
File Format  
PDF Encryption  
Scan Preset  
60  
61 Basic tab  
62 Advanced tab  
62 Image tab  
Sending a fax manually (On Hook Dial)  
Duplex  
Resolution  
Original Type  
Darkness  
Color Mode  
Setting up a fax phonebook using SyncThru™ Web Service  
68 Using Mailbox  
68 Creating Mailbox  
13  
contents  
72  
73 Scan to USB  
Basic tab  
Advanced tab  
Image tab  
Output tab  
Duplex  
Resolution  
Original Size  
Original Type  
Color Mode  
Darkness  
Erase Background  
Scan to Edge  
Quality  
Scan Preset  
File Format  
File Policy  
14  
contents  
80 Understanding the Standard Workflow Screen  
80  
Machine Status screen  
Admin Setting screen  
83  
86 Copy Setup  
86 Fax Setup  
88 Security  
Access Control  
Log  
Change Admin. Password  
Information Hiding  
91 Optional Service  
92 Document Box Management  
92 Standard Workflow Management  
94  
To access SyncThru™ Web Service:  
15  
contents  
Samsung Scan Manager Problem  
121  
123  
16  
contents  
132  
17  
introduction  
These are the main components of your machine:  
This chapter includes  
z
PRINTER OVERVIEW  
Front view  
DADF document output tray  
scanner lid  
toner cartridge  
imaging unit  
8
9
18  
19  
Control panel  
10  
a.The symbol a is a mark for the optional device.  
Rear view  
Extension telephone socket  
(EXT)a  
USB memory port  
1
7
Telephone line socket  
(LINE)a  
Power switch  
2
3
4
8
9
DADF document width  
Side cover  
1
11  
guides  
USB port  
Power receptacle  
DADF cover  
Output support  
Tray 1  
Multi-purpose tray  
Front cover  
2
3
12  
13  
network port  
Finisher output tray  
(Stacker & Stapler)a  
10  
dummy for FDI (Foreign  
Device Interfacea)  
finisher cover (Stacker &  
Stapler)a  
Multi-purpose tray  
extension  
5
6
11  
12  
4
5
14  
15  
Optional traya  
Multi-purpose tray paper  
width guides  
finisher (Stacker & Stapler)a  
15-pin Finisher connection  
(Stacker & Stapler)a  
Standa  
Scanner lock switch  
Scanner glass  
6
7
16  
17  
a.The symbol a is a mark for the optional device.  
DADF document input tray  
Introduction_ 18  
                                         
CONTROL PANEL OVERVIEW  
Leads you to the machine setup and advanced  
Machine Setup  
Job Status  
Status  
1
2
3
Shows the jobs currently running, queued jobs or  
completed jobs.  
Shows the status of your machine. (See  
Displays the current machine status and prompts  
during an operation. You can set menus easily  
using the touch screen.  
Display screen  
4
Dials fax number, and enters the number value  
for document copies or other options.  
number keypad  
Clear  
5
6
7
Deletes characters in the edit area.  
In standby mode, redials the last number, or in  
edit mode, inserts a pause into a fax number.  
Redial/Pause  
Engages the telephone line.  
On Hook Dial  
Interrupt  
8
9
Stops a job in process to do an urgent copy job.  
Reverts the current settings to the default values.  
Clear All  
10  
Sends the machine into the power saver mode.  
Power Saver  
11  
Stops an operation at any time. The pop up  
window appears on the screen showing the  
current job that the user can stop or resume.  
Stop  
Start  
12  
13  
Starts a job.  
All illustrations on this user’s guide may differ from your machine  
depending on its options or models.  
When you use the touch screen, use your finger only. The screen  
may be damaged with a sharpen pen or else.  
19 _Introduction  
   
INTRODUCING THE TOUCH SCREEN AND  
USEFUL BUTTONS  
: This button allows you to move to Copy, Fax, Scan,  
Document Box menu directly.  
Machine Status: Shows the current status of the machine.  
Admin Setting: Allows an administrator to set up the machine.  
Tray Management: Shows the currently installed tray and their  
status. You can also change the paper settings for each tray.  
Usage Page Report: You can print the report on the amount of  
printouts depending on the paper size and type.  
Touch screen  
The touch screen allows for user-friendly operation of the machine. Once  
you press the home icon (  
) on the screen, it shows the Main screen.  
Job Status button  
When you press this button, the screen shows the lists of currently running  
jobs, queued jobs and completed jobs.  
:
Shows Help. You can find the explanation by feature  
contents.  
Copy: Enters the Copy menu.  
Fax: Enters the Fax menu. (Optional)  
Scan: Enters Scan to Email, Scan to PC, Scan to Server menu.  
Document Box: Enters the Document Box menu. (See "Checking  
Current Job tab: Shows the list of jobs in progress and pending.  
Completed Job tab: Provides the list of completed jobs.  
Active Notice tab: Displays any error codes that have occurred.  
No.: Gives the order of jobs. The job in No. 001 is currently in  
progress.  
Job Name: Shows job information like name and type.  
Status: Gives the current status of each job.  
User:Provides user name, mainly computer name.  
Job Type: Displays details of the active job, such as job type,  
recipient phone number and other information.  
Delete: Removes the selected job from the list.  
Delete All: Removes all the jobs from the list.  
Detail: Shows the detailed information of the selected option on the  
Active Notice list.  
USB: When USB memory is inserted into the USB memory port on  
your machine, USB icon shows on the display screen.  
Logout: Logs out from the currently logged in account.  
Toner Info.: Shows amount of toner used.  
LCD Brightness: Adjusts the brightness of the touch screen.  
: To change the language that appears on the display.  
USB: guides you to remove the USB memory devices from the  
machine. Follow the instruction on the LCD. This icon appears only  
when you connect an USB memory module.  
Icons shown on the display screen such as Fax may be grayed  
out, depending on the optional kit or program installed in your  
machine.  
To switch the display screen and see other available icons, press  
the right arrow on the display screen.  
Close: Closes the job status window and switches to previous view.  
Power Saver button  
When the machine is not in use, save electricity with the provided power  
save mode. Pressing this button puts the machine into power save mode.  
Machine Setup button  
When you press this button, you can browse current machine settings or  
If you press this button for more than two seconds, a window appears,  
requesting that you turn the power off. If you choose Yes, the power is  
turned off. This button can also be used to turn the button on.  
STATUS  
DESCRIPTION  
Off  
The machine is not in the power save mode.  
The machine is in the low power save mode.  
The machine is in the power save mode.  
Blue  
On  
Blink  
Introduction_ 20  
           
Interrupt button  
When you press this button, the machine goes into interrupt mode which  
means it stops a printing job for urgent copy job. When the urgent copy job  
completes, the previous printing job continues.  
Check the message on the display screen, and follow the instruction  
on the message or refer to Troubleshooting part. See  
"Troubleshooting" on page 100. If the problem persists, call for  
service.  
STATUS  
DESCRIPTION  
Off  
The machine is not in interrupt printing mode.  
The machine is in interrupt printing mode.  
Blue  
On  
Interrupt mode is resumed at default value (Off) after the machine is  
shut down or reset.  
UNDERSTANDING THE STATUS LED  
When the problem occurs, the Status LED indicates the machine's  
condition by the light color of it's action.  
STATUS  
DESCRIPTION  
The machine is off-line.  
The machine is in power save mode. When  
data is received, or any button is pressed, it  
switches to on-line automatically.  
Off  
Green Blinking  
When the backlight slowly blinks, the machine  
is receiving data from the computer.  
When the backlight blinks rapidly, the  
machine is printing data.  
The machine is on-line and can be used.  
On  
Blinking  
Red  
A minor error has occurred and the machine is  
waiting the error to be cleared. Check the  
display message. When the problem is  
cleared, the machine resumes.  
The toner cartridge is low. Order a new toner  
cartridge. You can temporarily improve print  
quality by redistributing the toner. (See  
On  
The imaging unit is totally out of lifespan.  
Remove the old imaging unit and install a new  
The toner cartridge is totally empty. Remove  
the old toner cartridge and install a new one.  
The cover is opened. Close the cover.  
There is no paper in the tray. Load paper in  
the tray.  
The machine has stopped due to a major  
error. Check the display message. (See  
21 _Introduction  
       
MENU OVERVIEW  
The control panel provides access to various menus to set up the machine or use the machine's functions. These menus can be accessed by pressing Machine  
Setup, Job Status, or touching menus on the display screen. Refer to the following diagram.  
Main screen  
The Main screen is shown on the display screen on the control panel. Some menus are grayed out depending on your model.  
.
Copy  
Copy (Continued)  
Fax  
Scan  
Scan to Email  
Document Box  
Basic tab (Page 41)  
Original Size  
Reduce/Enlarge  
Duplex  
Image tab (Page 42)  
Erase Edge  
Basic tab (Page 61)  
Address  
User Box tab (Page 94)  
Basic tab (Page 51)  
Advanced tab  
(Page 52)  
Add  
Delete  
Edit  
Erase Background  
Margin Shift  
Duplex  
Resolution  
Output  
Original Type  
Darkness  
Image tab (Page 52)  
Output tab (Page 52)  
Scan to PC  
Detail  
Search  
Enter  
Advanced tab (Page 62)  
Original Size  
Delay Send  
Paper Supply  
Advanced tab (Page 41)  
ID Copy  
Priority Send  
Polling  
Mailbox  
Scan to Server  
Basic tab (Page 51)  
Advanced tab  
System Box tab  
(Page 94)  
Detail  
Enter  
N-Up  
(Page 52)  
Image tab (Page 52)  
Output tab (Page 52)  
Image tab (Page 62)  
Original Type  
Darkness  
Poster Copy  
Clone Copy  
Book Copy  
Booklet  
USB  
Erase Background  
Color Mode  
USB Format  
USB Print  
Scan to USB  
Basic tab  
Covers  
Transparencies  
WaterMark  
Overlay  
Advanced tab  
Image tab  
Output tab  
Auto Crop  
Machine Setup button  
When you press the Machine Setup button on the control panel, the screen displays three menus. Machine Status shows the supplies life, billing, counters and  
reports. Admin Setting lets you set the advanced setup to use your machine in depth and conveniently. Usage Page Report can print the report on the amount of  
printouts depending on the paper size and type.  
Machine Status  
.
Supplies Life tab  
(Page 83)  
Toner Cartridge  
Imaging Unit  
Machine Info tab  
(Page 83)  
Machine Details  
Customer Support  
Machine Serial  
Number  
Machine Info tab  
(Continued)  
Machine Info tab  
(Continued)  
Machine Info tab  
(Continued)  
Black Copied 2-Sided  
Sheets  
Printed 2 Sided Sheets  
Black Printed 2-Sided  
Sheets  
Analog Fax Sheets  
Analog Fax 2-Sided  
Sheets  
Fax Image Received  
Analog Fax Images  
Sent  
Analog Fax Images  
Received  
Images Sent  
Network Scanning  
Images Sent  
Email Images Sent  
Maintenance  
Impressions  
Black Maintenance  
Impressions  
Usage Counters  
Total Impressions  
Black Impressions  
Black Copied  
Impressions  
Black Printed  
Impressions  
Fuser Kit  
Feed Roller Kit  
Feed Roller Kit - Bypass  
Tray  
Document Feeder Roller  
BTR Kit  
IP Address  
Hardware Options  
Configuration  
Software Versions  
Tray Status  
Tray  
Sheets  
Copied Sheets  
Black Copied Sheets  
Printed Sheets  
Black Printed Sheets  
2 Sided Sheets  
Copied 2 Sided  
Sheets  
DADF Friction Pad Kit  
Status  
Paper Size  
Paper Type  
Print/Report  
System Report  
Scan Report  
Fax Report  
Introduction_ 22  
     
Admin Setting  
.
General tab  
Setup tab  
(Page 86)  
Print/Report tab  
(Page 84)  
(Page 93)  
Device Info  
Date & Time  
Default Settings  
Measurement  
Timers  
Language  
Power Saver  
Tray Management  
Altitude Adjustment  
Output Option  
Contention Management  
Sound  
Copy Setup  
Fax Setup  
Network Setup  
Security  
Optional Service  
Document Box  
Management  
Standard Workflow  
Management  
Print  
Accounting Reports  
Report  
Supplies Management  
Machine Test  
Manual Image Overwrite  
HDD Spooling  
Stored Job File Policy  
Country  
Home Window  
Background  
Multi-Bin  
Stamp  
Usage Page Report  
When the display “Are you sure you want to print it?” shows, press “Yes”.  
Job Status button  
This menu shows the job in process, in waiting, in completed and the notice message such as an error. (See "Job Status button" on page 20.)  
.
Current Job tab  
Detail  
Completed Job tab  
Detail  
Active Notice tab  
Detail  
Delete  
Delete All  
23 _Introduction  
 
SUPPLIED SOFTWARE  
PRINTER DRIVER FEATURES  
After you have set up your machine and connected it to your computer, you  
must install the printer software. If you are a Windows or Macintosh OS,  
download the software from the Samsung website (www.samsung.com/  
printer) and install.  
Your printer drivers support the following standard features:  
Paper orientation, size, source and media type selection  
Number of copies  
In addition, you can use various special printing features. The following  
table shows a general overview of features supported by your printer  
drivers:  
OS  
Windows  
CONTENTS  
Printer driver  
Printer driver: Use this driver to take full  
advantage of your printer’s features.  
Postscript printer driver: Use the PostScript  
driver to print documents with complex fonts and  
graphics in the PS language.  
PCL 6  
POSTSCRIPT  
FEATURE  
WINDOWS  
WINDOWS  
LINUX  
O
MACINTOSH  
Scanner driver: TWAIN and Windows Image  
Acquisition (WIA) drivers are available for  
scanning documents on your machine.  
Smart Panel: This program allows you to monitor  
the machine’s status and alerts you when an error  
occurs during printing.  
Toner save  
O
O
O
O
O
O
Machine quality  
option  
O
Poster printing  
O
O
X
X
X
SmarThru Officea: This is the accompanying  
Windows-based software for your multifunctional  
machine.  
Multiple pages  
per sheet (N-up)  
O
O (2, 4)  
O
Samsung Scan Manager: This program allows you  
to scan a document on your machine and save it to  
a network-connected computer.  
Fit to page  
printing  
O
O
O
O
Direct Printing Utility: This program allows you  
to print PDF files directly.  
Samsung Network PC Fax: This program allows  
you to send a fax from you computer.  
SetIP: Use this program to set your machine’s TCP/  
IP addresses. You can only use IPv4 setting for  
SetIP.  
Scale printing  
O
O
O
X
O
X
O
O
Different source  
for first page  
Watermark  
Overlay  
O
O
O
X
X
O
X
X
O
X
X
O
Linux  
Postscript Printer Description (PPD) file: Use  
this file to run your machine from a Linux  
computer and print documents.  
Duplexa  
SANE: Use this driver to scan documents.  
Smart Panel: This program allows you to monitor  
the machine’s status and alerts you when an error  
occurs during printing.  
SetIP: Use this program to set your machine’s TCP/  
IP addresses. You can only use IPv4 setting for  
SetIP.  
Secu Print  
Scheduled Print  
Spool Print  
Proof Print  
Stapler  
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
X
X
X
X
O
O
O
O
X
O
Macintosh  
Postscript Printer Description (PPD) file: Use  
this file to run your machine from a Macintosh  
computer and print documents.  
a.The machine with Duplex feature prints both side of a paper.  
Scanner driver: TWAIN driver is available for  
scanning documents on your machine.  
Smart Panel: This program allows you to monitor  
the machine’s status and alerts you when an error  
occurs during printing.  
SetIP: Use this program to set your machine’s TCP/  
IP addresses. You can only use IPv4 setting for  
SetIP.  
a.Allows you to edit a scanned image in many ways using a powerful  
image editor and to send the image by email. You can also open  
another image editor program, like Adobe Photoshop, from SmarThru.  
For details, please refer to the onscreen help supplied on the SmarThru  
program.  
Introduction_ 24  
     
getting started  
This chapter gives you step-by-step instructions for setting up the machine.  
This chapter includes:  
3. Remove the tape holding the machine tightly.  
4. Install both the print cartridge and imaging unit.  
6. Make sure that all the cables are connected to the machine.  
7. Turn the machine on.  
SETTING UP THE HARDWARE  
This section shows the steps to set up the hardware which is explained in  
the Quick Install Guide. Make sure you read Quick Install Guide and  
complete following steps.  
1. Select a stable location.  
Select a level, stable place with adequate space for air circulation. Allow  
extra space to open covers and trays.  
The area should be well-ventilated and away from direct sunlight or  
sources of heat, cold, and humidity. Do not set the machine close to the  
edge of your desk or table.  
This equipment will be inoperable when mains power fails.  
When you move the machine, do not tilt or turn it upside down.  
Otherwise, the inside of the machine may be contaminated by  
toner, which can cause damage to the machine or bad printing  
quality.  
If you are moving the machine or if machine is not in use for a long  
time, turn on the power and wait until it goes in to the ready mode.  
Then close the scan lid and turn the power off. And open the scan  
lid and lock the scanner lock.  
SETTING UP THE NETWORK  
You need to set up the network protocols on the machine to use it as your  
network printer. You can set up the basic network settings with the  
machine's touch screen.  
If you want to use the USB cable, connect the cable between a  
computer and you machine. Then, refer to Software section.  
Supported operating systems  
The following table shows the network environments supported by the  
machine:  
ITEM  
REQUIREMENTS  
Printing is suitable for altitudes under 1,000 m (3,281 ft). Refer to the  
altitude setting to optimize your printing. See page 29 for more  
information.  
Place the machine on a flat, stable surface so that there is no incline  
greater than 5 mm (0.02 inch). Otherwise, printing quality may be  
affected.  
Network interface  
Ethernet 10/100/1000 Base-TX  
Network operating system  
Novell NetWare 5.x, 6.x  
Windows 2000/XP/2003/2008/Vista/7/  
Server 2008 R2  
Various Linux OS  
Mac OS 10.3 ~ 10.6  
Network protocols  
TCP/IP  
EtherTalk  
Dynamic addressing  
server  
DHCP, BOOTP  
2. Unpack the machine and check all the enclosed items.  
25 _Getting Started  
         
DHCP network protocol, go to http://developer.apple.com/networking/  
bonjour/download/, select the Bonjour program that is appropriate for  
your computer operating system and install the program. This program  
will allow you to set network parameters automatically. Follow the  
instructions in the installation window. This program does not support  
Linux.  
You can also set up the network settings through the network  
administration programs.  
SyncThru™ Web Admin Service: Web-based printer  
management solution for network administrators. SyncThru™  
managing network devices and lets you remotely monitor and  
solution.samsungprinter.com.  
Configuring network protocol via the machine  
You can set up TCP/IP network parameters, follow the steps listed below.  
SyncThru™ Web Service: Web server embedded on your  
network print server, which allows you to:  
1. Make sure your machine is connected to the network with an RJ-45  
- Configure the network parameters necessary for the machine to  
Ethernet cable.  
connect to various network environments.  
- Customize machine settings.  
- Customize email settings and set up address book for scanning  
2. Make sure you have turned on the machine.  
3. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
4. Press Admin Setting.  
5. When the login message appears, enter password. Touch the password  
input area, then the question marks appears. Use the number keypad on  
the control panel to enter the password. Once the password is entered,  
press OK. (Factory setting:1111)  
to email.  
- Customize server settings and set up address book for scanning  
to the FTP or SMB servers.  
- Customize printer, copy, and fax settings  
SetIP: Utility program allowing you to select a network interface  
and manually configure the IP addresses for use with the TCP/IP  
AnyWeb Print: This tool helps you to screen-capture, preview,  
scrap and print the screen of Windows Internet Explorer more  
easily, than when you use the ordinary program. Click Start > All  
Programs > you machine name > AnyWeb Print to link the  
website where the tool is available for the download. This tool is  
available only for Windows operating systems.  
6. Press the Setup tab > Network Setup.  
7. Select TCP/IP Protocol.  
Apple Talk Protocol: This protocol is widely used in Macintosh  
network environments.  
Ethernet Speed: You can select the communication speed for  
Ethernet connections.  
8. Press IP Setting.  
9. Select Static and then enter IP Address, Subnet Mask and Gateway  
address fields. Touch the input area then, enter addresses by number  
keypad on the control panel.  
SYSTEM REQUIREMENTS  
Before you begin, ensure that your system meets the following  
requirements:  
Windows  
REQUIREMENT (RECOMMENDED)  
OS  
FREE HDD  
SPACE  
CPU  
RAM  
Windows 2000 Pentium II 400 MHz  
64 MB  
600 MB  
(Pentium III 933 MHz) (128 MB)  
Contact the network administrator if you are not sure how to configure.  
Windows XP  
Pentium III 933 MHz  
(Pentium IV 1 GHz)  
128 MB  
(256 MB)  
1.5 GB  
10. Press OK.  
Windows  
Server 2003  
Pentium III 933 MHz  
(Pentium IV 1 GHz)  
128 MB  
(512 MB)  
1.25 GB to  
2 GB  
Windows  
Server 2008  
Pentium IV 1 GHz  
(Pentium IV 2 GHz)  
512 MB  
10 GB  
15 GB  
(2048 MB)  
Windows  
Vista  
Pentium IV 3 GHz  
512 MB  
(1024 MB)  
Getting Started_ 26  
       
Linux  
REQUIREMENT (RECOMMENDED)  
OS  
ITEM  
REQUIREMENTS  
FREE HDD  
SPACE  
CPU  
RAM  
Operating system  
RedHat Enterprise Linux WS 4, 5 (32/64bit)  
Fedora Core 2~9 (32/64bit)  
SuSE Linux 9.1 (32bit)  
Windows 7  
Pentium IV 1 GHz 32- 1 GB  
bit or 64-bit processor (2 GB)  
or higher  
16 GB  
SuSE Linux 9.2, 9.3, 10.0, 10.1, 10.2, 10.3,  
11.0 (32/64bit)  
Mandrake 9.2 (32bit), 10.0, 10.1 (32/64bit)  
Mandriva 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008 (32/64bit)  
Ubuntu 6.06, 6.10, 7.04, 7.10, 8.04 (32/64bit)  
SuSE Linux Enterprise Desktop 9, 10 (32/64bit)  
Debian 3.1, 4.0 (32/64bit)  
Support for DirectX 9 graphics with 128 MB  
memory(to enable the Aero theme).  
DVD-R/W Drive  
Windows  
Server 2008  
R2  
Pentium IV 1  
512 MB  
10 GB  
GHz(x86) or  
1.4GHz(x64)  
processors(2GHz or  
faster)  
(2048 MB)  
CPU  
Pentium IV 2.4GHz (IntelCore2)  
512 MB (1024 MB)  
RAM  
Internet Explorer 5.0 or higher is the minimum requirement for all  
Windows operating systems.  
free HDD space  
1 GB (2 GB)  
Users who have an administrator right can install the software.  
Windows Terminal Services is compatable with this machine.  
It is necessary to claim swap partition of 300 MB or larger for  
working with large scanned images.  
The Linux scanner driver supports the optical resolution at  
maximum.  
Macintosh  
REQUIREMENT (RECOMMENDED)  
INSTALLING THE SOFTWARE  
OPERATIN  
G SYSTEM  
FREE HDD  
SPACE  
You have to install the machine software for printing. The software includes  
drivers, applications, and other user friendly programs.  
CPU  
RAM  
The following procedure is for when the machine is being used as  
a network machine. If you want to connect a machine with a USB  
cable, refer to Software section.  
The following procedure is based on the Windows XP operating  
system. The procedure and popup window which appears during  
the installation may differ depending on the operating system, the  
printer feature, or the interface in use. (See Software section.)  
Mac OS X  
10.3 ~ 10.4  
PowerPC G4/  
G5  
Intel  
128 MB for a  
PowerPC based  
MAC (512 MB)  
512 MB for an  
Intel based MAC  
(1 GB)  
1 GB  
processors  
Mac OS X  
10.5  
867 MHz or  
faster  
PowerPC G4/  
G5  
Intel  
512 MB (1 GB)  
1 GB  
1 GB  
1. Make sure that the network setup for your machine is completed. (See  
"Setting up the network" on page 25.) All applications should be closed  
on your computer before beginning installation.  
2. Insert the Printer Software CD-ROM into your CD-ROM drive.  
The CD-ROM should automatically run, and an installation window  
appears.  
processors  
If the installation window does not appear, click Start > Run. Type  
X:\Setup.exe, replacing “X” with the letter which represents your drive  
and click OK.  
Mac OS X  
10.6  
Intel Processor 1 GB (2 GB)  
If you use Windows vista, Windows 7 and Windows Server 2008 R2,  
click Start > All Programs > Accessories > Run, and type  
X:\Setup.exe.  
If the AutoPlay window appears in Windows vista, Windows 7 and  
Windows Server 2008 R2, click Run Setup.exe in Install or run  
program field, and click Continue in the User Account Control  
window.  
3. Click Next.  
27 _Getting Started  
       
5. The list of machines available on the network appears. Select the printer  
you want to install from the list and then click Next.  
The window above may slightly differ, if you are reinstalling the  
driver.  
4. Select Typical installation for a network printer, and then click Next.  
If you do not see your machine on the list, click Update to refresh the  
list, or select Add TCP/IP Port to add your machine to the network.  
To add the machine to the network, enter the port name and the IP  
address for the machine.  
To verify your machine’s IP address or the MAC address, print a  
To find a shared network printer (UNC Path), select Shared Printer  
[UNC] and enter the shared name manually or find a shared printer  
by clicking the Browse button.  
If you are not sure of the IP address, contact your network  
administrator or print network information. (See "Printing a  
6. After the installation is finished, a window appears asking you to print a  
test page and to register yourself as a user of Samsung machines in  
order to receive information from Samsung. If you so desire, select the  
corresponding checkbox(es) and click Finish.  
If your machine does not work properly after the installation, try  
to reinstall the printer driver. See Software section.  
During the printer driver installation process, the driver installer  
detects the location information for your operating system and  
sets the default paper size for your machine. If you use a  
different Windows location, you must change the paper size to  
match the paper you usually use. Go to printer properties to  
change the paper size after installation is complete.  
Getting Started_ 28  
7. Press OK.  
MACHINE'S BASIC SETTINGS  
After installation is complete, you may want to set the machine's default  
settings. Refer to the next section if you would like to set or change values.  
Setting the date and time  
When you set the time and date, they are used in Delay fax and Delay Print,  
also they are printed on reports. If, however, they are not correct, you need  
to change it for correct time being.  
Altitude adjustment  
The print quality is affected by atmospheric pressure, which is determined  
by the height of the machine above sea level. The following information will  
guide you on how to set your machine to the best print quality or best quality  
of print.  
If power to the machine is cut off, you need to reset the correct time  
and date once the power has been restored.  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
2. Press Admin Setting.  
3. When the login message appears, enter password with number keypad  
Before you set the altitude value, find the altitude where you are using the  
machine.  
4. Press the General tab > Date & Time > Date & Time.  
5. Select date and time using left/right arrows. Or touch the insert area and  
use the numeric keypad on the control panel.  
6. Press OK.  
To change the format of date and time, press Date Format and Time  
Format.  
Changing the display language  
To change the language that appears on the display, refer to the following  
steps.  
1 Normal  
2 High 1  
3 High 2  
0
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
2. Press Admin Setting.  
3. When the login message appears, enter password with number keypad  
4. Press the General tab.  
5. Press the down arrow to switch the screen and press Language.  
6. Select the desired language.  
7. Press OK.  
4 High 3  
1. Enter your machine’s IP address as the URL in a browser and click Go  
to access the web site of your machine.  
2. Log in to the SyncThru™ Web Service as an administrator. (See  
3. Click Settings > Machine Settings > System > Setup > Altitude Adj.  
4. Select the appropriate altitude value.  
5. Click Apply.  
Setting job timeout  
When there is no input for a certain period of time, the machine exits the  
current location. You can set the amount of time the machine will wait.  
Setting the authentication password  
To set your machine up or change the settings, you have to login. To  
change password, follow the next steps.  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
2. Press Admin Setting.  
3. When the login message appears, enter password with number keypad  
4. Press the General tab.  
5. Press Timers.  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
2. Press Admin Setting.  
3. When the login message appears, enter password. Touch the password  
input area, then the question marks appears, use the number keypad on  
the control panel to enter the password. Then, press OK. (Factory  
setting:1111)  
6. Select System Timeout.  
4. Press the Setup tab > Authentication.  
You can set the Held Job Timeout option to over one hour.  
5. Press Change Admin. Password  
.
7. Select On.  
8. Select a duration using left/right arrows.  
9. Press OK.  
Using energy saving feature  
The machine provides energy saving features.  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
2. Press Admin Setting.  
3. When the login message appears, enter password with number keypad  
4. Press the General tab.  
5. Press down arrow to switch the screen, press Power Saver.  
6. Enter old and new password, and then confirm the new password.  
29 _Getting Started  
                                 
6. Select appropriate option and time.  
5. Press the function you want to change, and change its settings.  
Scan Power Save: Turns off the scanner lamp under the glass.  
Low Power Save: Keeps the temperature of the fuser unit under  
125 °C, and turns off the fans within the machine except a core fan  
for the fuser unit.  
Power Save: Turns off all the fans even for the fuser unit after  
certain time.  
For example, if you want to change the default setting of the brightness  
& darkness for a copy job, press Copy > Darkness and adjust the  
brightness & darkness.  
6. Press OK.  
IP setting using SetIP Program (Windows)  
7. Press OK.  
This program is for manually setting the network IP address of your machine  
using its MAC address to communicate with the machine. A MAC address is  
the hardware serial number of the network interface and can be found in the  
Network Configuration Report.  
Setting the default tray and paper  
You can select the tray and paper you would like to keep using for printing  
You can only use IPv4 setting for SetIP.  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
2. Press Admin Setting.  
3. When the login message appears, enter password with number keypad  
4. Press the General tab.  
For using SetIP program, disable the computer firewall before continuing by  
performing the following:  
1. Open Control Panel.  
2. Double click Security Center.  
3. Click Windows Firewall.  
4. Disable the firewall.  
5. Press the down arrow to switch the screen and press Tray  
Management.  
6. Select tray and its options such as paper size and type.  
7. Press OK.  
Installing the program  
1. Insert the driver CD provided along with your machine. When the driver  
If the optional tray is not installed, the tray options on the screen is  
grayed out.  
CD runs automatically, close the window.  
2. Start Windows Explorer and open the X drive. (X represents the name  
of your CD-ROM drive.)  
3. Double-click Application > SetIP.  
4. Double-click Setup.exe to install this program.  
5. Follow the onscreen instructions to complete the installation.  
Changing the default settings  
You can set the default values for copy, fax, email, scan and paper all at  
once.  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
2. Press Admin Setting.  
3. When the login message appears, enter password with number keypad  
4. Press the General tab > Default Settings > Default Option.  
Starting the program  
1. Connect your machine and the computer using network cable.  
2. Turned on the machine.  
3. From the Windows Start menu, select All Programs > Samsung  
Printers > SetIP > SetIP.  
4. Click on the  
icon (third from left) in the SetIP window to open the  
TCP/IP configuration window.  
5. Enter the machine’s new information into the configuration window as  
follows:  
MAC Address: Find the machine’s MAC address from the Network  
Configuration Report and enter it without the colons. For example,  
00:15:99:29:51:A8 becomes 0015992951A8.  
MAC address is a hardware serial number of the machine’s  
network interface and can be found in the Network Configuration  
page 31.)  
Getting Started_ 30  
                 
IP Address: Enter a new IP address for your machine.  
Subnet Mask: Enter a new Subnet Mask for your machine.  
Default Gateway: Enter ta new Gateway for your machine.  
necessary, restart the computer’s firewall. You have successfully  
changed the IP address, subnet mask, and gateway.  
6. Click Apply, and then click OK. The machine will automatically print the  
Network Configuration Report. Confirm that all the settings are  
correct.  
7. Click Exit to close the SetIP program.  
8. If necessary, restart the computer’s firewall.  
IP setting using SetIP Program (Linux)  
SetIP program should be automatically installed during the printer driver  
installation.  
You can only use IPv4 setting for SetIP.  
Printing out the machine’s MAC address  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
2. Press Machine Status > the Machine Info tab > Print/Report.  
1. Print the machine’s network configuration report to find your machine’s  
page 31.)  
2. Open the /opt/Samsung/mfp/share/utils/.  
3. Double click the SetIPApplet.html file.  
4. Click to open the TCP/IP configuration window.  
3. Press System Report  
.
4. Scroll down the list on the right and select Network Configuration  
Report.  
5. Enter the network card’s MAC address, IP address, subnet mask,  
5. Press Print.  
default gateway, and then click Apply.  
IP setting using SetIP Program (Macintosh)  
When you enter the MAC address, enter it without a colon(:).  
For using SetIP program, disable the computer firewall before continuing by  
performing the following:  
6. The machine prints the network information. Confirm all the settings are  
correct.  
7. Close the SetIP program.  
You can only use IPv4 setting for SetIP.  
1. Open System Preferences.  
2. Click Security.  
3. Click the Firewall menu.  
4. Turn firewall off.  
UNDERSTANDING THE KEYBOARD  
You can enter alphabet characters, numbers, or special symbols using the  
keyboard on the touch screen. This keyboard is specially arranged like a  
normal keyboard for better usability for the user.  
The following instructions may vary for your model.  
Touch the input area where you need to enter characters and the keyboard  
pops up on the screen. The keyboard below is the default showing the  
lowercase letters.  
Starting the program  
1. Connect your machine and the computer using network cable.  
2. Insert the driver CD-ROM, and open the disk window. Open the  
MAC_Installer > MAC_Printer > SetIP > SetIPapplet.html.  
3. Double click the file and Safari will automatically open, then select  
Trust. The browser will open the SetIPapplet.html page that shows the  
printer’s name and IP address information.  
4. Highlight the printer information row and select the Setup icon, which is  
the second icon from the left in the application menu bar. A TCP/IP  
Configuration window will open.  
If the printer was not shown in the information row, select the Manual  
Setting icon (third from left) to open the TCP/IP Configuration window.  
Moves the cursor between characters in the input  
5. Enter the printer’s new information into the configuration window as  
follows. In a corporate intranet, you may need to have this information  
assigned by a network manager before proceeding.  
Left/Right  
Backspace  
Delete  
1
2
3
area.  
Deletes the character on the left side of the  
cursor.  
MAC Address: Find the machine’s MAC address from the Network  
Configuration Report and enter it without the colons. For example,  
00:15:99:29:51:A8 becomes 0015992951A8.  
Deletes the character on the right side of the  
cursor.  
MAC address is a hardware serial number of the machine’s  
network interface and can be found in the Network Configuration  
Deletes all characters in the input area.  
Enters letters within this line.  
Clear  
4
5
Input area  
IP Address: Enter a new IP address for your machine.  
Subnet Mask: Enter a new Subnet Mask for your machine.  
Default Gateway: Enter ta new Gateway for your machine.  
Toggles between lowercase keys and uppercase  
keys or vice versa.  
Shift  
6
Switches from the alphanumeric keyboard to the  
symbol keyboard.  
Symbols  
Space  
6. Select Apply, then OK, and OK again. The printer will automatically  
print the configuration report. Confirm that all the settings are correct.  
Quit Safari. You may close and eject the installation CD-ROM. If  
7
8
Enters a blank between characters.  
31 _Getting Started  
             
Saves and closes input result.  
Cancels and closes input result.  
OK  
9
Cancel  
10  
If you enter the email address, then the keyboard for email pops up.  
After you enter the address, press OK to activate entered address.  
Press the arrow key on the side for rotating between From, To, Cc,  
Bcc, Subject, Message in order.  
Getting Started_ 32  
loading originals and print media  
This chapter introduces you to how to load originals and print media into your machine.  
This chapter includes:  
3. Close the scanner lid.  
LOADING ORIGINALS  
Leaving the scanner lid open while copying may affect copy quality  
and toner consumption.  
You can use the scanner glass or DADF to load an original for copying,  
scanning, and sending a fax.  
Dust on the scanner glass may cause black spots on the printout.  
If you are copying a page from a book or magazine, lift the scanner  
lid until its hinges are caught by the stopper and then close the lid.  
If the book or magazine is thicker than 30 mm, start copying with  
the lid open.  
On the scanner glass  
Make sure that no originals are in the DADF. If an original is detected in the  
DADF, the machine gives it priority over the original on the scanner glass.  
To get the best scan quality, especially for colored or gray-scaled images,  
use the scanner glass.  
1. Lift and open the scanner lid.  
In the DADF  
Using the DADF, you can load up to 100 sheets of paper (75 g/m2, 20 lb) for  
one job.  
When you use the DADF:  
Do not load paper smaller than 174 x 128 mm (5.6 x 5.8 inches) or  
larger than 218 x 356 mm (8.5 x 14 inches).  
Do not attempt to load the following types of paper:  
- carbon-paper or carbon-backed paper  
- coated paper  
- onion skin or thin paper  
- wrinkled or creased paper  
- curled or rolled paper  
- torn paper  
Remove all staples and paper clips before loading.  
Make sure any glue, ink, or correction fluid on the paper is completely  
dry before loading.  
Do not load originals that include different sizes or weights of paper.  
Do not load booklets, pamphlets, transparencies, or documents having  
other unusual characteristics.  
To load an original into the DADF:  
1. Load the original face up into the DADF. Make sure that the bottom of  
the original stack matches the paper size marked on the document input  
tray.  
2. Place the original face down on the scanner glass and align it with the  
registration guide at the top left corner of the glass.  
33 _Loading originals and print media  
             
2. Adjust the document width guides to the paper size.  
SELECTING PRINT MEDIA  
You can print on a variety of print media, such as plain paper, envelopes,  
labels, and transparencies. Always use print media that meet the guidelines  
for use with your machine. Print media that does not meet the guidelines  
outlined in this user’s guide may cause the following problems:  
Poor print quality  
Increased paper jams  
Premature wear on the machine.  
Properties, such as weight, composition, grain, and moisture content, are  
important factors that affect the machine’s performance and the output  
quality. When you choose print materials, consider the following:  
The type, size and weight of the print media for your machine are  
described later in this section.  
Desired outcome: The print media you choose should be appropriate for  
your project.  
Brightness: Some print media are whiter than others and produce  
sharper, more vibrant images.  
Surface smoothness: The smoothness of the print media affects how  
crisp the printing looks on the paper.  
Some print media may meet all of the guidelines in this section and  
still not produce satisfactory results. This may be the result of  
improper handling, unacceptable temperature and humidity levels,  
or other variables over which Samsung has no control.  
Before purchasing large quantities of print media, ensure that it  
meets the requirements specified in this user’s guide.  
Dust on the DADF glass may cause black lines on the printout. Always  
keep it clean.  
Using print media that does not meet these specifications may cause  
problems, requiring repairs. Such repairs are not covered by  
Samsung’s warranty or service agreements.  
Loading originals and print media_ 34  
 
Specification on print media  
WEIGHTA  
CAPACITYB  
TYPE  
SIZE  
DIMENSIONS  
500 sheets of 80 g/m2 (20 lb  
bond) paper for the tray  
Plain paper  
Letter  
Legal  
Folio  
216 x 279 mm (8.5 x 11 inches)  
216 x 356 mm (8.5 x 14 inches)  
216 x 330 mm (8.5 x 13 inches)  
210 x 297 mm (8.26 x 11.69 inches)  
216 x 343 mm (8.5 x 13.5 inches)  
182 x 257 mm (7.16 x 10.11 inches)  
176 x 250 mm (6.93 x 9.84 inches)  
184 x 267 mm (7.25 x 10.5 inches)  
148 x 210 mm (5.82 x 8.26 inches)  
140 x 216 mm (5.5 x 8.5 inches)  
105 x 148 mm (4.13 x 5.82 inches)  
176 x 250 mm (6.92 x 9.84 inches)  
98 x 191 mm (3.87 x 7.5 inches)  
105 x 241 mm (4.12 x 9.5 inches)  
110 x 220 mm (4.33 x 8.66 inches)  
162 x 229 mm (6.37 x 9.01 inches)  
114 x 162 mm (4.48 x 6.38 inches)  
Refer to the Plain paper section  
60 to 90 g/m2 (16 to 24 lb  
bond) for the tray  
60 to 220 g/m2 (16 to 58 lb  
bond) for the multi-purpose  
tray  
100 sheets of 80 g/m2 (20 lb  
bond) in the multi-purpose tray  
2,100 sheets of 80 g/m2 (20 lb  
bond) in the high capacity  
feederc  
60 to 120 g/m2 (16 to 32 lb  
bond) for the high capacity  
feeder  
A4  
Oficio  
JIS B5  
ISO B5  
Executive  
A5  
Statement  
A6  
75 to 90 g/m2 (20 to 24 lb  
bond)  
50 sheets of 80 g/m2 (20 lb)  
paper for the tray  
Envelope  
Envelope B5  
Envelope Monarch  
Envelope No. 10  
Envelope DL  
Envelope C5  
Envelope C6  
Letter, A4, Oficio  
10 sheets of 80 g/m2 (20 lb) in  
the multi-purpose tray  
138 to 146 g/m2 (37 to 39 lb)  
100 sheets of 80 g/m2 (20 lb)  
paper for the tray  
20 sheets of 80 g/m2 (20 lb) in  
Transparency  
Labels  
the multi-purpose tray  
120 to 150 g/m2 (32 to 40 lb  
bond)  
100 sheets of 80 g/m2 (20 lb)  
paper for the tray  
Letter, Legal, Folio,  
A4, JIS B5, ISO B5,  
Executive, A5,  
Refer to the Plain paper section  
Refer to the Plain paper section  
10 sheets of 80 g/m2 (20 lb) in  
the multi-purpose tray  
Statement, Oficio, A6  
90 to 220 g/m2 (24 to 58 lb  
bond)  
50 sheets of 80 g/m2 (20 lb)  
paper for the tray  
Card stock  
Letter, Legal, Folio,  
A4, JIS B5, ISO B5,  
Executive, A5,  
Statement, Oficio, A6,  
Post Card 4x6  
10 sheets of 80 g/m2 (20 lb) in  
the multi-purpose tray  
60 to 220 g/m2 (16 to 58 lb bond)  
Minimum size (custom)  
Maximum size (custom)  
98 x 148 mm (3.86 x 5.83 inches)  
216 x 356 mm (8.5 x 14 inches)  
a.If media weight is over 105 g/m2 (28 lb bond), use the multi-purpose tray.  
b.Maximum capacity may differ depending on media weight, thickness, and environmental conditions.  
c. High capacity feeder is not supported A6.  
35 _Loading originals and print media  
   
Media sizes supported in each mode  
Guidelines for special print media  
MODE  
Copy mode  
SIZE  
SOURCE  
tray 1  
optional tray 2  
multi-purpose tray  
MEDIA TYPE  
Envelopes  
GUIDELINES  
Letter, A4, Legal,  
Oficio, Folio,  
Executive, JIS B5, A5,  
A6  
Successful printing on envelopes depends upon the  
quality of the envelopes. When selecting envelopes,  
consider the following factors:  
- Weight: The weight of the envelope paper should  
not exceed 90 g/m2 or jamming may occur.  
- Construction: Prior to printing, envelopes should  
lie flat with less than 6 mm curl, and should not  
contain air.  
- Condition: Envelopes should not be wrinkled,  
nicked, or otherwise damaged.  
- Temperature: You should use envelopes that are  
compatible with the heat and pressure of the  
machine during operation.  
high capacity feeder  
Single side printing All sizes supported by  
tray 1  
optional tray  
multi-purpose tray  
high capacity feeder  
the machine  
Duplex printinga  
Letter, A4, Legal, Folio,  
tray 1  
optional tray  
multi-purpose tray  
high capacity feeder  
Oficio, JIS B5, ISO B5,  
Executive, A5,  
Statement  
Use only well-constructed envelopes with sharp and  
well creased folds.  
Do not use stamped envelopes.  
Fax modeb  
Letter, A4, Legal  
tray 1  
optional tray  
high capacity feeder  
Do not use envelopes with clasps, snaps, windows,  
coated lining, self-adhesive seals, or other synthetic  
materials.  
Do not use damaged or poorly made envelopes.  
Be sure the seam at both ends of the envelope  
extends all the way to the corner of the envelope.  
a.75 to 90 g/m2 (20 ~ 24 lb) only  
b.Only the optional fax kit is installed.  
1 Acceptable  
2 Unacceptable  
Envelopes with a peel-off adhesive strip or with  
more than one flap that folds over to seal must use  
adhesives compatible with the machine’s fusing  
temperature for 0.1 second. Check your machine’s  
specification to view the fusing temperature, see  
extra flaps and strips might cause wrinkling,  
creasing, or jams, and may even damage the fuser.  
For the best print quality, position margins no closer  
than 15 mm from the edges of the envelope.  
Avoid printing over the area where the envelope’s  
seams meet.  
Loading originals and print media_ 36  
   
MEDIA TYPE  
GUIDELINES  
MEDIA TYPE  
GUIDELINES  
Transparencies  
To avoid damaging the machine, use only  
transparencies designed for use in laser printers.  
Transparencies used in the machine must be able  
to withstand 180 °C, the machine’s fusing  
temperature.  
Place them on a flat surface after removing them  
from the machine.  
Do not leave them in the paper tray for long periods  
of time. Dust and dirt may accumulate on them,  
resulting in spotty printing.  
To avoid smudging caused by fingerprints, handle  
them carefully.  
Preprinted  
paper  
Letterhead must be printed with heat-resistant ink  
that will not melt, vaporize, or release hazardous  
emissions when subjected to the printer’s fusing  
temperature for 0.1 second. Check your machine’s  
specification to view the fusing temperature, see  
page 126.  
Letterhead ink must be non-flammable and should  
not adversely affect printer rollers.  
Forms and letterhead should be sealed in a  
moisture-proof wrapping to prevent changes during  
storage.  
Before you load preprinted paper, such as forms  
and letterhead, verify that the ink on the paper is  
dry. During the fusing process, wet ink can come off  
preprinted paper, reducing print quality.  
To avoid fading, do not expose printed  
transparencies to prolonged sunlight.  
Ensure that transparencies are not wrinkled, curled,  
or have any torn edges.  
Labels  
To avoid damaging the machine, use only labels  
designed for use in laser machines.  
- When selecting labels, consider the following fac-  
CHANGING THE SIZE OF THE PAPER IN THE  
PAPER TRAY  
tors:  
To load longer sizes of paper, such as Legal-sized paper, you need to  
adjust the paper guides to extend the paper tray.  
- Adhesives: The adhesive material should be sta-  
ble at your machine’s fusing temperature. Check  
your machine’s specification to view the fusing  
temperature, see page 126.  
- Arrangement: Only use labels with no exposed  
backing between them. Labels can peel off sheets  
that have spaces between the labels, causing  
serious jams.  
- Curl: Prior to printing, labels must lie flat with no  
more than 13 mm of curl in any direction.  
- Condition: Do not use labels with wrinkles, bub-  
bles, or other indications of separation.  
Make sure that there is no exposed adhesive  
material between labels. Exposed areas can cause  
labels to peel off during printing, which can cause  
paper jams. Exposed adhesive can also cause  
damage to machine components.  
Do not run a sheet of labels through the machine  
more than once. The adhesive backing is designed  
for only a single pass through the machine.  
Do not use labels that are separating from the  
backing sheet or are wrinkled, bubbled, or otherwise  
damaged.  
1 paper length guide  
2 paper width guide  
If you have installed an optional high capacity feeder, refer to Quick  
Install Sheet to adjust paper size.  
1. Adjust the paper length guide to the desired paper length. It is preset  
to Letter or A4 size depending on the country. To load another size,  
hold the lever and move the length guide to the corresponding  
position.  
Card stock or  
custom-sized  
materials  
Do not print on media smaller than 98 mm wide or  
356 mm long.  
In the software application, set margins at least  
6.4 mm away from the edges of the material.  
37 _Loading originals and print media  
   
2. After inserting paper into the tray, while pinching the paper width  
guide as shown, move it toward the stack of paper until it lightly  
touches the side of the stack. Do not press the guide too tightly to the  
edge of the paper; the guide may bend the paper.  
1. To load paper, pull and open the paper tray and place paper with the  
side you want to print facing down.  
1 Full  
2 Empty  
Place the side to be printed facing up.  
When you use legal-sized paper, you need to extend the length of the  
tray.  
3. Load the paper into the tray.  
4. Place the tray into the machine.  
5. Set the paper size from your computer.  
PREPRINTED  
ENVELOPE  
TRANSPARENCY  
PAPER  
Do not push the paper width guides far enough to cause the  
materials to warp.  
If you do not adjust the paper width guides, it may cause paper  
jams.  
LETTERHEAD  
PAPER  
PUNCHED PAPER  
CARD STOCK  
LABEL  
LOADING PAPER  
Loading paper in tray 1, optional tray or optional  
high capacity feeder  
Load the print media you use for the majority of your print jobs in the tray 1.  
The tray 1 can hold a maximum of 500 sheets of 80 g/m2 (20 lb bond) plain  
paper.  
2. After loading paper, set the paper type and size for the tray 1. See  
Software section for PC-printing.  
You can purchase an optional tray and attach it below the standard tray to  
load an additional 500 sheets of paper. (See "Supplies" on page 121.)  
Using photographic paper or coated paper may cause problems,  
requiring repairs. Such repairs are not covered by Samsung’s  
warranty or service agreement.  
If you experience problems with paper feed, place one sheet at a  
time in the multi-purpose tray.  
You can load previously printed paper. The printed side should be  
facing up with an uncurled edge at the front. If you experience  
problems with paper feed, turn the paper around. Note that print  
quality is not guaranteed.  
Loading originals and print media_ 38  
         
3. Load the paper.  
In the multi-purpose tray  
The multi-purpose tray can hold special sizes and types of print material,  
such as postcards, note cards, and envelopes. It is useful for single page  
printing on letterhead or colored paper.  
Tips on using the multi-purpose tray  
Load only one size of print media at a time in the multi-purpose tray.  
To prevent paper jams, do not add paper when there is still paper in  
the multi-purpose tray. This also applies to other types of print  
media.  
Print media should be loaded face down with the top edge going into  
the multi-purpose tray first and be placed in the center of the tray.  
Always load only the specified print media to avoid paper jams and  
Flatten any curl on postcards, envelopes, and labels before loading  
them into the multi-purpose tray.  
To load paper in the multi-purpose tray:  
1. Open the multi-purpose tray and unfold the multi-purpose tray  
extension, as shown.  
Place the side to be printed facing down.  
PREPRINTED  
ENVELOPE  
PAPER  
TRANSPARENCY  
LETTERHEAD  
PAPER  
PUNCHED PAPER  
CARD STOCK  
2. If you are using paper, flex or fan the edge of the paper stack to  
separate the pages before loading.  
LABEL  
For transparencies, hold them by the edges and avoid touching the  
print side. Oils from your fingers can cause print quality problems.  
39 _Loading originals and print media  
   
4. Squeeze the multi-purpose tray paper width guides and adjust them  
to the width of the paper. Do not force too much, or the paper will be  
bent, which will result in a paper jam or skew.  
Depending on the media type you are using, keep the following  
loading guidelines:  
Envelopes: Flap side down and with the stamp area on the  
top left side.  
Transparencies: Print side up and the top with the adhesive  
strip entering the machine first.  
Labels: Print side up and top short edge entering the machine  
first.  
Preprinted paper: Design side up with the top edge toward the  
machine.  
Card stock: Print side up and the short edge entering the  
machine first.  
Previously printed paper: Previously printed side down with  
an uncurled edge toward the machine.  
5. After loading paper, set the paper type and size for the multi-purpose  
and faxing or the Software section for PC-printing.  
The settings made from the printer driver override the settings on  
the control panel.  
6. After printing, fold the multi-purpose tray extension and close the  
multi-purpose tray.  
SETTING THE PAPER SIZE AND TYPE  
After loading paper in the paper tray, you need to set the paper size and  
type. These settings will apply to Copy and Fax modes.  
For PC-printing, you need to select the paper size and type in the  
application program you use on your PC.  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
2. Press Admin Setting.  
3. When the login message appears, enter password with number keypad  
4. Press the General tab.  
5. Press the down arrow to switch the screen, press Tray Management.  
6. Select tray and its options such as paper size and type.  
7. Press OK.  
Loading originals and print media_ 40  
     
copying  
This chapter gives you information about using your machine as a copy machine.  
This chapter includes  
Advanced tab  
UNDERSTANDING THE COPY SCREEN  
When you press Copy on the Main screen, the Copy screen appears which  
has several tabs and lost of copying options. All the options are grouped by  
features so that you can configure your selections easily.  
If the screen displays an other menu, press (  
) to go to the Main screen.  
Basic tab  
Job Build: Allows you to copy several pages or different types of  
ID Copy: Prints 2-sided originals on one sheet of paper. This feature  
is helpful for copying a small-sized item, such as a business card.  
N-Up: Prints 2 or 4 original images, reduced to fit onto one sheet of  
Original Size: Selects the size of the originals. (See "Changing the  
Poster Copy: Prints a large image into divided 9 pages. (See  
Clone Copy: Prints multiple image copies from the original  
Book Copy: Allows you to copy an entire book. (See "Book  
Booklet: Creates booklets from a sequential set of either 1-sided or  
Covers: Automatically adds covers to your copied set using stock  
taken from a different tray. (See "Cover copying" on page 47.)  
Transparencies: Adds a blank or printed divider between  
Reduce/Enlarge: Reduces or enlarges the size of a copied image.  
Duplex: Sets the machine to print copies on both sides of the paper.  
Output: Selects Collated or Uncollated copy options. If you install  
the optional stacker & stapler, then the staple related option appears.  
Original Type: Improves the copy quality by selecting the document  
Light, Dark: Adjusts the brightness level to make a copy that is  
easier to read, when the original contains faint markings and dark  
Paper Supply: Selects the paper supply tray.  
WaterMark: Prints an image with the added watermark. (See  
Overlay: Prints an image with the image previously stored in your  
Auto Crop: Prints only the image of an original after cropping the  
Saving to box: Sets the machine to save the originals to the  
document box for later use.  
For details about how to use the Document Box, refer to the  
blank parts like the margin. (See "Auto crop copying" on page 49.)  
41 _Copying  
           
4. Select the tray by pressing the appropriate tray on screen.  
Image tab  
5. Enter the number of copies using the number keypad, if necessary.  
If you want to copy originals on the scanner glass and copy more than  
two copies, the message Another Page? appears after the first page  
copied. At this time, if you select No, the machine starts copying the  
rest of your originals and sorts the copied papers in order. Because  
the default value of theOutput option is Collated.  
Erase Edge: Allows you to erase punch holes, staple marks, and  
fold creases along any of the four documents edges. (See "Erasing  
Erase Background: Prints an image with no background. (See  
Margin Shift: Creates a binding edge for the document. (See  
6. Press Start on the control panel to begin copying.  
To cancel the current copy job, press Stop on the control panel. Or  
you can delete the current and pending job using Job Status on the  
control panel. Select the job you want to cancel and press Delete.  
CHANGING THE SETTINGS FOR EACH COPY  
COPYING ORIGINALS  
On the Basic tab of the Copy screen, you can select copy features before  
This is the normal and usual procedure for copying your originals.  
starting to copy.  
1. Press Copy from the Main screen.  
The Basic tab setting is only for each copy. That means that the  
setting does not apply to the next copy job. After finishing the current  
copy job, the machine automatically restores the default settings after  
certain time. Or the machine resume to default setting when you press  
the Clear All button on the control panel or when you press other  
menu such as fax or else except the Job Status screen.  
The default copy setting can be changed in Admin Setting. (See  
2. Place originals, face up, in the DADF, or you can use the scanner glass  
with a single original document face down.  
Changing the size of originals  
Press the Basic tab > Original Size, then use left/right arrows to set the  
original size.  
Press more to see the detail values.  
3. Adjust the settings for each copy such as Original Size, Reduce/  
Custom: Selects the scanning area of the original. Press the  
cardinal point arrows to set the size.  
Auto: Automatically detects the size of originals, but this option  
supports only when originals are Legal, Letter, or A5 sized. If the  
originals is mixed-sized, then the machine detects the largest original  
size and select the largest-sized paper in the tray.  
Mixed Size (Letter & Legal): Allows for the use of both of Letter and  
Legal sized papers together, and the machine uses the proper-sized  
paper from several trays. For example, if the originals are total 3  
Copying_ 42  
               
pages, 1st page is the letter-sized paper, 2nd page is the legal-sized  
paper, and 3rd page is the letter-sized paper, then the machine  
prints the output first letter, legal, and letter in order from several  
trays.  
Other preset values: Allows user to easily select commonly used  
values.  
1 -> 2 Sided, Rotate Side 2: Scans one side of the originals and  
prints on both sides of the paper, but the information on the back  
side of the print out is rotated 180°.  
Reducing or enlarging copies  
Press the Basic tab > Reduce/Enlarge, then use left/right arrows to reduce  
or enlarge an image on the paper.  
2 -> 1 Sided: Scans both sides of the originals and prints each of  
one on a separate sheet.  
Press more to see the values.  
2 -> 2 Sided: Scans both sides of the original and prints on both  
sides of the paper. This function produces exactly the same print out  
from the originals.  
2 -> 1 Sided, Rotate Side 2: Scans both sides of the original and  
prints each one on a separate sheet, but the information on the back  
side of the printout is rotated 180°.  
Original(100%): Prints texts or images the same size as originals.  
Auto Fit: Reduces or enlarges the original based on the size of the  
output paper.  
Other preset values: Allows you to easily select commonly used  
values.  
The Custom option is different depending on where the originals is  
placed. In the DADF, 25~200% adjustment is possible. And in the  
scanner glass, 25~400% adjustment is possible.  
Reverse 1 ->2 Sided: Scans originals and prints them on both sides  
of a paper. But the machine reverses the print out order of the  
originals. The machine prints the second original first, which means  
the firstly input original is printed on the back side of a paper. For  
instance, if you print 6 sheet of original papers, every even  
numbered pages of originals will be printed on the front side of a  
paper, and every odd numbered pages of originals will be printed on  
the back side of a paper.  
Copying on both sides of originals (Duplex)  
Press the Basic tab > Duplex, then use left/right arrows to select Duplex  
value.  
If you want to copy originals on the scanner glass and copy both sides  
of originals, the message Another Page? appears after the first page  
copied. At this time, load the original's the other side facing down and  
press Yes, then the machine starts scanning the second page of your  
original.  
Press more to see the detail values.  
1 -> 1 Sided: Scans one side of an original and prints on one side of  
the paper, this function produces exactly the same print out from  
originals.  
Reverse 1 -> 2 Sided, Rotate Side 2: Scans originals and prints  
them on both sides of a paper. But the machine reverses the print  
out order of the originals. The machine prints the second original  
first, which means the firstly input original is printed on the back side  
of a paper. For instance, if you print 6 sheet of original papers, every  
even numbered pages of originals will be printed on the front side of  
a paper, and every odd numbered pages of originals will be printed  
on the back side of a paper. The information on the back side of the  
print out is rotated 180°.  
1 -> 2 Sided: Scans one side of originals and prints them on both  
sides of the paper.  
43 _Copying  
         
Reverse 2 -> 2 Sided: Scans the both sides of originals and prints  
them on both sides of a paper. But the machine reverses the print  
out order of the originals. The machine prints the back sides of  
originals first, which means the front sides of originals is printed on  
the back side of a paper.  
Selecting the type of originals  
Press the Basic tab and select an appropriate original type.  
Text: Use for originals containing mostly text.  
Text/Photo: Use for originals with mixed text and photographs.  
Photo: Use when originals are photographs.  
Changing the darkness  
This defines the degree of darkness. Use left/right arrows to change the  
level of light/dark in the printouts.  
Deciding the form of copy output (Collated / Staple)  
Press the Basic tab > Output, then use left/right arrows to select Collated  
or Stapled. This feature is supported only when the original is on the DADF.  
If you want to copy originals on the scanner glass and copy both sides  
of originals, the message Another Page? appears after the first page  
copied. At this time, load the original's the other side facing down and  
press Yes, then the machine starts scanning the second page of your  
original.  
USING SPECIAL COPY FEATURES  
Press more to see the values.  
Collated: Prints output in sets to match the sequence of originals.  
On the Advanced tab or the Image tab of the Copy screen, you can select  
specific copy features.  
Merging multiple jobs as a single copy  
This feature allows you to merge multiple copy jobs into a single copy. For  
example, if you need to use the DADF and the scanner glass for a  
copy job, you can use this feature. In the picture below, each number  
means each segment order.  
Uncollated: Prints output sorted into stacks of individual pages.  
Segment 1 from the DADF.  
Segment 2 from the scanner  
glass.  
Segment 3 from the DADF.  
Segment 4 from the scanner  
glass.  
Staple, Portrait: Adds a single staple to all of your portrait-oriented  
output.  
Segment 5 from the DADF.  
Staple, Landscape: Adds a single staple to all of your landscape-  
oriented output.  
When the machine enters power saver mode, the jobs in the segment  
list will be deleted to prevent accessing by the unexpected users.  
1. Press Copy from the Main screen.  
2. Select the tray in Paper Supply.  
3. Press the Advanced tab > Job Build.  
4. Press On to enable job build function.  
The Staple feature is available with an optional stacker & stapler. (See  
Copying_ 44  
                 
Off: Disables Job Build feature.  
On: Enables Job Build feature.  
Display Between Segments: After executing a segment, the job is  
paused with this screen. is displayed Then the user can select to  
keep copying or stop.  
6. Turn the original over and place it on the scanner glass, where arrows  
indicate as shown. Then, close the scanner lid.  
Print: Prints the sample page(s) of a segment to confirm the  
contents.  
Delete: Deletes a segment.  
Delete All: Deletes all segments.  
Print All: Prints all segments.  
Add Segment: Adds a new segment.  
Cancel: Removes all segments in the list, and cancels the job.  
7. Press Start on the control panel to begin copying.  
If the original is larger than the printable area, some portions may  
not be printed.  
If this option is grayed out, select the Duplex option to 1 -> 1  
5. Press Add Segment.  
6. Place originals, face up, in the DADF, or you can use the scanner glass  
with a single original document face down.  
Sided, the Output option to Collated.  
7. Press Start on the control panel.  
Then the machine starts scanning.  
8. Repeat step 5 to step 7.  
Copying ID with the manual ID copy option  
If you want to copy several ID cards on a paper, or adjust the copying position  
of the page, follow the next steps.  
As long as the hard drive capacity of your device remains, you can add  
segments without any restriction.  
Next steps are the procedure when you copy two people's driver's license  
cards (100mm X 80mm) in one page.  
9. After adding segments, press Print All.  
ID card copying  
1
2
Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
The machine prints one side of the original on the upper half of the paper  
and the other side on the lower half without reducing the size of the original.  
This feature is helpful for copying a small-sized item, such as a business  
card.  
Select Admin Setting. When the login message pops up, then enter  
password and press OK.  
3
4
5
6
Press the Setup tab > Copy Setup > Manual ID Copy Setup.  
Press the number from the template list table.  
Press Edit Template.  
This copy feature is available only when you place originals on the scanner  
glass.  
Selec the appropriate option values and press OK.  
Template Name: Enter the template name.  
Scan Position: Select the position for scanning. You should select the  
largest scanning position out of the originals.  
The original must be placed on the scanner glass to use this feature.  
LEFT, TOP : X-000mm/Y-000mm, RIGHT, BOTTOM: X-110mm/Y-  
090mm  
1. Place the front side of an original facing down on the scanner glass  
where arrows indicate as shown, and close the scanner lid.  
2. Press Copy from the Main screen.  
3. Select the tray in Paper Supply.  
4. Press the Advanced tab > ID Copy.  
5. Press Start on the control panel.  
Then the machine starts scanning the front side.  
Number of Images: Select how many images are on a page. (select  
number 4.)  
45 _Copying  
       
Image Position: Select the position of a page which images are on. If  
you choose to copy four images, you have to select four positions  
here.  
- First Image Position: LEFT, TOP : X-000mm/Y-020mm, RIGHT,  
BOTTOM: X-100mm/Y-100mm  
- Second Image Position: LEFT, TOP : X-105mm/Y-020mm, RIGHT,  
BOTTOM: X-205mm/Y-100mm  
- Third Image Position: LEFT, TOP : X-000mm/Y-150mm, RIGHT,  
BOTTOM: X-100mm/Y-230mm  
Poster copying  
Your original will be divided into 9 portions. You can paste the printed pages  
together to make one poster-sized document. This copy feature is available  
only when you place originals on the scanner glass. Each portion is  
scanned and printed on by one in the following order.  
This copy feature is available only when you place originals on the scanner  
glass.  
- Forth Image Position: LEFT, TOP : X-105mm/Y-150mm, RIGHT,  
BOTTOM: X-205mm/Y-230mm  
7
Press OK, the template you have saved will be shown in the template  
1. Place a single original face down on the scanner glass. (See "Loading  
list table.  
2. Press Copy from the Main screen.  
3. Select the tray in Paper Supply.  
4. Press the Advanced tab > Poster Copy.  
8
9
Press  
and select Copy.  
Press the Advanced tab > ID Copy > Manual ID Copy >.  
This feature is available only when the options in the Basic tab are  
selected as below;  
10 Press the template you have saved from the template list.  
- Duplex to 1 -> 1 Sided  
- Reduce/Enlarge to Original(100%)  
- Paper Supply to Tray.  
11 Press the Start button on the control panel. now follow the instruction  
on display to finish the ID copy for four images  
5. Press On to activate this feature.  
6. Press OK.  
7. Press Start on the control panel to begin copying.  
2-up or 4-up copying (N-up)  
The machine reduces the size of the original images and prints 2 or 4 pages  
onto one sheet of paper.  
2 or 4-up copying is available only when you load originals into the DADF.  
Your original is divided into 9 portions. Each portion is scanned and  
printed one by one in the following order:  
1
3
2
4
1. Place the originals face up in the DADF. Or place a single original face  
Clone copying  
The machine prints multiple original images on a single page. The number  
of images is automatically determined by the original image and the paper  
size.  
2. Press Copy from the Main screen.  
3. Select the tray in Paper Supply.  
4. Press the Advanced tab > N-Up.  
5. Select Off, 2Up, or 4Up.  
This copy feature is available only when you place originals on the scanner  
glass.  
Off: Copies an original onto one sheet of paper.  
2Up: Copies two separate originals onto one page.  
4Up: Copies four separate originals onto one page.  
6. Press Start on the control panel.  
You cannot adjust the copy size using the Reduce/Enlarge for the N-  
Up feature.  
1. Place a single original face down on the scanner glass. (See "Loading  
2. Press Copy from the Main screen.  
Copying_ 46  
           
3. Select the tray in Paper Supply.  
4. Press the Advanced tab > Clone Copy.  
1. Place the originals face up in the DADF. Or place a single original face  
2. Press Copy from the Main screen.  
3. Select the tray in Paper Supply.  
4. Press the Advanced tab > Booklet.  
This feature is available only when the options in the Basic tab are  
selected as below;  
- Duplex to 1 -> 1 Sided  
- Reduce/Enlarge to Original(100%)  
- Paper Supply to Tray.  
5. Press On to use this feature, and select detailed settings for each  
option.  
1 Sided Original: Copies on one side of the paper.  
2 Sided Original: Copies on both sides of the paper.  
5. Press On to activate this feature.  
6. Press OK.  
7. Press Start on the control panel to begin copying.  
6. Press OK.  
7. Press Start on the control panel to begin copying.  
Book copying  
This feature is possible only with A4, Letter, Legal, Folio, Oficio, JIS  
B5, ISO B5, Executive, A5 and Statement sized paper.  
Use this feature to copy a book. If the book is too thick, lift the scanner lid  
until its hinges are engaged by the stopper and then close the scanner lid. If  
the book or magazine is thicker than 30 mm(1.18 inches), start copying with  
the scanner lid open.  
Cover copying  
The machine automatically adds covers to your copied set using stock taken  
from a different tray. Covers must be the same size and orientation as the  
main body of the job.  
This copy feature is available only when you place originals on the scanner  
glass.  
1. Place the originals face up in the DADF. Or place a single original face  
2. Press Copy from the Main screen.  
3. Select the tray in Paper Supply.  
4. Press the Advanced tab > Covers.  
Once you have set the Paper Supply option to Auto, you cannot use  
this feature.  
1. Place the originals face down on the scanner glass. (See "Loading  
2. Press Copy from the Main screen.  
5. Press On to use this feature, and select detailed settings for each  
option.  
Position: Selects whether the cover will be placed at the front, back,  
or both.  
Cover Sheet: Selects whether the cover will be 1 sided, 2 sided, or  
blank paper.  
Paper Source: Select the paper tray, where the cover sheet is  
loaded.  
To remove shadows of a book edge, press the Image tab > Erase  
Edge > Book Center and Edges Erase.  
3. Press the Advanced tab > Book Copy.  
4. Select the binding option.  
Off: Disables this feature.  
6. Press OK.  
7. Press Start on the control panel to begin copying.  
Left Page: Prints left page of the book.  
Right Page: Prints right page of the book.  
Both Page: Prints both facing pages of the book.  
Transparency copying  
When you prepare transparencies for presentations, use this feature to copy  
the information.  
5. Press OK.  
6. Press Start on the control panel to begin copying.  
Before you start this special copy job, set the tray's Paper Types and  
Booklet copying  
The machine automatically prints on one or both sides of the paper,  
which are then folded to produce a booklet with all of the pages in  
the correct sequence.  
The machine will also reduce and correctly adjust the position of each  
image to fit on the selected paper.  
1. Place the originals face up in the DADF. Or place a single original face  
2. Load the right-sized transparencies into the tray you have set.  
3. Set the paper type to Transparency.  
4. Press Copy from the Main screen.  
5. Press the Advanced tab > Transparencies.  
6. Select Transparencies option.  
No Separator: Does not place separator sheets between  
transparencies.  
Blank Sheet: Places a blank sheet between transparencies.  
Printed Sheet: Places the same image on the divider sheets as  
printed on the transparency.  
7. Select media sources, in case you selected either Blank Sheet or  
Printed Sheet.  
47 _Copying  
               
8. Press OK.  
9. Press Start on the control panel to begin copying.  
Shifting margins  
You can secure a room for binding by shifting the margin of a page.  
Erasing edges  
You can copy the original without any edges or margins.  
1. Place the originals face up in the DADF. Or place a single original face  
2. Press Copy from the Main screen.  
3. Press the Image tab > Margin Shift  
4. Select Margin Shift option.  
1. Place a single original face down on the scanner glass. Or load the  
originals face up in the DADF. (See "Loading originals" on page 33.)  
2. Press Copy from the Main screen.  
3. Press the Image tab > Erase Edge.  
4. Select the appropriate option.  
Off: Disables this feature.  
Auto Center: Adjusts centers of the paper copy automatically. The  
original must be loaded on the scanner glass to use this feature. This  
option supports only the original is loaded on the scanner glass.  
Custom Margin: Adjusts the margin of the left and right, top and  
bottom as you want using arrows. This option supports both on the  
scanner glass or in DADF.  
Off: Disables this feature.  
Border Erase: Erases equal amounts on all edges of the copies.  
Small Original Erase: Erases 0.25" (6mm) from the edge of the  
copies. The original must be placed on the scanner glass to use this  
feature.  
5. Press OK.  
6. Press Start on the control panel to begin copying.  
Hole Punch Erase: Erases hole punch marks from the left edge of  
the copies.  
Book Center and Edges Erase: Erases shadows of a binding or  
book edge from the center and side edges of the copies. This feature  
only applies when you do copying a book. (See "Book copying" on  
Watermark copying  
You can copy the original with a watermark. For example, you can use it  
when you want to have large gray letters such as Top Secret or  
Confidential printed diagonally across the first page or all pages of the  
copy.  
If you have set the Book Copy option to Off, you cannot use Book  
Center and Edges Erase.  
5. Press OK.  
6. Press Start on the control panel to begin copying.  
Erasing background images  
This feature is helpful when copying originals containing color in the  
background, as in newspapers or catalogs.  
1. Load the originals, face up, in the DADF. Or place a single original face  
down on the scanner glass.  
1. Place the originals face up in the DADF. Or place a single original face  
2. Press Copy from the Main screen.  
3. Press the Image tab > Erase Background.  
4. Select the appropriate option.  
2. Press Copy from the Main screen.  
3. Select the tray in Paper Supply.  
4. Press the Advanced tab > WaterMark.  
5. Select WaterMark option.  
Off: Disables this feature.  
Auto: Optimizes the background.  
Enhance: The higher the number is, the more vivid the background  
is.  
Off: Disables this feature.  
Top Secret: Prints the original with Top Secret text.  
Confidential: Prints the original with Confidential text.  
Urgent: Prints the original with Urgent text.  
Draft: Prints the original with Draft text.  
Custom: The machine prints the original with the customized  
text.  
Erase: The higher the number is, the lighter the background is.  
5. Press OK.  
6. Press Start on the control panel to begin copying.  
6. Select 1st Page only, Size, Position, Darkness of options.  
7. Press OK.  
8. Press Start on the control panel to begin copying.  
Copying_ 48  
                 
Overlay copying  
If you scan and store the data such as format, you can copy the  
original with the previously stored data.  
1. Place the originals face up in the DADF. Or place a single original face  
2. Press Copy from the Main screen.  
3. Select the tray in Paper Supply.  
4. Press the Advanced tab > Overlay.  
5. Press List.  
6. Select a file name.  
7. Select a overlay option.  
New: Makes the new overlay. When the file name pops up, enter the  
file name.  
Detail: Shows information of the selected overlay.  
Edit: Modifies the name of the selected overlay.  
Delete: Deletes the selected overlay.  
Apply: Prints the originals with the selected overlay.  
Print: Prints the selected overlay.  
Cancel: Cancels overlay options you have selected.  
8. Press Start on the control panel to begin copying.  
If you have selected option New in step 7, the machine starts storing the  
new overlay by pressing the Start button.  
Auto crop copying  
The machine prints only the image of an original after cropping the blank  
parts like the margin.  
1. Place the originals face up in the DADF. Or place a single original face  
2. Press Copy from the Main screen.  
3. Select the tray in Paper Supply.  
4. Press the Advanced tab > Auto Crop.  
5. Press On to activate this feature.  
6. Press OK.  
7. Press Start on the control panel to begin copying.  
49 _Copying  
   
scanning  
Scanning with your machine lets you turn pictures and text into digital files that can be stored on your computer. Then you can fax  
or email the files, upload them to your website, or use them to create projects that you can print.  
This chapter gives you information about the scanning method and the different ways to send the scanned file to the destination.  
This chapter includes  
UNDERSTANDING THE SCAN SCREEN  
To use the scanning feature, press Scan on the Main screen. If the screen  
The maximum resolution that can be achieved depends upon various  
factors, including computer speed, available disk space, memory, the  
size of the image being scanned, and bit depth settings. Thus,  
depending on your system and what you are scanning, you may not  
be able to scan at certain resolutions, especially using enhanced  
resolution.  
displays an other menu, press (  
) to go to the Main screen.  
SCANNING BASICS  
Scanning with your machine lets you turn hard copy originals into digital  
files.  
There are two ways to scan originals, one is using the USB cable to directly  
connect the machine with your computer, and the other is using the network  
scan feature which scans and sends the document to a specific destination  
via the network.  
Samsung Scan Manager: You just walk to the machine with the  
originals and scan them from the control panel. Then, the scanned data  
will be stored in the connected computers My Documents folder. When  
you install all the softwares in the supplied CD, the Samsung Scan  
Manager is also automatically installed on your computer. This feature  
can be used via the local connection or the network connection. (See  
If the message asking Auth. ID and Password, it means the network  
administrator has set the authentication in SyncThru™ Web  
Press Scan to Email, Scan to PC or Scan to Server.  
TWAIN: TWAIN is the one of preset imaging applications. Scanning an  
image launches the selected application, enabling you to control the  
scanning process. See Software section. This feature can be used via  
the local connection or the network connection. See Software section.  
Samsung SmarThru Office: This feature is the accompanying  
software for your machine. You can use this program to scan images or  
documents, and this feature can be used via the local connection or the  
network connection. See Software section.  
WIA: WIA stands for Windows Images Acquisition. To use this feature  
your computer must be connected directly to the machine with a USB  
cable. See Software section.  
Email: You can send the scanned image as an attachment to an email.  
FTP: You can scan an image and upload it to an FTP server. (See  
SMB: You can scan an image and send it to a shared folder on an SMB  
Scan to Email: Scans and sends the scanned output to the  
Scan to PC: Scans and sends the scanned output to the destination  
with the Samsung Scan Manager program. (See "Using Samsung  
Scan to Server: Scans and sends the scanned output to the  
destination with SMB and FTP. (See "Scanning originals and  
Scanning_ 50  
     
Basic tab  
This section explains the Basic tab of Scan to Email and Scan to Server,  
and Scan to PC's basic screen.  
Scan to Email  
Duplex: Selects whether the machine scans on one side of the  
paper (1-Sided), both sides of the paper (2-Sided), or both sides of  
paper but the back side is rotated 180 degrees (2-Sided, Rotate Side  
2).  
Resolution: Selects the scanning resolution value.  
For details about how to use the Document Box, refer to the  
From: Sender's email address.  
To/Cc/Bcc: Recipients' addresses. Cc is for copies to an additional  
recipient and Bcc is for the same as Cc but without their name be  
displayed.  
Subject/Message: Subject and message of the email.  
Remove All: Erases everything in the input area.  
Address: Inputs the recipient's address just by pressing stored  
addresses. You can store frequently used email addresses from your  
computer using the SyncThru™ Web Service. (See "Storing email  
Back: Returns to the previous screen. If network authentication is  
enabled, the log off confirmation message pops-up and closes Scan  
to PC.  
Scan to Server  
Duplex: Selects whether the machine scans on one side of the  
paper (1 Sided), both sides of the paper (2 Sided), or both sides of  
paper but back is rotated 180 degrees (2 Sided, Rotate Side 2).  
Resolution: Selects the scanning resolution value.  
Saving to box: Sets the machine to save the originals to the  
document box for later use.  
For details about how to use the Document Box, refer to the  
Back: Returns to the previous screen. If the network authentication  
is enabled, the log off confirmation message popes up and closes  
Scan to Email.  
SMB: Sends the scanned file to SMB. Press SMB for that option.  
FTP: Sends the scanned file to FTP. Press FTP for that option.  
No.: Index number which you entered in SyncThru™ Web Service.  
Scan to PC  
If the authentication for network appears, you have to enter user name  
and password to enter the Scan to PC screen.  
Server: Alias name which you entered in SyncThru™ Web Service.  
Duplex: Selects whether the machine scans on one side of the  
paper (1 Sided), both sides of the paper (2 Sided), or both sides of  
paper but back is rotated 180 degrees (2 Sided, Rotate Side 2).  
Resolution: Selects the scanning resolution value.  
Saving to box: Sets the machine to save the originals to the  
document box for later use.  
For details about how to use the Document Box, refer to the  
Back: Returns to the previous screen.  
No.: Lists the number in order for application programs.  
Application: Shows the available application programs from your  
computer.  
Select: Moves to the application program you have selected.  
51 _Scanning  
   
Advanced tab  
Output tab  
Job Build: Allows you to scan several originals, and then send them  
Quality: Adjusts the display quality of the scan output. (See  
in a single email or send them to a server(s) at once. (See "Scanning  
Original Size: Sets the originals to a specific fixed size. (See  
File Format: Selects the file format of the scan output. (See "File  
Scan Preset: Automatically changes some scan options such as file  
format, resolution, and more. You can adjust options to fit each  
Back: Returns to the previous screen.  
Back: Returns to the previous screen.  
Image tab  
SCANNING ORIGINALS AND SENDING  
THROUGH EMAIL (SCAN TO EMAIL)  
You can scan the originals and email the scanned image to several  
destinations from the machine by email.  
Sending a scanned image to several destinations as  
an email attachment  
1. Place the originals face up in the DADF. Or you can use the scanner  
glass for one sheet of paper.  
Original Type: Selects whether the original is text or photo. (See  
Color Mode: Adjusts the color options of the scan output. If the  
original is color and you want to scan in color, press Color Mode.  
Darkness: Adjusts the degree of darkness of the scan output. Use  
left/right arrow to adjust the values. (See "Darkness" on page 58.)  
Erase Background: Erases backgrounds like paper patterns. (See  
Scan to Edge: Scans originals from edge-to-edge. (See "Scan to  
Back: Returns to the previous screen.  
2. Press Scan from the Main screen.  
If the authentication message shows, enter User Name and  
Password. This message shows only when the network  
administrator has set the authentication in SyncThru™ Web  
3. Press Scan to Email.  
4. Set the scan features in the Advanced, Image, or Output tabs. (See  
5. Press the Basic tab to enter the email address.  
Scanning_ 52  
                       
From: Sender's address. Touch From and then the keyboard pops  
up on the screen. Use the pop up keyboard to enter your email  
addresses. Or you can use Local and Global to enter the addresses  
To/Cc/Bcc: Recipient's email address manually with the pop up  
keyboard, or by pressing Local or Global. Local or Global  
addresses are pre-loaded address lists from your computer or the  
LDAP server which is configured at Web UI. (See "Global" on  
Off: Disables Job Build feature.  
On: Enables Job Build feature.  
Display Between Segments: After executing a segment, the job is  
paused with this screen is displayed. Then the user can select to  
keep sending email or stop.  
Delete: Deletes a segment.  
Delete All: Deletes all segments.  
Send All: Prints all segments.  
Add Segment: Adds a new segment.  
Cancel: Remove all segments in the list, and cancel the job.  
Subject: Title of email.  
Message: Enters the text which will be as the contents of the email.  
The maximum size is 1KB.  
6. Press Add Segment.  
7. Place the originals face up in the DADF or you can use the scanner  
To delete previously entered contents, press Remove All.  
glass for one sheet of paper.  
8. Press Start to start the scanning job.  
6. Set the scan quality by Duplex and Resolution.  
9. Repeat step 6 to step 8.  
Duplex: Sets this option for originals that are printed on one side  
only, or on both sides.  
Resolution: Sets the scanning resolution by pressing left/right  
arrows.  
As long as the hard drive capacity of your device remains, you can add  
segments without any restriction.  
10. After adding segments, press Send All.  
7. Press the Start button to scan and send the file.  
Setting up an email account  
While the machine is sending an email, you cannot perform a copy  
job or send a fax.  
To scan and send an image as an email attachment, you need to set up  
network parameters using SyncThru™ Web Service.  
1. Turn your networked computer on and open the web browser.  
2. Enter your machine's IP address as the URL in a browser.  
3. Click Go to access the SyncThru™ Web Service.  
Scanning and sending multiple documents in a  
single email  
You can make multiple scanning jobs into a single file. And, therefore, you  
can send the document with a single email.  
4. Log in to the SyncThru™ Web Service as an administrator. ( See  
When the machine enters power saver mode, the jobs in the segment  
list will be deleted to prevent accessing of the unexpected users.  
5. Click Settings > Network Settings > Outgoing Mail Server(SMTP).  
6. Enter the server address in dotted decimal notation or a host name.  
7. Enter the server port number, from 1 to 65535.  
The default port number is 25.  
8. Check the box next to SMTP Requires Authentication to require  
authentication.  
9. Enter the SMTP server login name and password.  
10. Click Apply.  
1. Press Scan from the Main screen.  
2. Press Scan to Email.  
3. Set the scan features in the Advanced, Image, or Output tabs. (See  
4. Press the Advanced tab > Job Build.  
5. Press On to enable the job build function.  
If the authentication method of SMTP server is POP3beforeSMTP,  
check the box next to SMTP Requires POP3 Before SMTP  
Authentication.  
a. Enter the IP address in dotted decimal notation or as a host name.  
b. Enter the server port number, from 1 to 65535. The default port  
number is 25.  
If SMTP server requires SSL/TLS connection, enable Secure E-mail  
Connection with SSL/TLS  
53 _Scanning  
   
Storing email addresses  
Entering email addresses by the address book  
Once you have stored the frequently used addresses into the address book,  
you can simply enter email addresses.  
There are two kinds of email addresses - Local on your machine's memory  
and Global on the LDAP server - which differ depending on where they are  
stored. Local is that email addresses are stored in the machine's memory,  
and Global is that email addresses are stored in the certain (LDAP) server.  
1. Press Local or Global from the Basic tab of Scan to Email.  
Through the SyncThru™ Web Service, you can easily enter and store  
email addresses from your computer.  
Individual  
1. Turn your networked computer on and open the web browser.  
2. Enter your machine's IP address as the URL in a browser.  
3. Click Go to access the SyncThru™ Web Service.  
4. Click Address Book.  
5. Click Add.  
6. When the Add E-Mail screen appears, select the Speed No. from 1  
to 500, enter User Name and E-mail Address.  
7. Click Apply.  
The search window shows.  
2. Press the initial alphabet key of the address you are looking for. Or  
8. Check if the emails are correctly stored and listed on your machine  
by pressing Local > the Individual tab.  
press Search to specify the search criteria.  
Group  
1. Access to the SyncThru™ Web Service from your computer.  
2. Make sure you have configured Individual Address Book.  
3. Click Address Book > E-mail Groups.  
4. Click Add Group.  
5. Enter Group Name and Speed No..  
6. Add Individual addresses to the e-mail group.  
7. Click Apply.  
8. Check if the email addresses are correctly stored and listed on your  
machine by pressing Group.  
Global  
When the search is completed, the screen displays the search results.  
3. Press From and enter your email address and press OK.  
Email addresses which are stored in Global in your machine are  
processed by the LDAP server.  
4. Select the address you want in the right-hand pane, and the press To,  
Cc or Bcc in the left-hand pane.  
5. Press Apply. Keep selecting addresses as many as you want.  
1. Turn your networked computer on and open the web browser.  
2. Enter your machine's IP address as the URL in a browser.  
3. Click Go to access the SyncThru™ Web Service.  
6. Press OK.  
4. Log in to the web site as an administrator. (See "Managing your  
5. Click Security > Network Security > External Authentication  
Server > LDAP Server.  
6. Enter LDAP server and Port.  
7. Enter optional information.  
8. Click Apply.  
The LDAP server administrator must store the email address data.  
The method of storing is varies depending on the server and the  
operating systems.  
Scanning_ 54  
               
Entering email addresses by the keyboard  
Set Scan Button tab  
When you press the input field in the From, To, Cc, or message input field,  
the keyboard shows on the display screen.  
The following explanation is the example that you are entering  
1. Press From in the Basic tab of the Scan to Email.  
2. Press a, b, c, d, e, f, g.  
3. Press @.  
Scan Destination  
4. Press a, b, c.  
5. Press . and press c, o, m.  
Available Destination List: Shows the list of applications currently  
linked to scanned images in the PC’s registry. Select the program  
you want to use and click the right arrow and add to Front Panel  
Destination List.  
Front Panel Destination List: Shows the list of applications to open  
scanned image.  
Add Application: Allows you to add application you want to use to  
Available Destination List.  
Remove Application: Allows you to remove an item added by the  
to enter contents in other fields, press  
keyboard.  
on the  
6. Press OK after finishing all the contents.  
USING SAMSUNG SCAN MANAGER  
user in the Available Destination List.  
File Format: Allows you to select the form of scanned data to be  
saved. You can choose among BMP, JPEG, PDF, and TIFF.  
If you have installed the printer driver, Samsung Scan Manager program  
has installed too. Start Samsung Scan Manager program to find out about  
this program information and the installed scan driver's condition. Through  
this program, you can change scan settings and add or delete the folders  
where scanned documents are saved in your computer.  
Scan Property  
Computer ID: Shows the ID of your computer.  
Save Location: Allows you to choose the location of the default  
saving folder.  
Resolution: Allows you to choose the scan resolution.  
Scan Color: Allows you to choose the scan color.  
Scan Size: Allows you to choose the scan size.  
ADF Duplex: Automatically scans both sides. If your model does not  
support this option, it will be grayed out.  
The Samsung Scan Manager program can only be used in the  
Window and Macintosh system. If you use the Macintosh, see  
Software section.  
The scan data can be encrypted to protect the contents from  
unauthorized access. You can enable the secured scan feature from  
the SyncThru™ Web Service. Log in to the SyncThru™ Web  
website" on page 99.) And click Setting > Machine Settings > Scan  
> Scan Security > PC Scan Security.  
Show Preview: Checking this box allows you to preview applied  
scan options. You can modify the options before scanning.  
Default: Allows you to go back to default options.  
1. From the Start menu, click Control Panel > Samsung Scan Manager.  
You can open Samsung Scan Manager by right clicking the  
Smart Panel icon in the Windows task bar and seleting Scan  
Manager.  
2. Select the appropriate machine from the Samsung Scan Manager  
window.  
3. Press Properties.  
4. The Set Scan Button tab allows you to change the saving destination  
and scan settings, add or delete application program, and format files.  
You can change the scanning machine by using the Change Port tab.  
(Local or Network)  
5. When setting is done, press OK.  
55 _Scanning  
     
14. Configure Scan folder creating policy, Filing Policy and File Name.  
15. Click Apply.  
Change Port tab  
Scanning and sending to SMB/FTP server  
1. Press Scan from the Main screen.  
If the authentication message shows, enter User Name and Password.  
This message shows only when the network administrator has set the  
authentication in SyncThru™ Web Service. (See "Managing your  
2. Press Scan to Server.  
3. Place the originals face up in the DADF. Or you can place a single  
original document face down on the scanner glass.  
4. Adjust the document settings in the Image tab.  
5. Select Duplex and Resolution in the Basic tab.  
6. Press Scan to Server to show the SMB server list you entered in the  
SyncThru™ Web Service.  
Local Scanner  
Select when your machine is connected via USB or LPT port.  
Network Scanner  
Select when your machine is connected via network port.  
Auto detection on the network: Automatically detects your  
machine.  
IP address: Enter in your machine’s IP address to detect your  
machine.  
7. Select the destination SMB server.  
SCANNING ORIGINALS AND SENDING VIA SMB/  
FTP (SCAN TO SERVER)  
You can select up to five destinations using both of SMB or FTP  
servers.  
8. Press Start on the control panel.  
You can scan an image and send it to a server via the SMB or FTP.  
The machine begins scanning and then sends the scanned image to the  
specified server.  
Preparation for scanning to SMB/FTP  
Select the folder and share it with the machine in order to receive the  
scanned file.  
Scanning and sending multiple documents to SMB/  
FTP server(s) at once  
The next steps are for SMB server setting using SyncThru™ Web  
Service, and the setting for FTP server is the same as SMB. Apply the  
same steps for setting up the FTP server.  
You can make multiple scanning jobs into a single file. And, therefore, you  
can send the document with a single access to the server.  
When the machine enters power saver mode, the jobs in the segment  
list will be deleted to prevent accessing of the unexpected users.  
1. Turn your networked computer on and open the web browser.  
2. Enter your machine's IP address as the URL in a browser.  
3. Click Go to access the SyncThru™ Web Service.  
4. Click Address Book.  
1. Press Scan from the Main screen.  
2. Press Scan to Server.  
3. Set the scan features in the Advanced, Image, or Output tabs. (See  
5. Click Add.  
6. Enter a name and speed number.  
4. Press the Advanced tab > Job Build.  
7. Check Add SMB.  
8. Enter the server address in dotted decimal notation or a host name.  
9. Enter the server port number, from 1 to 65535. The default port number  
is 139.  
10. If you want to allow the unauthorized person’s access to SMB server,  
check Anonymous. By default, this is unchecked.  
11. Enter the login name and password.  
12. Enter the domain name of the SMB server.  
13. Enter the path of shared folder in the SMB server for storing the scanned  
images.  
Scanning_ 56  
                   
5. Press On to enable job build function.  
Resolution  
You can adjust document resolution.  
Press Scan > Scan to Email (Or Scan to Server) > the Basic tab >  
Resolution. Use left/right arrows to toggle the values. The higher value you  
select the clear result you get. But the scanning time may take longer.  
100, 200, 300 dpi resolution is available only when Color Mode is set to  
Color or Gray. The following table shows detailed information feature,  
resolution and file format options.  
FEATURE  
RESOLUTION (DPI)  
FILE FORMAT  
Off: Disables Job Build feature.  
On: Enables Job Build feature.  
Display Between Segments: After executing a segment, the job is  
paused with this screen is displayed. Then the user can select to  
keep sending email or stop.  
Delete: Deletes a segment.  
Delete All: Deletes all segments.  
Send All: Prints all segments.  
Add Segment: Adds a new segment.  
Cancel: Remove all segments in the list, and cancel the job.  
Scan to Email  
100, 200, 300, 400,  
600  
PDF, Single-Page TIFF,  
Multi-Page TIFF, JPEG  
Scan to PC  
100, 200, 300, 400,  
600  
PDF, TIFF, JPEG  
Scan to Server  
100, 200, 300, 400,  
600  
PDF, Single-Page TIFF,  
Multi-Page TIFF, JPEG  
6. Press Add Segment.  
7. Place the originals face up in the DADF or you can use the scanner  
Original Size  
glass for one sheet of paper.  
8. Press Start to start the scanning job.  
9. Repeat step 6 to step 8.  
You can specify the scanning area on the originals by selecting the pre-  
defined size, or putting in the margin value or Auto. If you set this option to  
Auto, the machine senses and determines the size of the original.  
Press Scan > Scan to Email (Or Scan to Server) > the Advanced tab >  
Original Size. Use up/down arrows to go to the next screen. Select the  
appropriate option and press OK.  
As long as space remains on your device's hard drive, you can add  
segments without any restriction.  
10. After adding segments, press Send All.  
CHANGING THE SCAN FEATURE SETTINGS  
This part explains how to adjust the document settings for each scan job,  
such as resolution, duplex, original size, type, color mode, darkness, and  
more. The options you change will be maintained for a certain time, but after  
that period, the options will be reset to default values.  
Duplex  
This feature especially applies when the original documents to be scanned  
are two-sided. You can select whether the machine scans only one side of  
the paper or both sides of the paper.  
Press Scan > Scan to Email (Or Scan to Server) > the Basic tab >  
Duplex. Use left/right arrows to toggle the values.  
1 Sided: For originals that are printed on one side only.  
2 Sided: For originals that are printed on both sides.  
2 Sided, Rotate Side 2: For originals that are printed on both sides.  
But the back is rotated 180 degrees.  
To use 2 Sided and 2 Sided, Rotate Side 2, you have to load the  
originals on the DADF. Because, if the machine can not detect the  
original on DADF, automatically changes the option to 1 Sided.  
57 _Scanning  
             
Original Type  
You can set the original document type in order to enhance the quality of a  
document being scanned.  
Darkness  
You can select the degree of darkness of the scanned output. If your  
original document is light or faded, press the right arrow to make the output  
darker.  
Press Scan > Scan to Email (Or Scan to Server) > the Image tab >  
Original Type. Select the appropriate option and press OK.  
Press Scan > Scan to Email (Or Scan to Server) > the Image tab >  
Darkness. Press right arrow to enhance the darkness degree then, press  
OK.  
Erase Background  
You can lighten, reduce or deletes the dark background from scanning  
colored paper or newspaper originals.  
Text: For originals that have text or line art.  
Text/Photo: For originals that have both text and photographs  
together.  
Press Scan > Scan to Email (Or Scan to Server) > the Image tab > Erase  
Background. Select the appropriate option and press OK.  
Photo: For originals that are continuous tone photographs.  
Off: Disables this feature.  
Auto: Optimizes the background.  
Enhance: The higher the number is, the more vivid the background  
is.  
Color Mode  
Use this option to scan the original in Mono, Gray or Color mode.  
Erase: The higher the number is, the lighter the background is.  
Press Scan > Scan to Email (Or Scan to Server) > the Image tab > Color  
Mode. Select the appropriate option and press OK.  
Scan to Edge  
You can set the machine to scan full size of a page as it is. Usually, the  
machine scans a page except edges, which means the margin, especially  
when you do the copy job with certain sized paper in the tray. But if you  
scan and sent it right away via the network, as the file, the machine does not  
need to exclude the edges from the originals.  
Press Scan > Scan to Email (Or Scan to Server) > the Image tab > Scan  
to Edge. Select On and press OK.  
Color: Uses color to display an image. 24 bits per pixel, 8 bits for  
each RGB, is used for 1 pixel.  
Gray: Uses the black gradation to display an image. 8 bits per pixel.  
Quality  
You can use this option to produce a high quality document. Higher quality  
you select a larger file size you get.  
Press Scan > Scan to Email (Or Scan to Server) > the Output tab >  
Quality.  
Mono: Displays an image in black and white. 1 bit per pixel.  
When you set Color Mode to Mono, the Quality option is grayed out.  
The file format JPEG cannot be selected if Mono has been selected  
for Color Mode.  
Scanning_ 58  
                         
4. Select an encryption level.  
File Format  
Low (RC4, 40 bits): Recommended for Acrobat 3.0 or later version.  
High (RC4, 128 bits): Recommended for Acrobat 5.0 or later  
version.  
You can select the file format before you proceed with the scanning job.  
Press Scan > Scan to Email (Or Scan to Server) > the Output tab > File  
Format.  
High (AES, 128 bits): Recommended for Acrobat 7.0 or later  
version.  
5. Enter the Owner Password to get a whole right about the PDF.  
6. Enter the User Password to get an Access Permission set by the  
Access Permission menu below.  
7. Set the Access Permission in printing or modifying. This configuration  
will affect the users accessed with the User Password.  
8. Check Extract text and graphics to give users permission to extract  
text or graphics.  
9. Press OK.  
PDF: Scans originals in PDF format.  
You can add a Digital Signature to the PDF with the certification. To  
add the Digital Signature, you have to create the certification from  
the SyncThru™ Web Service. Log in to the SyncThru™ Web  
website" on page 99.) And click Setting > Machine Settings > Scan  
> Scan Security > Digital Signature in PDF.The Digital Signature  
can be used in the Scan to Server feature.  
Scan Preset  
This feature allows you to use optimized settings for your specific scan job.  
Press Scan > Scan to Email (Or Scan to Server) > the Output tab > Scan  
Preset.  
You also can create a PDF Encryption that is encrypted to protect  
the contents from unauthorized access. You can set the encryption  
level, password, and access permission such as reading, printing, or  
modifying, etc. The PDF Encryption can be used in the Scan to  
Single-Page TIFF: Scans originals in TIFF (Tagged Image File  
Format), but several originals are scanned as one file.  
Multi-Page TIFF: Scans the originals in TIFF (Tagged Image File  
Format), and several originals are scanned as several file.  
JPEG: Scans original in JPEG format.  
Sharing and Printing: Produces a small-sized file for normal quality  
documents.  
High Quality Printing: Set this option for high quality output with the  
largest file size.  
Archival Record: For the electronic file which is of the smallest file  
size of the output.  
OCR: Produces scanned output for OCR software. You can expect  
the highest quality images.  
Simple Scan: Used for a simple document with text only. The file  
size of output is small.  
XPS: Scans original in XPS format.  
The file format JPEG cannot be selected if Mono has been  
selected for Color Mode.  
The file format XPS cannot be showed in the Scan to PC mode.  
PDF Encryption  
To encrypt your PDF files, you need to set up parameters for the encryption  
level, password, and access permission, etc.  
Custom: Applies the current scan settings that you have chosen.  
The PDF Encryption can be used in the Scan to Server feature.  
1. Press Scan > Scan to Server > the Output tab > File Format > PDF.  
2. Press PDF Encryption.  
3. Press On.  
59 _Scanning  
               
basic printing  
This chapter explains common printing tasks.  
This chapter includes:  
PRINTING A DOCUMENT  
Your machine allows you to print from various Windows, Macintosh, or  
Linux applications. The exact steps for printing a document may vary  
depending on the application you use.  
For details about printing, see Software section.  
CANCELING A PRINT JOB  
If the print job is waiting in a print queue or print spooler, such as the printer  
group in Windows, delete the job as follows:  
1. Click the Windows Start menu.  
2. For Windows 2000, select Settings and then Printers.  
For Windows XP/2003, select Printers and Faxes.  
For Windows Vista/2008, select Control Panel > Hardware and Sound  
> Printers.  
For Windows 7, select Control Panel > Hardware and Sound >  
Devices and Printers.  
For Windows Server 2008 R2, select Control Panel > Hardware >  
Devices and Printers.  
3. For Windows 2000, XP, 2003, 2008 and Vista, double-click your  
machine.  
4. For Windows 7 and Windows Server 2008 R2, right click your printer  
icon > context menus > See what’ s printing.  
5. From the Document menu, select Cancel.  
You can also access this window by simply double-clicking the printer  
icon at the bottom right corner of the Windows desktop.  
You can also cancel the current job by pressing Stop on the control panel.  
Basic printing_ 60  
     
faxing (optional)  
This chapter gives you information about using your machine as a fax machine.  
This chapter includes:  
UNDERSTANDING THE FAX SCREEN  
To use the fax feature, press Fax on the Main screen. If the screen displays  
You cannot use this machine as a fax via the internet phone. For  
more information ask the internet service provider.  
You may experience restrictions on color fax transmmission, slower  
fax transmmission, poor fax quality and communication failures when  
faxing over VoIP network. Contact you local network administrator or  
Internet Service Provider for more details.  
an other menu, press (  
) to go to the Main screen.  
To use advanced features of the fax, press Machine Setup on the  
control panel and Admin Setting > Setup > Fax Setup. (See "Fax  
We recommend you to use traditional analog phone services  
(PSTN: public switched telephone network) when connecting  
telephone lines to use Fax. If you use other Internet services (DSL,  
ISDN, VolP), you can improve the connection quality by using the  
Micro-filter. The Micro-filter eliminates unnecessary noise signals  
and improves connection quality or Internet quality. Since the DSL  
Micro-filter is not provided with the machine, contact your Internet  
Service provider for use on DSL Micro-filter.  
If the optional fax feature is not installed the fax icon will not appear on  
the Main screen.  
Basic tab  
1 Line port  
2 Micro filter  
3 DSL modem/Telephone line  
PREPARING TO FAX  
Before you send or receive a fax, you need to connect the supplied line cord  
to the wall jack. Refer to the Quick Install Guide how to make a connection.  
The method of making a telephone connection is varies from one country to  
another.  
Fax number input area: Shows the recipient's fax number using the  
number keypad on the control panel. If you configured the phone  
book, press Individual or Group. (See "Setting up a fax  
If you want to add fax feature to the machine, check the option lists  
(See "Fax option kit" on page 121.) and contact the purchasing point  
to order. When you purchase a fax kit, install the kit by following the  
steps described in the Fax Kit Setup Guide which is enclosed in the kit.  
After installing the fax kit, set the machine to use this feature. (See  
Add No.: Lets you add more destinations.  
: Deletes the last digit entered.  
:
Removes all digits of the selected entry.  
Remove: Removes the selected fax number entry.  
Remove All: Removes all the fax numbers in the input area.  
Address: Picks up the frequently used fax numbers directly from  
your machine or from SyncThru™ Web Service. (See "Setting up a  
61 _Faxing (Optional)  
           
Duplex: Selects whether the machine send faxes one side of the  
original, both sides of the original.  
Resolution: Adjusts the resolution options.  
Saving to box: Sets the machine to save the originals to the  
document box for later use.  
Color Mode: Selects whether the user sends the fax in mono or  
Back: Returns to the Basic tab.  
SENDING A FAX  
For details about how to use the Document Box, refer to the  
This part explains how to send a fax, and the special methods of  
transmission.  
Advanced tab  
When you place the originals, you can use either the DADF or the  
are placed on both the DADF and the scanner glass, the machine will  
read the originals on the DADF first, which has higher priority in  
scanning.  
Setting the fax header  
In some countries, you are required by law to indicate your fax number on  
any fax you send.  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
2. Press Admin Setting. When the login message pops up, enter  
Job Build: Allows you to send several fax jobs in a single fax  
Original Size: Selects the size of the original document. Press OK to  
update current setting.  
3. Press the Setup tab > Fax Setup > Machine ID & Fax No.  
4. Touch the input area to enter the machine name and your fax number.  
5. Press OK.  
Sending a fax  
1. Press Fax from the Main screen.  
2. Place the originals face up in the DADF.  
Delay Send: Sets the machine to send a fax at a later time without  
Priority Send: Sends an urgent fax before reserved operations.  
Polling: Used when the receiver requests the document to be faxed  
remotely at sender's absence or vice versa. In order to use the  
polling function, the originals must be previously stored in the  
Mailbox: Used to store a received fax or originals in the machine  
memory which are ready to be polled. You can use a mailbox on the  
same machine you are using, or the one on a remote machine. Each  
mailbox has a corresponding mailbox number, name and password.  
Back: Returns to the Basic tab.  
Image tab  
3. Adjust the document settings in the Image tab.  
4. Select Duplex and Resolution options in the Basic tab.  
If the originals are printed on both sides of the paper, select 2  
Sided with left/right arrows in the Duplex feature.  
5. When the cursor is blinking in the input line, enter the fax number using  
the number keypad on the control panel. Or use Address on the right  
side of the screen, if you have stored frequently used fax numbers.  
Original Type: Enhances the fax quality based on the type of the  
original document being scanned. (See "Original Type" on page 65.)  
Darkness: Adjusts the level of lightness or darkness of the fax. (See  
Erase Background: Reduces dark backgrounds or paper patterns  
Faxing (Optional)_ 62  
                   
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
2. Select Admin Setting. When the login message pops up, then enter  
3. Press the Setup tab > Fax Setup.  
4. Press Redial.  
5. Select Redial Term and Redial Times.  
6. To add a number, press Add No..  
7. Press Start on the control panel. The machine starts to scan and send a  
fax to destinations.  
When you want to cancel a fax job, press Stop before the machine  
start transmission. Or press the Job Status button, and select the  
job you want to delete, press Delete.  
If you used the scanner glass, the machine shows the message  
asking to place another page.  
While the machine is sending a fax, you can not send an email at  
6. Press OK.  
Redialing the last number  
1. Press Fax from the Main screen.  
2. Adjust the document settings in the Image tab.  
3. Place the originals face up into the DADF.  
4. Press the Redial/Pause button on the control panel to show ten recent  
Sending a fax manually (On Hook Dial)  
1. Press Fax from the Main screen.  
2. Place the originals face up into the DADF.  
fax numbers.  
5. Select a fax number in the list and press OK.  
The machine automatically begins to send.  
Delaying a fax transmission  
You can set your machine to send a fax at a later time when you will not be  
present.  
1. Press Fax from the Main screen.  
2. Place the originals face up in the DADF.  
3. Adjust the document settings in the Image tab and the Basic tab.  
4. Press the Advanced tab > Delay Send.  
5. Press On.  
6. Enter Job Name using the keyboard on the display, select Start Time  
with left/right arrows.  
3. Adjust the document settings in the Image tab.  
4. Select Duplex and Resolution options in the Basic tab.  
5. Press On Hook Dial on the control panel.  
6. Enter a fax number using the number keypad on the control panel.  
If the number is which you have dialed recently, press the Redial/  
Pause button on the control panel to show ten recent fax numbers  
and select a fax number.  
7. Press Start when you hear a high-pitched fax signal from the remote fax  
machine.  
Color faxes are only supported when faxes are sent manually. (See  
Automatic resending  
When the number you have dialed is busy or there is no answer, the  
machine automatically redials the number.  
If you do not enter Job Name, the machine assigns the job name as  
'Fax Send Job xxx'. 'xxx' number are set in order.  
To change the time interval between redials and/or the number of redial  
attempts, refer to the next following steps.  
63 _Faxing (Optional)  
                 
8. Repeat step 5 to step 7.  
Start Time is the specific time you want the fax to be sent. You can set  
Start Time on a 24 hour basis and 15 minutes later than the current  
time. For example, if it is 1:00, then you can set the time starting from  
1:15. If the set time is incorrect, the warning message will appear and  
the machine resets it to the current time.  
As long as space remains on your device's hard drive, you can add  
segments without any restriction.  
9. After adding segments, press Send All.  
7. Press OK to start storing the scanned original data into memory.  
RECEIVING A FAX  
To cancel delaying a fax, press Off before sending is activated.  
This section explains how to receive a fax, and the special receiving  
methods available.  
Sending a priority fax  
Changing the receive modes  
This function is used when a high priority fax need to be sent ahead of  
reserved operations. The original is scanned into memory and immediately  
transmitted when the current operation is finished. In addition, priority  
transmission will interrupt a sending to multiple destinations between  
stations (example, when the transmission to station A ends, before  
transmission to station B begins) or between redial attempts.  
Your machine is preset to Fax mode at the factory. When you receive a fax,  
the machine answers the call on a specified number of rings and  
automatically receives the fax. But if you want to change the Fax mode to  
another mode, refer to next steps.  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
1. Press Fax from the Main screen.  
2. Place the originals face up in the DADF.  
3. Adjust the document settings in the Image tab and the Basic tab.  
4. Press the Advanced tab > Priority Send.  
5. Press On.  
2. Select Admin Setting. When the login message pops up, then enter  
3. Press the Setup tab > Fax Setup > Fax Initial Setup > Receive Mode.  
4. Select the option.  
Telephone: Receives a fax by pressing On Hook Dial and then  
Start.  
Fax: Answers an incoming fax call and immediately goes into the fax  
reception mode.  
Answering Machine/Fax: Is for when an answering machine  
attached to your machine. Your machine answers an incoming call,  
and the caller can leave a message on the answering machine. If the  
fax machine senses a fax tone on the line, the machine automatically  
switches to Fax mode to receive the fax.  
6. Press OK.  
7. Press Start to start the urgent fax job.  
Sending multiple faxes in a single transmission  
You can send multiple fax jobs in a single transmission.  
When the machine enters power saver mode, the jobs in the segment  
list will be deleted to prevent accessing by the unexpected users.  
1. Press Fax from the Main screen.  
2. Adjust the document settings in the Image tab and the Basic tab.  
3. Press the Advanced tab > Job Build.  
5. Press OK.  
When the memory is full, the machine can no longer receive any  
incoming fax. Secure free memory to resume by removing data stored  
in the memory.  
4. Press On to enable the job build function.  
Receiving manually in Telephone mode  
You can receive a fax call by pressing On Hook Dial and then pressing  
Start when you hear a fax tone from the remote machine. The machine  
begins receiving a fax.  
Receiving automatically in Answering Machine/Fax  
mode  
To use this mode, you must attache an answering machine to the EXT  
socket on the back of your machine. (See "Rear view" on page 18.)  
If the caller leaves a message, the answering machine stores the message  
as it would normally. If your machine detects a fax tone on the line, it  
automatically starts to receive the fax.  
Off: Disables Job Build feature.  
On: Enables Job Build feature.  
Display Between Segments: After executing a segment, the job is  
paused with this screen is displayed. Then user can select to keep  
sending fax or stop.  
Delete: Deletes a segment.  
Delete All: Deletes all segments.  
Send All: Prints all segments.  
Add Segment: Adds a new segment.  
Cancel: Remove all segments in the list, and cancel the job.  
If you have set your machine to this mode and your answering  
machine is switched off, or no answering machine is connected to  
EXT socket, your machine automatically goes into Fax mode after  
a predefined number of rings.  
If your answering machine has a user-selectable ring counter, set  
the machine to answer incoming calls within 1 ring.  
If you are in Telephone mode when the answering machine is  
connected to your machine, you must switch off the answering  
machine, or the outgoing message from the answering machine  
will interrupt your phone conversation.  
5. Press Add Segment.  
6. Place the originals face up in the DADF.  
7. Press Start to start scanning a segment for fax job.  
While the machine is receiving a fax, you can not do the copy job.  
Faxing (Optional)_ 64  
                     
Receiving faxes manually using an extension  
telephone  
This feature works best when you are using an extension telephone  
connected to the EXT socket on the back of your machine. You can receive  
a fax from someone you are talking to on the extension telephone, without  
going to the fax machine.  
Duplex  
This function is especially intended for two-sided originals. You can select  
whether the machine sends the fax on one side or both sides of the paper.  
Load the originals onto the DADF to use this function.  
Press Fax > the Basic tab > Duplex. Use left/right arrows to toggle the  
value.  
When you receive a call on the extension phone and hear fax tones, press  
the keys  
Press the buttons slowly in sequence. If you still hear the fax tone from the  
remote machine, try pressing once again.  
To change the to, for example, , follow the next steps.  
9
on the extension phone. The machine receives the fax.  
9
1 Sided: Is for the originals that are printed on one side only.  
2 Sided: Is for the originals that are printed on both sides.  
9
3
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
Resolution  
2. Select Admin Setting. When the login message pops up, then enter  
Changing the resolution setting affects the appearance of the received  
document.  
3. Press the Setup tab > Fax Setup > Receive Start Code.  
4. Select On.  
Press Fax > the Basic tab > Resolution. Use left/right arrows to toggle the  
values.  
5. Press left/right arrows to display number 9.  
Standard: Usually recommended for originals with text. This option  
will reduce the transmission time.  
Fine: Recommended for the originals containing with small  
characters, thin lines, or text that was printed using a dot-matrix  
printer.  
6. Press OK.  
Super Fine: Recommended for originals containing with extremely  
fine detail, this option is enabled only if the receiving machine also  
supports a Super Fine resolution.  
Receiving in secure receiving mode  
You may need to prevent your received faxes from being accessed by  
unauthorized people. You can turn on secure receiving mode to restrict  
printing of received faxes when the machine is unattended. In secure  
receiving mode, all incoming faxes go into memory.  
For memory transmission, Super Fine mode is not available. The  
resolution setting is automatically changed to Fine.  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
Original Type  
You can set the original document type to enhance the quality of a  
document being scanned.  
2. Select Admin Setting. When the login message pops up, then enter  
Press Fax > the Image tab > Original Type. Select the appropriate option  
on the screen and press OK.  
3. Press the Setup tab > Fax Setup > Secure Receive.  
4. Select On.  
5. Enter passcode with 4 digit number using the number keypad on the  
Text: For originals with text or line art.  
Text/Photo: For originals with both text and photographs together.  
Photo: For originals that are continuous tone photographs.  
control panel.  
To deactivate the Secure Receive feature, press Off. In this case, the  
received fax will be printed out.  
Darkness  
You can select the degree of darkness of the original document.  
Receiving faxes in memory  
Press Fax > the Image tab > Darkness. Press the right arrow to enhance  
the darkness degree and press OK.  
Since your machine is a multi-tasking device, it can receive faxes while you  
are making copies or printing. If you receive a fax while you are copying or  
printing, your machine stores incoming faxes in its memory. Then, as soon  
as you finish copying or printing, the machine automatically prints the fax.  
ADJUSTING THE DOCUMENT SETTINGS  
Before sending a fax, you can adjust the document settings, such as  
resolution, darkness, color, duplex and so forth. Refer to explanation of this  
section.  
Erase Background  
You can lighten, reduce or delete the dark backgrounds from scanned  
colored paper or newspaper originals.  
Press Fax > the Image tab > Erase Background. Select the appropriate  
option and press OK.  
The document setting herein is for only current job. If you want to  
change the default setting on document settings, refer to Admin  
Setting > General tab > Default Settings. (See "General settings" on  
Off: Disables this feature.  
Auto: Optimizes the background.  
65 _Faxing (Optional)  
                                     
Enhance: The higher the number is, the more vivid the background  
3. Enter the name of the fax number in the ID field with the pop up  
keyboard, and the fax number in the Fax No. area using the number  
keypad on the control panel.  
is.  
Erase: The higher the number is, the lighter the background is.  
Erase Background is disabled if the Original Type is set to Photo.  
Color Mode  
You can transmit a fax in color using this feature. But this feature only  
applies when you send a fax using On Hook Dial on the control panel.  
Press Fax > the Image tab > Color Mode. Select option and OK.  
Mono: Transmits a fax in black and white.  
Color: Transmits a fax in color.  
ID: Enters the name.  
Color Mode faxes are only supported when faxes are sent manually.  
Speed Dial No.: Is automatically filled with the first free number. If  
you want to assign to a different number, use left/right arrows.  
Fax No.: Enters a fax numbers, only the numbers, with the area  
code if necessary.  
SETTING UP A FAX PHONEBOOK  
Use this feature to store destination names, fax numbers and transmission  
4. Press OK.  
settings in your machine. There are two options, Individual and Group.  
Storing Group fax numbers (Group No.)  
1. Press Fax > the Basic tab > Group.  
2. Press New.  
Individual: Stores up to 500 fax numbers. And the fax numbers which  
are stored in Individual work as Speed Dial No..  
3. Press the input area in Group Dial ID, then the keyboard pops up, enter  
the name.  
Group: Makes groups when you frequently send the same document to  
several destinations. You can store up to 100 group dial numbers.  
Entries stored here will be available for selection within the sending list  
on the Basic tab of Fax. Dialing Group can be also setup comprising of  
many Individual entries.  
4. Select Group Dial No. with left/right arrows.  
The fax numbers, which are stored in Individual, work as Speed Dial No..  
Storing individual fax numbers (Speed Dial No.)  
1. Press Fax > the Basic tab > Individual.  
Group Dial ID: Enters the group name.  
Group Dial No.: Is automatically filled with the first free number. If  
you want to assign to a different number, use left/right arrows.  
5. Press OK.  
6. Select an entry from Speed Dial List, and press Add. Repeat this step  
until you added entries you need.  
Edit: Changes the ID, Speed Dial No., and Fax No..  
New: Creates the new Speed Dial No..  
Delete: Deletes the selected Speed Dial No..  
Search: Searches the fax number which currently stored in  
Individual phonebook. When the keyboard pops up, enter ID.  
Detail: Shows ID, Fax No. and Included group information if it is  
Make sure the selected Speed Dial List is copied to the left pane,  
Group list.  
7. Press OK to save the numbers.  
Apply: Inputs the selected fax number to the sending fax number list  
in the Basic tab.  
Cancel: Cancels the current job and goes to the previous screen.  
2. Press New.  
Faxing (Optional)_ 66  
                   
Setting up a fax phonebook using SyncThru™ Web  
Service  
You can store fax numbers conveniently from the networked computer  
using SyncThru™ Web Service.  
Individual  
1. Open the web browser in your computer.  
2. Enter IP address of your machine, then SyncThru™ Web Service  
shows.  
(Example. http://123.123.123.123)  
3. Press Address Book > Individual.  
4. Press Add.  
5. Press the input area then the pop up keyboard, enter Passcode (The  
four-digit number which you have to inform the receiver). If you do not  
want to set Passcode, enter number 0000 here. Then you can store,  
delete, print and receive a fax for polling without any passcode.  
5. Enter Name, Speed No., and Fax Number.  
6. Press Apply.  
Speed Dial numbers can be imported from an *.csv file.  
If you want to use the Mailbox, refer to Storing the originals in the  
Group  
1. Open the web browser in your computer.  
2. Enter IP address of your machine, then SyncThru™ Web Service  
6. Select the Delete On Poll option. If you select Off, the sent fax data will  
be remained in the machine’s memory even after it’s printing. If you  
select On, the fax data will be deleted at the printing point.  
shows.  
7. Press OK to start to store the originals into memory for polling.  
(Example. http://123.123.123.123)  
8. Give the Passcode to the receiver.  
3. Press Address Book > Group.  
4. Press Add Group.  
Printing (Deleting) the polling document  
1. Press Fax from the Main screen.  
2. Press the Advanced tab > Polling > Print (or Delete).  
3. Enter Passcode  
5. Enter Group Name and Speed No..  
6. Add individual ddresses to the fax group.  
7. Press Apply.  
4. Press OK.  
USING THE POLLING OPTION  
Polling a remote fax  
This option allows you to retrieve (poll) a fax which is stored in the remote  
machine.  
Polling is used when one fax machine requests another to send a  
document. This is useful when the person with the original document is not  
in the office. The person who wants to receive the document, calls the  
machine holding where the original is stored and requests that the  
document be sent. In other words, it "polls" the machine holding that has the  
original.  
1. Press Fax from the Main screen.  
2. Press the Advanced tab > Polling > Poll from Remote.  
To use this feature, both the sender and receiver must have the polling  
feature.  
The polling process is as follows:  
1. Sender stores the originals in the machine. (See "Storing the originals  
2. Sender gives the Passcode to the receiver.  
3. Receiver dials the fax number and enters the Passcode when  
4. Receiver presses Start to receive the stored fax.  
Storing the originals for polling  
1. Press Fax from the Main screen.  
2. Place the originals face up in the DADF. Or you can use the scanner  
Your can use Delay Poll From Remote to poll the fax at a specific  
time within 24 hours.  
3. Enter Passcode and Destination Fax No using the number keypad on  
the control panel. You have to be informed Passcode from sender with  
the remote fax machine.  
glass with a single original document, face down.  
3. Adjust the document settings in the Image tab and the Basic tab.  
4. Press the Advanced tab > Polling > Store.  
4. Press OK.  
67 _Faxing (Optional)  
                     
Polling from a remote Mailbox  
This option allows you to retrieve (poll) a fax which is stored in the Mailbox  
of on the remote machine. Before you start polling, you must be informed of  
Mailbox No. and Passcode from the sender. (See "Using Mailbox" on  
1. Press Fax from the Main screen.  
2. Press the Advanced tab > Mailbox > Poll from Remote.  
8. Press Edit Mailbox.  
3. Enter Remote Fax No, Mailbox No., and Passcode. All these field are  
filled with information from the sender.  
9. Press Mailbox ID and enter ID with number keypad on the control panel.  
Up to 20 numbers you can enter.  
10. Enter Mailbox Name with the pop up keyboard. It can be either alphabet  
or number up to 20 digits.  
11. Enter Mailbox Passcode with the numeric keypad on the control panel.  
If you set Mailbox Passcode to number 0000, then the machine  
does not ask passcode for using Mailbox, such as storing,  
deleting, printing, receiving.  
You can use Delay Poll From Remote to poll a fax from the  
remote machine's Mailbox at certain time within 24 hours.  
12. Set Notification option to On, if you want to be notified when a fax is  
received into Mailbox.  
13. Press OK.  
4. Press OK.  
Storing originals in Mailbox  
Since you created the mailbox, you can store originals in it.  
USING MAILBOX  
You can store the original data in Mailbox, since you are absent and the  
receiver need to be retrieve a fax from you. This feature allows you to  
program up to 15 individual Mailbox. Before you store the originals, the  
Mailbox must be created.  
1. Press Fax from the Main screen.  
2. Place the originals face up in the DADF. Or you can use the scanner  
glass with a single original document faced down.  
3. Adjust the document settings in the Image tab and the Basic tab.  
Creating Mailbox  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
2. Select Admin Setting. When the login message pops up, then enter the  
password and press OK.  
3. Press the Setup tab > Fax Setup.  
4. Press the down arrow to scroll down, if necessary.  
5. Press Mailbox Setup.  
6. Press Mailbox Configuration. Then the screen displays Mailbox List.  
7. Select a Mailbox on the Mailbox List.  
Faxing (Optional)_ 68  
                         
4. Press the Advanced tab > Mailbox > Store.  
5. Enter Remote Fax No, Mailbox No., and Passcode. All these field are  
filled with information from the receiver.  
5. Enter Mailbox No. and Passcode which are set from Creating Mailbox  
6. Press OK.  
in page 68.  
PRINTING A REPORT AFTER SENDING A FAX  
You can set the machine to print a report whether a fax transmission is  
successfully completed or not.  
The detailed information is available in advanced setup part. (See  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
2. Press Admin Setting. When the login message pops up, enter  
3. Press the Print/Report tab > Report > Fax Report > Fax Send Report.  
4. Press On.  
6. Press OK.  
Deleting the data in a specific Mailbox  
Press Fax > the Advanced tab > Mailbox > Delete, enter  
Mailbox No. and Passcode, and then press OK. When the  
confirmation window appears, press Yes to complete the job.  
Printing a Mailbox  
Press Fax > the Advanced tab > Mailbox > Print, enter  
Mailbox No. and Passcode, and press OK.  
Faxing to a remote Mailbox  
To fax and store the originals in a recipient's Mailbox in this machine, you  
can use the Send to Remote feature.  
1. Press Fax from the Main screen.  
2. Place the originals face up in the DADF. Or you can use the scanner  
5. Press OK.  
glass with a single original document face down.  
3. Adjust the document settings in the Image tab and the Basic tab.  
4. Press the Advanced tab > Mailbox > Send to Remote.  
SENDING A FAX IN TOLL SAVE TIME  
You can set the machine to send a fax in toll save time to save a telephone  
fee. If you send a fax after setting this feature, fax data will be stored in  
machine's memory and the machine will start to send fax in toll save time.  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
2. Press Admin Setting. When the login message pops up, enter  
3. Press the Setup tab > Fax Setup.  
4. Press down arrow on the right side.  
5. Press Toll Save.  
69 _Faxing (Optional)  
             
6. Press On.  
4. Press down arrow on the right side.  
5. Press Fax Forward Settings > Forward to Fax Setting > Send  
Forward.  
6. Press On and enter a fax number using the keypad on the control panel.  
7. Press OK.  
Forwarding a received fax to other destination by a  
fax  
With this feature, you can forward every fax you received to other  
destination by faxing. When the machine receives a fax, a fax is stored in  
the memory then, the machine sends it to the destination you have set.  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
2. Press Admin Setting. When the login message pops up, enter  
7. Press Start Time and set the start date and time with left/right arrows.  
8. Press OK.  
3. Press the Setup tab > Fax Setup.  
9. Press End Time and set the end date and time with left/right arrows.  
4. Press down arrow on the right side.  
10. Press OK.  
5. Press Fax Forward Settings > Forward to Fax Setting > Receive  
11. Press OK.  
Forward.  
6. Press Forward and enter a fax number using the keypad on the control  
ADDING DOCUMENTS TO A RESERVED DELAY  
FAX JOB  
You can add additional documents to the delayed fax job which is saved in  
memory.  
panel.  
If you want to set the star time and end time, select Start Time and  
End Time.  
If you want the machine to print the report after forwarding a fax, set  
the Forward & Print.  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
7. Press OK.  
2. Press Admin Setting. When the login message pops up, enter  
3. Press the Setup tab > Fax Setup.  
4. Press down arrow on the right side.  
5. Press Send Batch.  
Forwarding a sent fax to other destination by an  
email  
If Forward to Server Setting is on, this option will be grayed out.  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
6. Press On.  
7. Press OK.  
2. Press Admin Setting. When the login message pops up, enter  
3. Press the Setup tab > Fax Setup.  
4. Press down arrow on the right side.  
When you send a fax, if a fax number is same as the number in delay  
fax, the machine asks whether you want to add more documents to  
reserved delay fax.  
5. Press Fax Forward Settings > Forward to Email Setting > Send  
Forward.  
6. Press On.  
FORWARDING A RECEIVED FAX TO OTHER  
DESTINATION  
7. Enter the From and Destination Email option using the keyboard on  
the display.  
8. Press OK.  
You can set the machine to forward the received or sent fax to other  
destination by a fax or an email. If you are out of office but have to receive  
the fax, this feature may be useful.  
When you forward a fax by an email, you firstly set the mail server  
and IP address in SyncThru™ Web Service.  
If this Fax Forward Settings feature to On, you cannot use a fax  
with the On Hook Dial button on the control panel.  
Forwarding a received fax to other destination by an  
email  
If Forward to Server Setting is on, this option will be grayed out.  
Forwarding a sent fax to other destination by a fax  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
You can set the machine to forward every fax you sent to other destination  
by faxing.  
2. Press Admin Setting. When the login message pops up, enter  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
3. Press the Setup tab > Fax Setup.  
4. Press down arrow on the right side.  
5. Press Fax Forward Settings > Forward to Email Setting > Receive  
2. Press Admin Setting. When the login message pops up, enter  
Forward.  
3. Press the Setup tab > Fax Setup.  
Faxing (Optional)_ 70  
               
6. Press Forward and enter the From and Destination Email option using  
SENDING A FAX FROM A COMPUTER  
the keyboard on the display.  
You can send a fax from your computer without going to the machine. To  
send a fax from your computer, the Samsung Network PC Fax program  
must be installed. This program will be installed when you installed the  
printer driver. (See Software section.)  
If you want the machine to print the report after forwarding a fax, set  
the Forward & Print.  
7. Press OK.  
Forwarding a sent fax to other destination by server  
Sending a fax from your Computer  
1. Open the document to be sent.  
2. Select Print from the File menu.  
The Print window will be displayed. It may look slightly different  
depending on your application.  
3. Select Samsung Network PC Fax from the Print window.  
4. Click Print or OK.  
If Forward to Email Setting is on, this option will be grayed out. The  
server setting must be done in SyncThru™ Web Service prior to this  
option on.  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
2. Press Admin Setting. When the login message pops up, enter  
5. Enter the recipients’ numbers and select the option.  
3. Press the Setup tab > Fax Setup.  
4. Press down arrow on the right side.  
5. Press Fax Forward Settings > Forward to Server Setting > Send  
Forward.  
6. Press On.  
7. Press OK.  
Forwarding a received fax to other destination by  
server  
If Forward to Email Setting is on, this option will be grayed out. The  
server setting must be done in SyncThru™ Web Service prior to this  
option on.  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
2. Press Admin Setting. When the login message pops up, enter  
3. Press the Setup tab > Fax Setup.  
4. Press down arrow on the right side.  
5. Press Fax Forward Settings > Forward to Server Setting > Receive  
Forward.  
6. Press On.  
If you want to use a cover page, check Use cover page.  
Check Notify me on delivery, when the fax delivered to the recipients  
successfully.  
7. Press OK.  
6. Click Send.  
For more information about Samsung Network PC Fax, click Help.  
SETTING UP THE END FAX TONE  
The end fax tone that sounds to indicate that the fax has been received can  
be turned on or off.  
Checking a sent fax list  
You can check a sent fax list on your computer.  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
From the Start menu, click Programs or All Programs > Samsung  
Printers > Network PC Fax > Fax Journal. Then, the Fax Journal  
appears with the fax list you have sent.  
2. Press Admin Setting. When the login message pops up, enter  
3. Press the Setup tab > Fax Setup.  
4. Press down arrow on the right side.  
5. Press Fax Ending Sound.  
6. Press On.  
7. Press OK.  
71 _Faxing (Optional)  
             
using USB memory device  
This chapter explains how to use a USB memory device with your machine.  
This chapter includes:  
Scan to USB: You can specify image size, file format, or color mode  
ABOUT USB MEMORY  
USB memory devices are available with a variety of memory capacities to  
give you more room for storing documents, presentations, downloaded  
music and videos, high resolution photographs, or whatever other files you  
want to store or move.  
for each scanning to USB job. (See "Scan to USB" on page 73. )  
PLUGGING IN A USB MEMORY DEVICE  
You can do the following on your machine using a USB memory device:  
The USB memory port on the left side of your machine is designed for USB  
V1.1 and USB V2.0 memory devices. Your machine supports USB memory  
devices with FAT16/FAT32 and sector size of 512 bytes.  
Check your USB memory device’s file system from your dealer.  
You must use only an authorized USB memory device with an A plug type  
connector.  
Scan documents and save them on a USB memory device.  
Print data stored on a USB memory device.  
Format the USB memory device.  
UNDERSTANDING THE USB SCREEN  
To use the USB feature, press USB on the Main screen. If the screen  
displays an other menu, press (  
) to go to the Main screen.  
Use only a metal-shielded USB memory device.  
Insert a USB memory device into the USB memory port on the left side of  
your machine.  
When an USB memory is inserted into the USB memory port on your  
machine, USB icon shows on the display screen.  
Press USB Format, USB Print or Scan to USB.  
USB Format: You can delete image files stored on an USB memory  
device one by one or all at once by reformatting the device.  
USB Print: You can directly print files stored on an USB memory  
device. You can print TIFF, BMP, JPEG, PDF, and PRN files. (See  
Using USB memory device_ 72  
       
Delete: Deletes the folder on the USB memory device.  
Duplex: Selects whether the machine scans on one side of the  
paper (1 Sided), both sides of the paper (2 Sided), or both sides of  
paper but back is rotated 180 degrees (2 Sided, Rotate Side 2).  
Resolution: Selects the scanning resolution value.  
File Name: Names a file before you scan a document by just clicking  
this field.  
Do not remove the USB memory device while the machine is in  
operation, or writing to or reading from USB memory. The  
machine warranty does not cover damage caused by use’s  
misuse.  
If your USB memory device has certain features (example,  
security key, security partition, booting disk, password settings  
and so forth), do not use the USB memory device with your  
machine. The files stored in the USB memory device may be  
corrupted, or the machine may not automatically detect it. For  
details about these features, see device’s User’s Guide.  
Back: Returns to the previous screen.  
Advanced tab  
SCANNING TO AN USB MEMORY DEVICE  
You can scan a document and save the scanned image onto a USB  
memory device. When you scan a document, the machine uses the default  
settings such as the resolution. You can also customize your own scan  
If your USB memory device has certain features (example, security  
key, security partition, booting disk, password settings and so forth),  
do not use the USB memory device with your machine. The files  
stored in the USB memory device may be corrupted, or the machine  
may not automatically detect it. For details about these features, see  
device’s User’s Guide.  
Original Size: Sets the originals to a specific fixed size. (See  
Back: Returns to the previous screen.  
Scanning  
1. Insert a USB memory device into the USB memory port on your  
Image tab  
machine.  
2. Place the originals face up in the DADF. Or you can use the scanner  
glass with a single original document, face down.  
3. Press USB from the Main screen.  
4. Press Scan to USB.  
5. Set the scan features in the Advanced, Image, or Output tabs. (See  
6. Press Start on the control panel to begin scanning.  
7. After scanning is complete, you can remove the USB memory device  
from the machine.  
SCAN TO USB  
Basic tab  
Original Type: Selects whether the original is text or photo. (See  
Color Mode: Adjusts the color options of the scan output. If the  
original is color and you want to scan in color, press Color Mode.  
Darkness: Adjusts the degree of darkness of the scan output. Use  
left/right arrow to adjust the values. (See "Darkness" on page 75.)  
Erase Background: Erases backgrounds like paper patterns. (See  
Scan to Edge: Scans originals from edge-to-edge. (See "Scan to  
Back: Returns to the previous screen.  
Name: The folder names on the USB memory device.  
Date: Tha date which folders are made.  
Select: Selects the folder which has been chosen from the Name.  
New Folder: Makes a new folder on the USB memory device.  
Detail: Views the details of currently selected folder or file.  
Rename: Renames the folder or file name.  
73 _Using USB memory device  
             
Output tab  
Original Size  
The machine senses and determines the size of the original.  
Press USB > Scan to USB > the Advanced tab > Original Size. Use up/  
down arrows to go to the next screen. Select the appropriate option and  
press OK.  
Quality: Adjusts the display quality of the scan output. (See  
Scan Preset: Automatically changes some scan options such as file  
format, resolution, and more. You can adjust options to fit each  
File Format: Selects the file format of the scan output. (See "File  
File Policy: Selects the file format of the scan output. (See "File  
Back: Returns to the previous screen.  
Original Type  
You can set the original document type in order to enhance the quality of a  
document being scanned.  
Press USB > Scan to USB > the Image tab > Original Type. Select the  
appropriate option and press OK.  
CHANGING THE SCAN FEATURE SETTINGS  
This part explains how to adjust the document settings for each scan job,  
such as resolution, duplex, original size, type, color mode, darkness, and  
more. The options you change will be maintained for a certain time, but after  
that period, the options will be reset to default values.  
Text: For originals that have text or line art.  
Text/Photo: For originals that have both text and photographs  
together.  
Duplex  
Photo: For originals that are continuous tone photographs.  
This feature especially applies when the original documents to be scanned  
are two-sided. You can select whether the machine scans only one side of  
the paper or both sides of the paper.  
Color Mode  
Use this option to scan the original in Mono, Gray or Color mode.  
Press USB > Scan to USB > the Basic tab > Duplex. Use left/right arrows  
to toggle the values.  
Press USB > Scan to USB > the Image tab > Color Mode. Select the  
appropriate option and press OK.  
1 Sided: For originals that are printed on one side only.  
2 Sided: For originals that are printed on both sides.  
2 Sided, Rotate Side 2: For originals that are printed on both sides.  
But the back is rotated 180 degrees.  
To use 2 Sided and 2 Sided, Rotate Side 2, you have to load the  
originals on the DADF. Because, if the machine can not detect the  
original on DADF, automatically changes the option to 1 Sided.  
Color: Uses color to display an image. 24 bits per pixel, 8 bits for  
each RGB, is used for 1 pixel.  
Gray: Uses the black gradation to display an image. 8 bits per pixel.  
Resolution  
You can adjust document resolution.  
Press USB > Scan to USB > the Basic tab > Resolution. Use left/right  
arrows to toggle the values. The higher value you select the clear result you  
get. But the scanning time may take longer.  
Using USB memory device_ 74  
                         
Mono: Displays an image in black and white. 1 bit per pixel.  
Scan Preset  
This feature allows you to use optimized settings for your specific scan job.  
Press USB > Scan to USB > the Output tab > Scan Preset.  
The file format JPEG cannot be selected if Mono has been selected  
for Color Mode.  
Darkness  
You can select the degree of darkness of the scanned output. If your  
original document is light or faded, press the right arrow to make the output  
darker.  
Sharing and Printing: Produces a small-sized file for normal quality  
documents.  
High Quality Printing: Set this option for high quality output with the  
largest file size.  
Archival Record: For the electronic file which is of the smallest file  
size of the output.  
OCR: Produces scanned output for OCR software. You can expect  
the highest quality images.  
Simple Scan: Used for a simple document with text only. The file  
size of output is small.  
Press USB > Scan to USB > the Image tab > Darkness. Press right arrow  
to enhance the darkness degree then, press OK.  
Custom: Applies the current scan settings that you have chosen.  
Erase Background  
You can lighten, reduce or deletes the dark background from scanning  
colored paper or newspaper originals.  
File Format  
You can select the file format before you proceed with the scanning job.  
Press USB > Scan to USB > the Image tab > Erase Background. Select  
the appropriate option and press OK.  
Press USB > Scan to USB > the Output tab > File Format.  
Off: Disables this feature.  
Auto: Optimizes the background.  
Enhance: The higher the number is, the more vivid the background  
is.  
Erase: The higher the number is, the lighter the background is.  
Scan to Edge  
You can set the machine to scan full size of a page as it is. Usually, the  
machine scans a page except edges, which means the margin, especially  
when you do the copy job with certain sized paper in the tray. But if you  
scan and sent it right away via the network, as the file, the machine does not  
need to exclude the edges from the originals.  
PDF: Scans originals in PDF format.  
Single-Page TIFF: Scans originals in TIFF (Tagged Image File  
Format), but several originals are scanned as one file.  
Multi-Page TIFF: Scans the originals in TIFF (Tagged Image File  
Format), and several originals are scanned as several file.  
JPEG: Scans original in JPEG format.  
Press USB > Scan to USB > the Image tab > Scan to Edge. Select On and  
press OK.  
BMP: Scans original in BMP format.  
Quality  
The file format JPEG cannot be selected if Mono has been selected  
for Color Mode.  
You can use this option to produce a high quality document. Higher quality  
you select a larger file size you get.  
Press USB > Scan to USB > the Output tab > Quality.  
File Policy  
You can choose the policy for generating file name before you proceed with  
the scan job through USB. If the USB memory already has the same name  
when you entered a new file name, you can rename or overwrite it.  
Press USB > Scan to USB > the Output tab > File Policy.  
When you set Color Mode to Mono, the Quality option is grayed out.  
Rename: If the USB memory already has the same name when you  
entered a new file name, the file will be saved as a different name  
that is automatically programmed.  
75 _Using USB memory device  
                             
Overwrite:You can set the machine to delete previous job  
information on USB as you store new job information.  
PRINTING FROM A USB MEMORY DEVICE  
You can directly print files stored on a USB memory device. You can print  
TIFF, BMP, JPEG, and PRN files.  
If your USB memory device has certain features (example, security  
key, security partition, booting disk, password settings and so forth),  
do not use the USB memory device with your machine. The files  
stored in the USB memory device may be corrupted, or the machine  
may not automatically detect it. For details about these features, see  
device’s User’s Guide.  
Direct Print option supported file types:  
PRN: Only files created by provided driver with your machine are  
compatible.  
PRN files can be created by selecting the Print to file check box when  
you print a document. The document will be saved as a PRN file, rather  
than printed on paper. Only PRN files created in this fashion can be  
printed directly from USB memory. See Software section to learn how to  
create a PRN file.  
BMP: BMP Uncompressed  
TIFF: TIFF 6.0 Baseline  
JPEG: JPEG Baseline  
PDF: PDF 1.4 and below  
To print a document from a USB memory device:  
1. Insert a USB memory device into the USB memory port on your  
machine.  
Your machine automatically detects the device and reads data stored on it.  
2. Press USB from the Main screen.  
3. Use up/down arrows until the file you want appears. Select the file  
name.  
If there is a folder, select folder name and press Select.  
4. Press USB Print.  
5. Press Start on the control panel.  
Using USB memory device_ 76  
     
using document box  
This chapter explains how to use Document Box with your machine.  
This chapter includes:  
Document Box Screen  
ABOUT DOCUMENT BOX  
The Document Box feature makes it possible to store scanned data to the  
hard drive. Users can send the stored data to various destinations such as  
print, fax, e-mail, or an FTP/SMB server. The Document Box provides  
three types of boxes: public (  
) , secured (  
) , and common (  
) .  
The public box can be created by all users and all users can store data to  
public boxes. The secured box can be created with password by all users.  
This means that the only users who know the password can access to the  
box and store their data. A common box is provided by default. Users  
cannot create, edit, and delete the common box. When a user needs to  
store a job that is not assigned to a box (i.e., fax receiving or PC printing in  
store mode), the data will be stored in the common box by default.  
You can also see the System Box tab from the Document Box screen.  
The System Box is used for temporary data backup such as printing in  
delayed mode, printing proof page.  
s
User Box tab: Create the box where you can save documents such  
as the file you have printed, sent by email, or scanned. When you  
create a box, you can set the password to secure your box. The box  
with a password is called Secured Box, and without it, it is called  
public box.  
UNDERSTANDING THE DOCUMENT BOX  
SCREEN  
System Box tab: The machine provided default boxes, which you  
cannot modify them.  
Type: Shows the box is secured or not.  
Box Name: Shows the box name.  
Owner: Shows the user name of a box.  
Date: Shows the date of a box created.  
File: Shows the number of total files in the box.  
Add: Lets you add more boxes.  
Delete: Deletes the selected box.  
Edit: Lets you modify a box name and an owner name.  
Detail: Shows box information.  
Report: Prints the information about the documents inside the  
selected box.  
To use the Document Box feature, press Document Box on the Main  
screen. If the screen displays an other menu, press (  
screen.  
) to go to the Main  
Search: Searches a box with a box name or an owner name.  
Enter: Prints or sends the stored file in the box.  
77 _Using document box  
         
Add From Scan: Lets you add a new document from scanning.  
Detail: Shows a document’s information.  
Search: Searches a file with a document name or an owner name.  
Edit: Lets you to modify a document name and an owner name.  
Delete: Deletes the selected document.  
Copy: Copies a selected document to another document box.  
Move: Moves a selected document to another document box.  
Combine: Merge documents located in two or more boxes.  
Send To: Sends the selected document(s) to a destination such as  
e-mail, fax, server, or USB.  
Box Adding Screen  
You can create a new box to store your scanned data. To add a new  
Document Box, press Add on the Document Box screen.  
The following are some constraints about the document box.  
You can create maximum 100 document boxes.  
A document box can contain up to 200 stored-documents.  
The length of a box name is limited to 20 characters.  
Common (  
) box is already created by default.  
Print: Prints the selected document(s) out.  
Back: Returns to the previous screen.  
STORING DOCUMENTS TO DOCUMENT BOX  
This machine allows you to store the scanned data on the hard drive.  
Storing documents from document box  
You can scan orignals directly from Document Box menu.  
1. Place the originals face up in the DADF. Or you can use the scanner  
glass with a single original document, face down.  
Box Name: Enter a box name.  
2. Press Document Box from the Main screen.  
3. Press a document box with which you need to store a document.  
4. Press Enter.  
Owner: Enter the user name of the box's owner.  
Secured Box: Check to make a secured-type box.  
New Password: Enter a new password to access the box.  
Confirm Password: Enter the password again.  
Edit a Box Screen  
You can modify a box name or an owner name. To modify a Document  
Box, select a box from the Document Box list and press Edit.  
5. Press Add From Scan.  
Box Name: Enter a new box name.  
Owner: Enter a user name of a box.  
Document List Screen  
You can enter a document box by clicking Enter from the Document Box  
screen, you can use the stored documents again.  
6. Set the scan settings.  
7. Press Start to begin scanning.  
Storing documents during copy, scan, fax function  
During copying, scanning, or faxing, you can save the scanned originals to  
Document Box in your machine.  
Document Name: Shows the document’s name.  
Owner: Shows the user name of a document.  
Date: Shows the date of a document stored.  
Page: Shows the number of total pages in the document.  
Using document box_ 78  
             
1. Place the originals face up in the DADF. Or you can use the scanner  
glass with a single original document, face down.  
2. Press Copy > the Basic tab > Saving to box.  
Or press Scan > Scan to Email (Scan to Server or Scan to PC) > the  
Basic tab > Saving to box.  
Or press Fax > the Basic tab > Saving to box.  
3. Enter the file name in the File Name field with the pop up keyboard.  
Then press OK.  
4. Select a destination box and press OK.  
5. Press Start from the control panel to begin a job.  
79 _Using document box  
using standard workflow  
This chapter explains how to use standard workflow with your machine.  
This chapter includes:  
Workflow Screen  
Favorite Tab  
ABOUT STANDARD WORKFLOW  
Standard Workflow is a feature for users to conveniently operate jobs with  
pre-arranged task sets called workform. Standard Workflow makes it  
possible to execute multiple jobs in a single session by defined the job  
workform. Once you create a workform, you can reuse the same workflow  
only with one-touch operation.  
Favorite workform is a shortcut of public or private workform. You can  
select a frequently-used public or private workform, and then the  
workform appears on the favorite workform tab.  
Fax input workform is automatically executed when receiving fax.  
Therefore fax input workforms cannot be registered to a favorite  
workform.  
INPUT  
TRANSMIT  
Email  
Scan  
Document Box  
Fax  
FTP/SMB server  
Document Box  
Print  
Fax  
UNDERSTANDING THE STANDARD  
WORKFLOW SCREEN  
To use the Standard Workflow feature, press Standard Workflow on the  
Main screen.  
Execute: Start the job defined in the workform.  
To switch to the other display screen, press the left or right arrow on  
the display screen.  
My Workform and Public Workform Tab  
Using standard workflow_ 80  
       
Transmit Tab  
Type: Shows the workform is locked by the creator or not.  
Name: Shows the workform name.  
Input: Shows the workform’s input module name.  
Transmit: Shows the workform’s transmit module name. If two or  
more modules are added in transmit workform, this column displays  
Multi without any icon.  
Properties: Shows the workform’s perperties.  
Create: Creates a new private workform.  
Delete: Deletes the selected workform.  
Transmit: Shows the workform’s transmit module name.  
Status: shows the setting status. To create a workform, you have to  
set every mandatory items of every assigned transmit modules.  
After you do fill out all mandatory items, the Save & Execute and  
Save button are enabled.  
Add Module: Add transmit module(s).  
Before you add module, make sure that the parameters are correctly  
configured for each module.  
Edit: Lets you to modify a workform.  
Detail: Shows detailed workform information.  
Search: Searches a workform with a workform name.  
Task: Imports a workform from USB, export a workform to USB,  
copy or move a workform to public workform. It also makes a  
shortcut in favorite workform tab by clicking Set to Favorite WF or  
removes the shortcut by clicking Set to Normal WF.  
Execute: Start the job defined in the workform.  
Delete: Deletes the selected module.  
Settings: Configures the setting values for the module.  
Previous: Goes to the next tab.  
Next: Goes to the next tab.  
Workform Creating Screen  
You can create a new workform. To add a new workform, press Create on  
Properties Tab  
the My Workform or Public Workform tab.  
You can create maximum 100 workforms.  
Input Tab  
Workform Name: Sets the workform name.  
Delay Start: Schedule the start date and time to start.  
Expired: Sets the expire date.  
Secured: Locks the workform with password protection.  
Previous: Goes to the next tab.  
Input: Shows the workform’s input module name.  
Status: shows the setting status. To create a workform, you have to  
set every mandatory items of the assigned input module.  
VARIOUS OPERATIONS WITH WORKFORM  
User can operate various jobs with workforms. The following items show  
some example cases.  
After you do fill out all mandatory items, the Save & Execute and  
Save button are enabled.  
Settings: Configures the setting values for the module.  
Next: Goes to the next tab.  
81 _Using standard workflow  
   
Scan to multi-destination  
You can scan a document once and send it to multiple destinations such as  
email, SMB/FTP server, document box, and print.  
Before you add module, make sure that the parameters are correctly  
configured for each module.  
Fax forwarding  
You can forward the received fax to another destinations. To forward a fax,  
your machine checks caller’s ID that the fax service provides. When the  
caller is also Samsung’s fax machine, your machine checks the fax number  
that the user defined for the machine information.  
Make sure that you enabled Default Fax in Machine Setup > Admin  
Setting > Setup tab > Standard Workflow Management. (See  
When you need to forward different destination for each caller, you can  
create several workforms for each caller’s ID.  
Auto redirection  
If the fax transmission failed, the machine re-sends the fax image to the  
user’s email address.  
Make sure that you enabled Default Fax in Machine Setup > Admin  
Setting > Setup tab > Standard Workflow Management. (See  
Delayed start feature  
You can schedule the job’s execution time by setting Delay Start in  
Properties tab when you creating a workform.  
Notification feature  
You can notify the job processing result to an email.  
Make sure that you enabled Complete Notification in Machine  
Setup > Admin Setting > Setup tab > Standard Workflow  
Approval feature  
Before executing the transmit module, you can get approval from an  
administrator.  
Make sure that you enabled Approve in Machine Setup > Admin  
Setting > Setup tab > Standard Workflow Management. (See  
Using standard workflow_ 82  
           
machine status and advanced setup  
This chapter explains how to browse the current status of your machine, and the method of setting for the advanced machine  
setup. Please read this chapter carefully in order to use your machine's diverse features.  
This chapter includes:  
Back: Returns to the previous screen.  
MACHINE SETUP  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
2. Select the appropriate item for your occasion.  
Admin Setting screen  
Gives you access to detailed machine settings.  
When you press Admin Setting, a login message appears. If the  
administrator set the password, you have to enter the password every  
time you want to use Admin Setting. (See "Setting the authentication  
Machine Status: Shows the current machine status.  
Admin Setting: Allows administrator to set up the machine.  
When you press Admin Setting, login message pops up. Enter  
password and press OK. (Factory setting is 1111.)  
Tray Management: Shows the currently installed tray and their  
status. You can also change the paper settings for each tray.  
Usage Page Report: You can print the report on the amount of  
printouts depending on the paper size and type.  
General tab: Sets the basic parameters of the machine such as  
location, date, time, and more. (See "General settings" on page 84.)  
Setup tab: Sets the values for fax, network and login. Also you can  
set to enable the feature listed on the screen.  
Print/Report tab: Prints configuration or font list and displays a  
report of machine features. (See "Printing a report" on page 93.)  
Back: Returns to the previous screen.  
Machine Status screen  
Press Machine Setup on the control panel and press Machine Status.  
BROWSING THE MACHINE’S STATUS  
You can browse the machine information and validate some features of the  
machine.  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
2. Press Machine Status > the Machine Info tab.  
Supplies Life tab: Displays the remainders or the usage count of the  
machine supplies. Use up/down arrows to switch screens.  
Machine Info tab: Displays the detailed information about the  
machine, and some options allows for validating your machine. (See  
83 _Machine status and advanced setup  
                       
OPTION  
Device Info  
DESCRIPTION  
The sub-options available are Service Center  
Registration and Contact Info. You may enter  
information on service center and purchasing  
point.  
Date & Time  
You can set the date and time. (See "Setting the  
Default Settings  
Default Window: Set the first window that will  
appear on the display screen after turning on  
the machine or waking up from the Power  
Save. For example, if you select Fax as a  
default window, the first window will be the  
Basic tab of the Fax feature. In case you want  
to show ID Copy as a default window, you need  
to enable this feature in Default Option  
previously.  
OPTION  
DESCRIPTION  
Machine Details  
This option shows the customer support  
information on the email address and the phone  
number you stored from Admin Setting. Also, you  
can check the machine's serial number, or the  
hardware and software information specification.  
Default Option: Changes all the default values  
for copying, faxing, emailing, scanning and  
Home: Changes the order of windows that will  
appears on the display screen.  
Print/Report  
Tray Status  
You can print various helpful and informative  
reports such as System Report, Fax Report and  
Depending on the optional kit you installed  
or the category you selected, the selectable  
options on the display screen may differ.  
The screen shows the trays installed on your  
machine, and their current configurations. Select  
the tray and Edit to change the settings for paper  
type and size.  
Measurements  
Timers  
This option lets you change the measurement unit  
to use (mm or inch), and set the numeric  
separation (comma or period).  
Usage Counters  
You can view the amount of each category that  
your machine has printed so far. To print this  
The machine cancels a printing job if data does  
not be received in specific time.  
System Timeout: The machine returns to the  
default value after certain time the machine  
waits. You can set a time for maximum 10  
minutes.  
GENERAL SETTINGS  
Before you get ready to using the machine, it is recommended to set up the  
machine parameters.  
Held Job Timeout: The machine holds a job  
for a specific time period. You can set a time  
period for at least an hour.  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
2. Press Admin Setting. When the login message pops up, then enter  
password and press OK. (Factory setting is 1111.)  
3. Press the General tab.  
Language  
It allows you to change the language that appears  
on the touch screen.  
Power Saver  
You can reduce energy consumption by setting  
these features. Power Saver has three options,  
first Scan Power Save turns off the scanner lamp  
under the glass. And Power Save turns off all the  
fans within the machine after a certain time. Low  
Power Save turns off the fans within the machine  
except a core fan for the fuser unit. (See "Using  
Machine status and advanced setup_ 84  
                   
OPTION  
DESCRIPTION  
OPTION  
DESCRIPTION  
Tray Management  
This feature allows you to select the tray and  
paper you use for a printing job. Paper size, paper  
type, and paper color options are adjusted here.  
Tray Confirmation Message is to activate the  
window asking whether you set the paper size and  
type for the just opened tray.  
HDD Spooling  
To spool documents in HDD for the network  
printing, select On.  
Manual Image  
Overwrite  
You can set the machine to delete previous job  
information on HDD as you store new job  
information. To activate this feature, go to Admin  
Setting > the Setup tab > Optional Service and  
set the Manual Image Overwrite option to  
Enable. After activating this feature, you can  
overwrite the HDD by pressing Start in the  
display.  
Auto Tray Switch: If tray1 and tray2 are filled  
with letter size paper, when tray1 is empty and  
this option is On, then the machine continues  
printing with paper in tray2.  
Auto Continue: When the paper is  
mismatched, meaning that tray1has filled with  
the letter size paper, but the printing job needs  
A4 size paper, the machine will wait for 30  
seconds to paper in tray1 with proper sized  
paper. After 30 seconds, the machine  
automatically starts printing with Letter sized  
paper.  
Stored Job File  
Policy  
You can choose the file policy for generating file  
name before you proceed with the job through  
HDD. If the HDD memory already has the same  
name when you entered a new file name, you can  
rename or overwrite it.  
Rename: If the HDD memory already has the  
same name when you enter a new file name,  
the file will be saved as a different name that is  
automatically programmed.  
Paper Substitution: When the paper is  
mismatched, this option sets the machine print  
A4 size paper in the Letter size paper or vice  
versa.  
Wide A4: It is useful when printing in DOS  
mode. This option prints 80 charactors in a  
line, which printing 78 charactors in a line is  
usual in DOS mode.  
Overwrite: You can set the machine to delete  
previous job information on HDD as you store  
new job information.  
Country  
You can change the country, then some the  
values for fax and paper size will be changed  
automatically for your country.  
After installing the fax kit, you must change the  
Altitude  
Adjustment  
Print quality is affected by atmospheric pressure,  
which atmospheric pressure is determined by the  
height of the machine above sea level. This  
feature lets you adjust the altitude in a height  
district. Higher altitude location need to set this  
feature to High 3, which affects print quality.  
country.  
Home Window  
Background  
To change the background image of the  
machine's LCD UI to suit user’s preference, press  
Custom, select a customized background image  
file on the list, and then press Load.  
Output Options  
Output Options is for, when the staples run out,  
you to let the machine stop processing and wait to  
refill the staples or continue the job. If you set  
Within Job Offsetting to On, the output paper is  
placed and sorted by printout-sets.  
Users can register their own background image  
from SyncThru™ Web Service. Click Settings >  
Machine Settings > System > Home Window  
Customization, and add your images on the list.  
Multi-Bin  
You can set the default mode for multi-output bin  
from the following options:  
Contention  
Management  
This feature lets you to select the priority between  
copy jobs and print jobs.  
Mailbox: Stacks the printouts in a bin that the  
user selects from the output options in the  
printer driver. You can modify each bin’s name  
from Rename. You also can merge two or  
more bins from Link Setup. By using Default  
Setup, you can assign each job’s default bin  
such as bin 2 for copy job, bin 4 for fax job, etc.  
Job Seperator: Stacks the printouts in each  
seperated bin in sequence by job.  
Collator: Stacks the printouts in the same  
order as the originals.  
Stacker: Stacks the printouts in bins one-by-  
one. When bin 1 is full, printouts will be  
stacked in bin 2.  
Priority: Set the priority by numbering the job.  
The machine starts from the least to the  
highest number in order.  
First In, First Out: The machine does an  
asked job in order.  
Sound  
You can adjust the loudness of the machine  
sound. Press Fault to adjust the machine's error  
sound. Select Conflict if you pressed the wrong  
option. Press Selection to sound whenever you  
press the selection from your touch screen.  
Supplies  
Management  
The machine gives you the notification of the  
imaging unit and toner cartridge to reorder, and  
resets the used fuser counter, bias transfer roller,  
feed roller and document feeder friction pad  
counter.  
You can only use this feature if you have  
installed optional 2-Bin Finisher or 4-Bin  
Mailbox.  
Machine Test  
The machine prints the test image patterns using  
Image Quality Test Patterns.  
85 _Machine status and advanced setup  
           
OPTION  
Stamp  
DESCRIPTION  
You can print optional information such as ID,  
Machine Information, Date & Time, Comment,  
and Page Number, on the output paper for  
tracking.  
Items: Select item(s) to print on each paper.  
Position: Decide the position to stamp either  
Top or Bottom of paper.  
Appearance: Decide the appearance of the  
text either Opaque or Transparent. When you  
select Opaque, the text background color is  
filled with opaque white.  
The fax options are different from country to country depending on  
the international communication regulatory. If the display screen  
does not show or gray out some of the fax options explained  
herein, it means that the grayed out function does not supported in  
your communication environment.  
COPY SETUP  
For copy output, you can set up several options in advance.  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
2. Press Admin Setting. When the login message pops up, enter  
OPTION  
DESCRIPTION  
password and press OK.  
3. Press the Setup tab > Copy Setup  
.
Machine ID & Fax  
No  
Enter the machine ID and fax number which will  
be printed at the top of each page. Select the  
country name. This option usually pre-set for user.  
Receive Start Code This feature works best when you are using an  
extension telephone connected to the EXT socket  
on the back of your machine. You can receive a  
fax from someone you are talking to on the  
extension telephone, without going to the fax  
Error Correction  
Mode  
It helps with poor line quality and makes sure any  
faxes you send are properly transmitted to any  
other ECM-equipped fax machines. Sending a fax  
using ECM may take more time.  
OPTION  
DESCRIPTION  
Fax Initial Setup  
You can set Receive Mode for Telephone, Fax or  
Manual ID Copy  
Setup  
This option sets the ID copy settings such as the  
number of images or copying positions manually.  
Answering Machine/Fax, and Dial Mode at either  
Pulse (Dial Pulse) or Tone (Multi Frequency).  
When you select Answering Machine/Fax, you  
can receive a fax while the line is being used by  
the answering machine. (See "Changing the  
Contact your local telephone company for Dial  
Mode setting information.  
FAX SETUP  
This machine offers you with various options to you for setting up the fax  
system. You can change the default settings for your preferences and  
needs.  
Ring to Answer  
Receive Header  
You can specify the number of times the machine  
rings before answering an incoming call.  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
2. Press Admin Setting. When the login message pops up, enter  
Use this option to automatically print the page  
number, date and time of fax reception at the  
bottom of each page.  
password and press OK.  
3. Press the Setup tab > Fax Setup.  
Secure Receive  
You may need to prevent your received faxes from  
being accessed by unauthorized people. This  
feature restricts printing of received faxes when  
the machine is unattended. If you select this  
option to On, all incoming faxes go into memory.  
A four-digit Passcode is used when you want to  
Machine status and advanced setup_ 86  
               
OPTION  
DESCRIPTION  
OPTION  
Output Tray  
DESCRIPTION  
Received Fax  
Printing  
When receiving a fax containing pages longer  
than the paper loaded in the tray, the machine can  
reduce the size of the original to fit the size of the  
paper loaded in the machine. If this feature is set  
to Off, the machine cannot reduce the original to  
fit onto one page. The original will be divided and  
printed in actual size on two or more pages. If you  
set this option to On and set the discard size to  
10mm and the received data is longer then the  
currently set paper in the tray, the machine  
minuses the data that would have been on the  
specified discard segment.  
This feature lets you select the paper tray to use  
for receiving a fax.  
Toll Save  
Set the machine to send a fax in the toll save time  
Send Batch  
The machine asks you whether you want to add  
the documents to the reserved delay fax, if the fax  
number you have dialed is same as the delay fax  
Redial  
The machine can automatically redial a remote fax  
machine, if it was busy. You can set the number of  
redial attempts and an interval between attempts.  
Selecting 0 for Redial Times means that the  
machine will not use this feature.  
Fax Forward  
Settings  
You can forward a sent or received fax to other  
destination by a fax or an email. (See "Forwarding  
Fax Ending Sound  
This setting selects whether the end fax tone is on  
or off.  
Set whether you turn on or off the sound of an end  
Speaker Volume  
This controls the sound when a fax actually starts  
to transfer data. If this option is On, the machine  
sounds from a fax starts until a fax finishes. With  
Comm. the machine sounds only until the  
communication is succeeded. No sound with Off  
option.  
Caller ID  
If you have set this option, the machine  
remembers the last twenty fax numbers.  
Prefix Dial  
This feature allows you to set a prefix of up to five  
digits. This number will be dialed before any  
automatic number is dialed. User may set this to  
a.Private Automatic Branch Exchange  
access a PABXa (example 9) or area code  
number (example 02). When sending a fax, there  
may be a job which has same recipient's number  
in delay jobs. In this case, the machine can send  
faxes to the same recipient in a batch.  
NETWORK SETUP  
You may set up the network with the machine's touch screen. Before doing  
that, you must have the information concerning the type of network  
protocols and computer system you use. If you are not sure which setting to  
use, contact your network administrator to configure this machine network.  
Junk Fax Setup  
The machine does not accept faxes sent from  
remote stations if their numbers are stored in the  
memory as junk fax numbers. You can enter a  
maximum of 10 junk fax numbers. Press Junk  
Fax Setup and Edit, then, enter the fax numer. If  
you have set Caller ID enabled, you can browse  
the last received fax numbers and select a fax  
number from the list.  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
2. Press Admin Setting. When the login message pops up, enter  
password and press OK.  
3. Press the Setup tab > Network Setup.  
Ring Volume  
This feature adjusts the ring volume. When you  
select Off, the machine does not ring.  
Dial Tone Volume  
When you press On Hook Dial to send a fax, you  
can hear a specific tone. To adjust the tone  
volume, you can use this feature. Value 1 is the  
lowest volume. Use left/right arrows to adjust the  
value.  
Mailbox Setup  
Document Policy: You can set the document  
stored in Mailbox to delete or retain documents  
after. Select Delete On Poll of each option to  
delete, Delete On Print to remain the data.  
Mail Configuration: You can create, edit, or  
delete Mailbox. Enter Mailbox ID, Mailbox  
Name, Mailbox Passcode by pressing options.  
OPTION  
DESCRIPTION  
TCP/IP Protocol  
Select appropriate protocol and configure  
parameters to use the network environment.  
There are lots of parameters to be set,  
therefore, if you are not sure, leave as it is,  
or consult the network administrator.  
If you set the Notification option to On, you  
are notified when a fax is received in  
87 _Machine status and advanced setup  
   
Access Control  
.
OPTION  
Apple Talk  
DESCRIPTION  
Using SyncThru™ Web Service, administrators can classify  
For Macintosh network environments, select this  
option. This option provides packet transmission  
and routing functionality for networking.  
users into several groups according to each user’s role. Each  
user’s authorization, authentication and accounting will be  
controlled by the group’s role definition. For example, if a group  
A only has authorization to use the copy function, users in  
group A can only copy with the machine: they cannot fax or  
scan. You can set this feature from SyncThru™ Web Service.  
Click Security > User Access Control > Authority.  
Protocol  
Ethernet Speed  
Clear Setting  
802.1x  
Configure the network transmission speed.  
Reverts the network settings to the default values.  
When the Single Sign-On (SSO) feature is enabled, users just  
need to log in to the service only one time. Then the system  
automatically checks the user’s authority based on the user ID  
and password. The SSO feature is related to all of the security  
functions such as authentication, authorization and accounting.  
The SSO feature can be configured from SyncThru™ Web  
Service. Log in to the SyncThru™ Web Service as an  
website" on page 99.) And click Security > User Access  
Control > Authentication> Options.  
You can select the user authentication for network  
communication.  
For details information consult the network  
administrator.  
IPv6  
Machine supports IPv6 addresses for network  
printing and managements.  
IPv6 Activate: When you select On, the Host  
Name and Link-Local Address will  
automatically be entered into the address field.  
DHCPv6 Configuration: If you have a  
DHCPv6 server on your network, you can set  
one of the option for default dynamic host  
configuration.  
OPTION  
OPTION  
DESCRIPTION  
Routers: Use DHCPv6 only when  
requested by a router.  
DHCPv6 Addresses: Always use DHCPv6  
regardless of router request.  
DHCPv6 Off: Never use DHCPv6  
regardless of router request.  
Authentication  
Method  
No  
It disables Authentication  
Method.  
Authentication  
Local  
Authentication  
It enables the local authentication  
mode. The user ID and password  
is stored in an internal storage of  
the device. The administrator can  
see the user information from the  
SyncThru™ Web Service >  
Security > User Access Control  
> User Profile menu.  
SECURITY  
This feature lets you control and lock all outgoing data, or change the  
password.  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
2. Press Admin Setting. When the login message pops up, then enter  
password and press OK.  
3. Press the Setup tab > Security.  
Machine status and advanced setup_ 88  
     
OPTION  
OPTION  
Network  
DESCRIPTION  
OPTION  
OPTION  
DESCRIPTION  
Authentication  
Method  
(Continue)  
It enables the network  
Accounting  
Method  
No Accounting  
It disables accounting features.  
authentication mode. When the  
users already belong to a server-  
based networks, the Network  
Authentication system can be  
simply configured with the existing  
server. Then the user can access  
with the ID and password stored in  
the remote authentication server.  
To use any features in Network  
Authentication mode, the users  
have to get a certificate from SMB,  
FTP, LDAP, or Keberos server  
defined in SyncThru™ Web  
Service.  
Authentication  
Network  
Accounting  
You can set the network account  
for users by using SyncThru™  
Web Admin Service’s job  
accounting plug-in. When the  
users performs their copy, fax,  
print, or scan service job with the  
machine, the account module  
records it. You can see the report  
from the SyncThru™ Web Admin  
Service.  
Standard  
Accounting  
You can set the local account for  
maximum 500 users. When the  
users perform their copy, fax,  
print, or scan service job with the  
machine, the account module  
records it. You can see the report  
from Standard Acct. Usage  
Report in Machine Setup >  
Admin Setting > Print/Report tab  
> Accounting Reports.  
As the device itself can manage  
user’s ID and usage without any  
remote server, this feature is  
highly suitable for small and  
medium businesses.  
Foreign Device  
Interface  
When you install the optional FDI  
kit, select Foreign Device  
Interface Configuration Setup to  
activate it.  
Job Timer: If there is not  
enough credit, you can set the  
machine to cancel a job right  
away or wait a designated  
amount of time for a deposit.  
Print Job Control: When it is  
enabled, the both computer  
printing and copying are  
The accounting system  
possible since the credit  
regards storing a file to a  
remains. With Disable, only  
the copy printing job needs the  
credit. (which means a  
single server as a single  
count.  
Accounting ID List: It shows  
the accounting ID list. You can  
add, edit, or delete the ID.  
Login Setting: You can  
configure for user to login  
either with ID and password  
(ID & password Login) or with  
ID only (ID only Login).  
Accounting ID List: It shows  
the accounting ID list. You can  
add, edit, or delete the ID.  
Login Setting: You can  
configure for user to login  
either with ID and password  
(ID & password Login) or with  
ID only (ID only Login).  
computer printing a report or a  
fax job needs no credits)  
Inhibit Services: When no  
credit is left, the machine  
disables the copy job only with  
Copy Only. With All Services,  
scanning service and copy job  
are disabled.  
Internal Credits: It is used  
when you cancel the job or  
when the job is cancelled by  
the device due to insufficient  
credits (coin) or is canceled by  
user’s request. If you select  
Enable, the machine deposits  
a credit equal to the number of  
sheets that did not print out  
correctly, then it prints next job  
for free (for the amount  
deposited). With Disable, even  
if you cancel the printing job,  
the machine includes jammed  
paper in the count and the cost  
of printing.  
Image Counter: Depends on  
whether the machine counts  
blank white pages.  
89 _Machine status and advanced setup  
 
7. Click on User Profile and check the users.  
User Authentication Method  
You can create a new role group by clicking on the Add button.  
If you want add the information to Address Book, check the  
Automatically add your information to Address Book option.  
Select the user’s accounting ID if the accounting service is activated.  
Select the user’s role from Role.  
If you are an administrator, you can enable authentication service before  
using the machine to improve security for the device. If user  
authentication service has been activated, only authorized users can  
use the device. With authentication service, you also can give  
permission to each user and set the maximum number of job executions  
for a user.  
The authentication service and accounting service can be enabled  
independently. The services refer to the user information differently case  
by case.  
8. Click Apply.  
Enabling network authentication by Kerberos  
1. Log in to the SyncThru™ Web Service as an administrator. (See  
Using Local Authentication only,  
Using Local Authentication and Standard Accounting,  
Using Local Authentication and Network Accounting: Refers to  
User Profile from Security > User Access Control menu.  
Using Network Authentication only,  
Using Network Authentication and Standard Accounting,  
Using Network Authentication and Network Accounting: Refers  
to the user information in the network authentication server. Disable  
the user in User Profile to access the device.  
Standard Accounting only: Refers to the Standard Account List  
from SyncThru™ Web Service > Security > User Access Control  
Network Accounting only: Refers to the user information in network  
authentication server.  
2. Select Security > Network Security > External Authentication  
Server > Kerberos Server.  
Click on the Add button if you want to add more servers.  
3. Enter the realm used for Kerberos login.  
4. Select the IP Address or Host Name.  
5. Enter the IP address in dotted decimal notation or as a host name.  
6. Enter the server port number, from 1 to 65535.  
The default port number is 88.  
7. You can add a backup domain as a previous step.  
8. Click on Apply.  
Enabling network authentication by SMB  
1. Log in to the SyncThru™ Web Service as an administrator. (See  
Registering local authorized users  
2. Select Security > External Authentication Server > SMB Server.  
1. Enter your machine’s IP address as the URL in a browser and click  
Go to access the SyncThru™ Web Service for your machine.  
Click on the Add button if you want to add more servers.  
2. Log in to the SyncThru™ Web Service as an administrator. (See  
3. Select Security > User Access Control > Authentication >  
Authentication Method.  
4. Select Local Authentication.  
5. Click on the Apply button.  
6. Click on Authority, and check a Role Name according to the current  
3. Enter the domain that is used for SMB login.  
4. Select IP Address or Host Name.  
5. Enter the IP address in dotted decimal notation or as a host name.  
6. Enter the server port number, from 1 to 65535.  
The default port number is 139.  
7. Users can add a backup domain as in the previous step.  
8. Click on Apply.  
user’s role.  
Users can add up to 6 alternate domains.  
You can create a new role group by clicking on the Add button.  
7. Click on User Profile and check the users.  
You can add users by clicking the Add button.  
Enabling network authentication by LDAP  
1. Log in to the SyncThru™ Web Service as an administrator. (See  
2. Select Security > Network Security > External Authentication  
If you want add information to the Address Book, check the  
Automatically add your information to Address Book.  
Select the user’s accounting ID if the accounting service is activated.  
Select the user’s role from Role item.  
Server > LDAP Server.  
8. Click on Apply.  
Click on the Add button if you want to add more servers.  
Register authorized network users  
1. Enter your machine’s IP address as the URL in a browser and click  
3. Enter your machine’s IP address as the URL in a browser and click  
Go to access the SyncThru™ Web Service of your machine.  
4. Log in to the SyncThru™ Web Service as an administrator. (See  
on Go to access the SyncThru™ Web Service of your machine.  
2. Log in to the SyncThru™ Web Service as an administrator. (See  
5. Click Security > Network Security > External Authentication  
Server > LDAP Server.  
3. Select Security > User Access Control > Authentication >  
6. Select IP Address or Host Name.  
Authentication Method.  
7. Enter the IP address in dotted decimal notation or as a host name.  
8. Enter the server port number, from 1 to 65535.  
The default port number is 389.  
4. Select Kerberos, SMB, or LDAP.  
Before configuring network authentication, you need to configure  
External Authentication Server from Security > Network  
Security  
9. Enter Search Root Directory, the top search level of the LDAP  
directory tree.  
5. Click on the Apply button.  
10. Select Authentication method. There are two options for LDAP  
server login:  
6. Click on Authority, and check the Role Name according to the  
current user’s role.  
Anonymous: This is used to bind with null password and login ID  
Users can create a new role group by clicking on the Add button.  
Machine status and advanced setup_ 90  
(Password and login ID are grayed out in SWS).  
Simple: This is used to bind with the login ID and password in SWS.  
Log  
11. Check the box next to Append Root to Base DN.  
12. Select Match User’s Login ID to the following LDAP attribute  
OPTION  
DESCRIPTION  
(options are CN, UID, or UserPrincipalName).  
13. Enter your login name, password, maximum number of search  
Job Log  
You can enable (or disable) job log to record job  
processing results. You can print the records in  
Machine Setup > Admin Setting > Print/Report tab  
> Job Log Report.  
results, and search timeout.  
LDAP Referral: LDAP client will search the referral server if the  
LDAP server has no data to reply to the query and if the LDAP  
server has a referral server.  
Operation Log  
You can enable (or disable) operation log to record  
various operations such as formatting the system,  
creating document box, deleting file, etc. You can  
print the records in Machine Setup > Admin Setting  
> Print/Report tab > Operation Log Report.  
14. Select Search Name Order.  
15. Check the box next to "From:" Field Security Options.  
This option is only provided if you have selected the Network  
authentication option in the user authentication setting. You may  
check this option if you want to search for information in a default  
email address group.  
Security Event  
Log  
You can enable or disable security event log to record  
history such as user authentication, software  
upgrading, access log, exporting or importing data,  
etc. You can print the records in Machine Setup >  
Admin Setting > Print/Report tab > Security Event  
Log Report.  
16. Click on Apply.  
User Accounting Method  
Enabling Acccounting Method  
Change Admin. Password  
You can change the password for the Admin Setting authentication.  
1. Enter your machine’s IP address as the URL in a browser and click  
Go to access the SyncThru™ Web Service of your machine.  
2. Log in to the SyncThru™ Web Service as an administrator. (See  
Information Hiding  
3. Select Security > User Access Control > Accounting >  
OPTION  
OPTION  
DESCRIPTION  
Accounting Method.  
4. Select Standard Accounting.  
Hiding Level  
Setting  
Show All  
Information  
All information in Job Status is  
displayed to all users.  
If you want to allow users to login only with ID, then check  
Show Non-  
Secure  
Information  
Non-secured information in Job  
Status is displayed to all users.  
The secured information, such as  
secured received fax list or  
secured print list, will be displayed  
only to the owner.  
Authenticate with Login ID only.  
5. Click on the Apply button.  
Only  
Standard acccounting List  
1. Enter your machine’s IP address as the URL in a browser and click  
Go to access the SyncThru™ Web Service of your machine.  
2. Log in to the SyncThru™ Web Service as an administrator. (See  
Show Own  
Information  
Only  
All information in Job Status is  
displayed to the owner.  
3. Select Security > User Access Control > Accounting > Standard  
Accounting List.  
4. Select Standard Accounting.  
Hiding Method  
Setting  
Char Counts Of Instead of the job name and  
owner's name in Job Status, you  
can see a sequence of asterisks  
(*) characters.  
Information  
You can add users to the accounting list by clicking on the Add  
button. Enter a user’s ID, password and assign job limitation to  
the user.  
Fixed Counts  
Except First  
Char  
The job name and owner’s name  
in Job Status display as many as  
entered number of asterisks (*)  
except the first character.  
5. Click on the Apply button.  
Fixed Counts  
The job name and owner’s name  
in Job Status display as many as  
entered number of asterisks (*).  
OPTIONAL SERVICE  
When you want to add the optional features for this machine, you have to  
install the optional kit and then set the machine to enable and activate those  
features. Follow the next steps to enable those features.  
91 _Machine status and advanced setup  
         
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
2. Press Admin Setting. When the login message pops up, then enter  
password and press OK.  
3. Press the Setup tab > Optional Service.  
OPTION  
Public Box  
DESCRIPTION  
If you set this option to Administrators only, only  
the administrator can delete the publicly stored  
boxes in User Box, because the machine will asks  
the password of administrator.  
Deletion  
OPTION  
DESCRIPTION  
Copy  
Enables or disables the Copy menu from the main  
screen.  
STANDARD WORKFLOW MANAGEMENT  
You can set whether to use or not to use each features that standard  
workflow provides.  
Analog Fax  
Scan to Email  
Scan to PC  
After installing the fax kit, select this option Enable  
to use this machine as a fax machine.  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
2. Press Admin Setting. When the login message pops up, then enter  
password and press OK.  
3. Press the Setup tab > Standard Workflow Management.  
Enables or disables the Scan to Email menu from  
the scan screen.  
Set Enable to activate the scanning and sending it  
via network.  
Scan to SMB  
Scan to FTP  
Enables or disables the Scan to SMB option from  
the scan screen.  
Enables or disables the Scan to FTP option from  
the scan screen.  
Manual Image  
Overwrite  
You can set the machine to delete previous job  
information on HDD as you store new job  
information. Set this option to Enable, go to the  
General tab > Manual Image Overwrite, press  
Start in the display to start the overwriting job.  
Automatic Image  
Overwrite  
If you select Enable, the machine renews the HDD  
memory when you save new job on it.  
OPTION  
DESCRIPTION  
Auto Redirection  
To create and execute a workform including the  
auto redirection feature, enable this option.  
DOCUMENT BOX MANAGEMENT  
You can set a person performing deletion of the public boxes in User Box  
.
Approve  
To create and execute a workform including the  
approval feature, enable this option.  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
2. Press Admin Setting. When the login message pops up, then enter  
password and press OK.  
3. Press the Setup tab > Document Box Management.  
Complete Report  
To add a completion report in your workform,  
enable this option.  
Complete  
Notification  
To add a completion notification in your workform,  
enable this option.  
Default Fax  
To create and execute a workform including the  
fax feature, enable this option.  
Machine status and advanced setup_ 92  
           
PRINTING A REPORT  
OPTION  
OPTION  
DESCRIPTION  
You can print a report on the machine's configuration or font list, etc.  
Fax Report  
Fax Report  
You can set to print the  
Report  
(Continue)  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
2. Press Admin Setting. When the login message pops up, then enter  
password and press OK.  
3. Press the Print/Report tab.  
information of a fax reports.  
Multi Send Report: When you  
fax to several destination, set  
this option to print a  
transmission report. On is to  
print every time you send a  
fax, the machine prints a  
confirmation report. With On-  
Error, only when the  
transmission error occurred,  
the report will be printed out.  
Fax Send Report  
Appearance: You can select  
whether the image on the  
confirmation report shows or  
not.  
Fax Sent/Received Report:  
The machine stores the logs  
on each transmission and  
prints out every 50 logs with  
this option On. It you select  
Off, the machine stores the  
logs but does not print.  
OPTION  
Print  
OPTION  
DESCRIPTION  
You can print Network  
Configuration, PS3 Font List,  
PCL Font List and Schedule  
Jobs Report. Schedule Jobs  
Report shows the job list in  
pending, in delayed faxing or the  
Mailbox list as well.  
Fax Send Report: The  
machine prints the  
confirmation report after each  
fax job, only when you send a  
fax to one destination.  
Accounting  
Reports  
Supplies  
Information  
You can print the amount of each  
category that your machine has  
printed so far.  
E-mail  
Confirmation  
Report  
The report shows the job of  
scanning and sending it via Scan  
to Email.  
Network Auth.  
Log Report  
It displays user login IDs and  
emails.  
On: The report is printed  
whether a job successfully  
completed or failed.  
Off: No report is printed after  
completing a job.  
On-Error: Only in case of error  
occurrence, the machine prints  
the report.  
Usage Page  
Report  
You can print the report on the  
amount of printouts depending on  
the paper size and type.  
Accounting  
Report  
Prints the report of printing out  
count for each login user.  
Scan to Server  
Confirmation  
The report shows the job of  
scanning and sending it via SMB  
and FTP.  
Standard Acct.  
Usage Report  
Prints the used amount of  
Standard Accounting  
On: The report is printed  
whether a job successfully  
completed or failed.  
Standard Acct.  
Remain Report  
Prints the remained amount of  
Standard Accounting  
Off: No report is printed after  
completing a job.  
On-Error: Only in case of error  
occurrence, the machine prints  
the report.  
Configuration  
Report  
You can print a report on the  
machine's overall configuration.  
Report  
You can also print machine's status information and browse status  
with SyncThru™ Web Service. Open the web browser on your  
networked computer and type the IP address of your machine.  
When SyncThru™ Web Service opens, click Information > Print  
information.  
93 _Machine status and advanced setup  
                             
maintenance  
This chapter provides information for maintaining your machine and the toner cartridge.  
This chapter includes  
4. Press Toner Low Alert to enable this option not, and press Toner Low  
PRINTING A MACHINE REPORT  
Alert Level to set the remained life level.  
5. Press OK  
.
MONITORING THE SUPPLIES LIFE  
CHECKING DOCUMENT BOX  
If you want to view the supply life indicators, follow the next step.  
The machine shows the document box list of the print or fax job.  
Press Document Box on the Main screen. If the screen displays an other  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
2. Press Machine Status  
.
menu, press (  
) to go to the Main screen.  
3. Scroll down to browse the entire supplies list view the percentage  
remaining.  
FINDING THE SERIAL NUMBER  
If you want to check your serial number from the screen, follow the next  
steps.  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
2. Press Machine Status > the Machine Info tab > Machine Details  
.
SENDING THE IMAGING UNIT REORDER  
NOTIFICATION  
You can set the machine to alert you that the life of the imaging unit is  
almost over and needs to be reordered.  
User Box tab: Create the box where you can save the document  
such as the file you have printed, sent by email or scanned. When  
you create a box, you can set the password to secure your box. The  
box with a password is called Secured Box, and without it, it is  
called public box.  
System Box tab: The machine provided default boxes, which you  
cannot modify them.  
Type: Shows the box is secured or not.  
Box Name: Shows the box name.  
Owner: Shows the user name of a box.  
Date: Shows the date of a box created.  
File: Shows the number of total files in the box.  
Add: Lets you add more boxes.  
Delete: Deletes the selected box.  
Edit: Lets you to modify a box name and an owner name.  
Detail: Shows box information.  
Search: Searches a box with a box name or an owner name.  
Enter: Prints or sends the stored file in the box.  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
2. Press Admin Setting. When the login message pops up, then enter  
password and press OK  
.
3. Press the General tab > Supplies Management > Imaging Unit  
Reorder Notification.  
4. Press Imaging Unit Low Alert to enable this option not, and press  
Imaging Unit Low Alert Level to set the remained life level.  
5. Press OK  
.
SENDING THE TONER REORDER  
NOTIFICATION  
You can set the machine to alert you that the toner level is low and needs to  
be reordered.  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
2. Press Admin Setting. When the login message pops up, then enter  
CLEANING YOUR MACHINE  
password and press OK  
3. Press the General tab > Supplies Management > Toner Cartridge  
.
To maintain print and scan quality, follow the cleaning procedures below  
each time the toner cartridge is replaced or if print and scan quality  
problems occur.  
Reorder Notification.  
Maintenance_ 94  
                                   
7. Plug the power cable and turn the machine on.  
Cleaning the cabinet of the machine with cleaning materials  
containing large amounts of alcohol, solvent, or other strong  
substances can discolor or distort the cabinet.  
If your machine or its surrounding is contaminated with toner, we  
recommend you to use cloth or tissue dampened with water to  
clean it. If you use a vacuum cleaner, toner blows in the air and  
might be harmful to you.  
Cleaning the scan unit  
Keeping the scan unit clean helps ensure the best possible copies. We  
suggest that you clean the scan unit at the start of each day and during the  
day, as needed.  
1. Slightly dampen a soft lint-free cloth or paper towel with water.  
2. Open the scanner lid.  
3. Wipe the surface of the scanner glass and DADF glass until it is clean  
Cleaning the outside  
Clean the machine cabinet with a soft lint-free cloth. You can dampen the  
cloth slightly with water, but be careful not to let any water drip onto or into  
the machine.  
and dry.  
Cleaning the inside  
Contact a service representative to clean the inside of the machine.  
Cleaning the transfer unit  
The cleaning the transfer unit within this machine is recommended for its  
printing quality. The cleaning period is best once a year or once 10,000  
pages printing.  
1. Prepare a soft lint-free cloth.  
2. Turn off the machine.  
3. Unplug the power cable.  
4. Open the side cover.  
1 white sheet  
2 DADF glass  
3 scanner lid  
4 scanner glass  
4. Wipe the underside of the scanner lid and white sheet until it is clean  
and dry.  
5. Close the scanner lid.  
MAINTAINING THE TONER CARTRIDGE  
Toner cartridge storage  
Toner cartridges contain components that are sensitive to light,  
temperature, and humidity. Samsung suggests users follow the  
recommendations to ensure the optimum performance, highest quality, and  
longest life from your new Samsung toner cartridge.  
Store this cartridge in the same environment as the printer it will be used in;  
this should be in controlled office temperature and humidity conditions. The  
toner cartridge should remain in its original, unopened package until  
installation – If original packaging is not available, cover the top opening of  
the cartridge with paper and store in a dark cabinet.  
5. Wipe the surface of the transfer unit.  
Opening the cartridge package prior to use dramatically shortens its useful  
shelf and operating life. Do not store on the floor. If the toner cartridge is  
removed from the printer, always store the cartridge:  
Inside the protective bag from the original package  
Correct side up in a horizontal position (not standing on end)  
Do not store consumables in;  
- Temperature greater than 40°C (104°F).  
- Humidity range less than 20% and not greater than 80%.  
- An environment with extreme changes in humidity or temperature.  
- Direct sunlight or room light.  
- Dusty places.  
- A car for a long period of time.  
- An environment where corrosive gases are present.  
- An environment with salty air.  
6. Close the side cover.  
95 _Maintenance  
                       
Handling instructions  
Do not touch the surface of the photosensitive drum in the cartridge.  
Do not expose the cartridge to unnecessary vibrations or shock.  
Never manually rotate the drum, especially in the reverse direction; this  
can cause internal damage and toner spillage.  
Use of non-Samsung and refilled toner cartridge  
Samsung Electronics does not recommend or approve the use of non-  
Samsung brand toner cartridges in your printer including generic, store  
brand, refilled, or remanufactured toner cartridges.  
Samsung’s printer warranty does not cover damage to the machine  
caused by the use of a refilled, remanufactured, or non-Samsung  
brand toner cartridge.  
Estimated cartridge life  
Estimated cartridge life (the life of the toner cartridge yield) depends on the  
amount of toner that print jobs require. The actual print-out number may  
vary depending on the print density of the pages you print on, operating  
environment, printing interval, media type, and/or media size. For example,  
if you print a lot of graphics, the consumption of the toner is high and you  
may need to change the cartridge more often.  
3. Turn the cartridge locking lever toward the right until you hear a 'click', to  
release the toner cartridge.  
Replacing the toner cartridge  
When the toner cartridge is completely empty:  
Toner is empty. Replace toner cartridg appears on the display.  
The machine stops printing. Incoming faxes are saved in memory.  
At this stage, the toner cartridge needs to be replaced.Check the type of the  
toner cartridge for your machine. (See "Supplies" on page 121.)  
1. Open the side cover.  
4. Lift the locking lever and pull the toner cartridge out.  
2. Open the front cover.  
5. Remove the new toner cartridge from its bag.  
6. Thoroughly roll the cartridge five or six times to distribute the toner  
evenly inside the cartridge.  
Maintenance_ 96  
         
MAINTAINING THE IMAGING UNIT  
Expected cartridge life  
The useful life of the imaging unit is approximately 80,000 pages. The  
screen displays Imaging unit is worn. Replace with new one when the life  
of the imaging unit is almost ended. Approximately 6,000 more pages can  
be made after the warning message related to the imaging unit, but you  
should have a replacement imaging unit in stock. Imaging unit yield may be  
affected by the operating environment, optional, printing interval, media type  
and media size.  
If toner gets on your clothing, wipe it off with a dry cloth and wash  
clothing in cold water. Hot water sets toner into fabric.  
Imaging unit is worn. Replace with new one appears on the display.  
7. Hold the toner cartridge by the handle and slowly insert the cartridge into  
For ordering information for imaging unit. (See "Supplies" on page 121.)  
the opening in the machine.  
To prevent damage to the imaging unit, do not expose it to light for  
more than a few minutes.  
Replacing the imaging unit  
1. Open the side cover.  
8. Slide the new toner cartridge in until it locks in place.  
9. Turn the cartridge locking lever toward the left until you hear a 'click'.  
2. Open the front cover.  
10. Close the front cover, then the side cover.  
After replacing the toner cartridge, wait for several minutes without  
powering off until the machine enters to standby mode. Otherwise it  
may cause malfunction of the machine.  
3. Turn the cartridge locking lever toward the right until you hear a 'click', to  
release the toner cartridge.  
97 _Maintenance  
             
If toner gets on your clothing, wipe it off with a dry cloth and wash  
clothing in cold water. Hot water sets toner into fabric.  
Do not touch the green part, midside of the imaging unit. Use the  
handle on the cartridge to avoid touching this area.  
9. Unpack the new imaging unit and slide it into place, making sure not to  
touch the surface of the imaging unit.  
4. Lift the locking lever and pull the toner cartridge out.  
10. Slide the toner cartridge in until it locks in place.  
11. Turn the cartridge locking lever toward the left until you hear a 'click'.  
The toner cartridge must be removed to replace the imaging unit.  
5. Pull the used imaging unit out.  
12. Close the front cover, then the side cover.  
After replacing the toner cartridge, wait for several minutes without  
powering off until the machine enters to standby mode. Otherwise it  
may cause malfunction of the machine.  
6. Remove the new imaging unit from its bag.  
7. Open the carefully pull the seal tape out of the cartridge.  
8. Thoroughly shake the imaging unit side to side five or six times.  
Maintenance_ 98  
MAINTENANCE PARTS  
To avoid print quality and paper feed problems resulting from worn parts  
and to maintain your machine in top working condition the following items  
will need to be replaced after the specified number of pages or when the life  
span of each item has expired.  
ITEMS  
DADF rubber pad  
YIELD (AVERAGE)  
Approx. 50,000 pages  
Approx. 50,000 pages  
Approx. 250,000 pages  
Approx. 200,000 pages  
Approx. 125,000 pages  
Approx. 250,000 pages  
Approx. 250,000 pages  
Multi-purpose tray rubber pad  
DADF feed roller  
Multi-purpose tray feed roller  
Transfer roller  
Fuser unit  
Paper Feed roller  
We highly recommend that this maintenance be performed by an authorized  
service provider, dealer or the retailer where you bought the machine. The  
warranty does not cover the replacement of the maintenance parts after  
their lifespan.  
MANAGING YOUR MACHINE FROM THE  
WEBSITE  
If you have connected your machine to a network and set up TCP/IP  
network parameters correctly, you can manage the machine via Samsung’s  
SyncThru™ Web Service, an embedded web server. Use SyncThru™  
Web Service to:  
View the machine’s device information and check its current status.  
Change TCP/IP parameters and set up other network parameters.  
Change the printer properties.  
Set the machine to send email notifications to let you know the  
machine’s status.  
Get support for using the machine.  
To access SyncThru™ Web Service:  
1. Start a web browser, such as Internet Explorer, from Windows.  
2. Enter the machine IP address (http://xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx) in the address  
field and press the Enter key or click Go.  
Your machine’s embedded website opens.  
SyncThru™ Web Service allows administrator to set up the  
machine. If you want to access Settings or Security menu, login  
first. Press Login button, and enter user ID and password from the  
pop-up window. Then press LOGIN button.  
The initial administrator’s setting is as follows:  
The default ID: admin  
The default password: sec00000  
99 _Maintenance  
         
troubleshooting  
This chapter gives helpful information for what to do if you encounter an error.  
This chapter includes:  
TIPS FOR AVOIDING PAPER JAMS  
By selecting the correct media types, most paper jams can be avoided.  
When a paper jam occurs, follow the steps outlined on page 100.  
Ensure that the adjustable guides are positioned correctly. (see  
Do not overload the tray. Ensure that the paper level is below the paper  
capacity mark on the inside of the tray.  
Do not remove paper from the tray while your machine is printing.  
Flex, fan, and straighten paper before loading.  
Do not use creased, damp, or highly curled paper.  
Do not mix paper types in a tray.  
Use only recommended print media. (See "Setting the paper size and  
Ensure that the recommended side of the print media is facing down in  
the tray, or facing down in the multi-purpose tray.  
If paper jams occur frequently when you print on A5/B5-sized paper:  
Load the paper into the tray with the long edge facing the front of the  
tray. If load the paper this way, printing both sides of the paper (Duplex)  
is not supported.  
3. Gently remove the jammed paper from the DADF.  
In the printer properties window, set the page orientation to be rotated  
90 degrees. See Software section.  
CLEARING DOCUMENT JAMS  
When an original jams while passing through the DADF, the warming  
message appears on the display screen.  
To avoid tearing the document, remove the jammed document gently  
and slowly.  
If you see no paper in this area, refer to Roller misfeed. (See  
To prevent document jams, use the scanner glass for thick, thin, or  
mixed paper-type originals.  
4. Close the DADF cover. Then reload the pages you removed, if any, in  
1. Remove any remaining pages from the DADF.  
2. Open the DADF cover.  
the DADF.  
Troubleshooting_ 100  
           
Misfeed of exiting paper  
1. Remove the remaining documents from the DADF.  
Roller misfeed  
1. Open the scanner lid.  
2. Open the DADF cover.  
2. Grasp the misfeed paper, and remove the paper from the feed area by  
carefully pulling it to the right using both hands.  
3. Open the document input tray upwards and pull the document gently out  
1 scanner lid  
If you do not see the paper in this area, stop and go to step 3.  
3. Open the white document background.  
of the DADF.  
4. Close the DADF cover and the document input tray. Then place the  
4. Remove the paper from the feed area by carefully pulling.  
documents back in the DADF.  
101 _Troubleshooting  
     
5. Close the white document background and the scanner lid. Then load  
In the tray 1  
the removed pages back into the DADF.  
1. Pull out the paper tray to open. After you pull it out completely, lift the  
front part of the tray up slightly to release the tray from the machine.  
CLEARING PAPER JAMS  
When a paper jam occurs, the warming message appears on the display  
screen. Refer to the table below to locate and clear the paper jam.  
MESSAGE  
LOCATION OF JAM  
GO TO  
Paper Jam in tray 1, In the paper feed area  
See "In the multi-  
(tray 1, optional tray, or purpose tray" on  
Paper Jam in tray 2,  
Paper Jam in tray 2  
(HCF),  
multi-purpose tray)  
See "In the optional  
Paper Jam in tray 3,  
Paper Jam in tray 3  
(HCF),  
Paper Jam in tray 4,  
Paper Jam in MP  
tray  
Paper Jam in exit  
area  
In the fuser area or  
around the toner  
cartridge  
See "In the fuser area  
2. Remove the jammed paper by gently pulling it straight out.  
Paper Jam inside of In the paper exit area  
machine  
Paper Jam at the  
bottom of duplex  
path,  
In the duplex unit  
Paper Jam at the  
top of duplex path,  
Paper Jam inside of  
duplex path  
Paper jam in front of In the stacker unit  
finisher  
See "Paper jam in front  
Once you remove the jammed paper here, open the side cover and then  
close it to clear the error message on the display.  
Paper jam inside  
finisher, Paper jam  
inside finisher’s  
duplex  
In the stacker unit  
In the stacker unit  
See "Paper jam inside  
inside finisher’s  
If there is any resistance, and the paper does not move immediately when  
you pull, stop pulling. Then:  
3. Open the side cover.  
Paper jam at exit of  
finisher  
See "Paper jam at exit  
To avoid tearing the paper, pull the jammed paper out gently and  
slowly. Follow the instructions in the following sections to clear the  
jam.  
Troubleshooting_ 102  
         
In the optional tray  
Do not touch the shiny imaging unit surface. Scratches or smudges  
will result in poor print quality.  
This part explains the method of removing the jammed paper in the  
optional tray 2. Please refer to the next method for other optional trays,  
since the method is same as the tray 2.  
4. Carefully remove the misfeed paper in the direction shown.  
1. Open the outer cover in tray 2.  
5. Close the side cover and insert the paper tray. Lower the rear part of the  
Tray to align the rear edge with the corresponding slot of the machine,  
then insert it completely.  
2. Open the inner cover of tray 2.  
3. Pull the jammed paper out in the direction shown. To avoid tearing the  
paper, pull it out gently and slowly.  
If the paper does not move when you pull, or if you do not see the paper  
103 _Troubleshooting  
   
in this area, stop and go to step 4.  
4. Pull out the optional tray 2.  
5. Lift the front part of the tray slightly up to release the tray from the  
machine.  
In the optional high capacity feeder  
1. Open the outer cover of the high capacity feeder.  
If the paper does not move when you pull, or if you do not see the paper  
in this area, stop and go to step 6.  
6. Remove the paper in the direction shown. To avoid tearing the paper,  
pull it out gently and slowly.  
2. Open the inner cover of the high capacity feeder.  
7. Insert the tray 2 and close the two covers.  
Troubleshooting_ 104  
       
3. Pull the jammed paper out, in the direction shown, pulling gently and  
6. Remove the paper in the direction shown. Pull it out gently and slowly in  
slowly in order to avoid tearing the paper.  
order to avoid tearing the paper.  
If the paper does not move when you pull, or if you do not see the paper  
in this area, stop and go to step 4.  
4. Pull out the optional high capacity feeder.  
5. Lift the front part of the tray slightly up to release the tray from the  
7. Insert the optional high capacity feeder and close the two covers.  
machine.  
If the paper does not move when you pull, or if you do not see the paper  
in this area, stop and go to step 6.  
If you do not see any paper in this area, stop and go to step 6.  
105 _Troubleshooting  
   
2. Remove the jammed paper, in the direction shown.  
In the multi-purpose tray  
1. If the paper is not feeding properly, pull the paper out of the machine.  
3. Close the side cover.  
2. Open and close the side cover. Printing automatically resumes.  
In the paper exit area  
1. Open the side cover.  
2. Gently pull the paper out through the exit area.  
In the fuser area or around the toner cartridge  
The fuser area is hot. Take care when removing paper from the  
machine.  
3. Close the side cover. Printing automatically resumes.  
1. Open the side cover.  
Troubleshooting_ 106  
             
2. Press the right part of lever (1c) and hold still, then push the stacker  
In the duplex unit area  
If the duplex unit is not inserted correctly, paper jam may occur. Make sure  
that the duplex unit is inserted correctly.  
to the left to release the stacker.  
1. Open the side cover.  
2. Release the guide to pull the jammed paper easily.  
3. Remove the jammed paper.  
4. Slide in the stacker until you hear the sound ‘click’.  
5. Close the stacker front cover.  
3. Remove the jammed paper.  
Paper jam inside finisher, Paper jam inside finisher’s  
duplex  
1. Open the stacker front cover.  
4. Close the side cover.  
In the stacker (finisher)  
2. Pull the stacker lever 1a down. If necessary, pull the stacker lever 1b  
Paper jam in front of finisher  
1. Open the stacker front cover.  
down as well.  
107 _Troubleshooting  
           
3. Remove the jammed paper.  
UNDERSTANDING DISPLAY MESSAGES  
Messages appear on the Smart Panel program window or on the control  
panel display to indicate machine status or errors. Refer to the tables below  
to understand the messages meaning to correct the problem, if necessary.  
Messages and their explanations are listed in alphabetical order.  
If the message is not in the table, cycle the power and try the  
printing job again. If the problem persists, call for service.  
When you call for service, it is very convenient to provide the  
service representative with the contents of display message.  
Some messages may not appear in the display depending on  
options or models.  
[yyy] indicates the part of the machine.  
[zzz] indicates the error code. When you contact the service  
center, this error code help to handle the problem.  
You may see an exclamation mark (  
) or a cross mark (  
) on  
the upper left of the display, in that case, press the question mark  
to browse detailed information on the supplies.  
4. Pull up on the stacker lever and then close the stacker front cover.  
.
SUGGESTED  
SOLUTIONS  
MESSAGE  
MEANING  
[yyy] is worn.  
Replace with new  
one  
The life of the part  
expires totally.  
Replace the part with a  
new one. Call for  
service.  
DC motor does not  
operate: [zzz].  
Please turn off then  
on  
There is a problem in  
the control of DC  
motor unit.  
Turn the machine off  
and turn it on again. If  
the problem persists,  
please call for service.  
Did not supply  
enough toner.  
Remove seal tape &  
reinstall  
Not supplied toner to  
the imaging unit.  
Remove the sealing  
tape from the  
imaging unit.  
Thoroughly roll the  
toner cartridge five or  
six times, and  
reinstall it.  
Turn the machine off  
and turn it on again.  
Paper jam at exit of finisher  
1. Gently pull the paper out through the exit area.  
Did not supply  
enough toner.  
Please open/close  
door  
The machine received Open side door and  
several papers with  
many images, and it  
cannot supply the  
toner properly.  
close it. If the problem  
still persists, please call  
for service.  
Fax memory is  
almost full. Print or  
remove received fax  
Job  
There is no more  
Delete the received fax  
available fax memory. data in the memory to  
No more fax data can secure memory. Call  
be received.  
for service.  
Fax memory is full.  
Print or remove  
received fax Job  
Available fax memory Delete the received fax  
is now 1MB.  
data in the memory to  
secure memory. Call  
for service.  
Finisher door is  
open. Close it  
The finisher cover is  
not securely latched.  
Close the finisher until it  
locks into place.  
Troubleshooting_ 108  
         
SUGGESTED  
SOLUTIONS  
SUGGESTED  
SOLUTIONS  
MESSAGE  
MEANING  
MESSAGE  
MEANING  
Finisher error: [zzz]. There is a problem in  
Please turn off then  
on  
Turn the machine off  
and reinstall the finisher  
again. Check that the  
finisher cable is  
connected properly. If  
the problem persists,  
please call for service.  
Original paper is too Oversized document  
long for scanner.  
Check size  
Open the DADF cover  
and remove the  
jammed original. (See  
Check the document  
size whether it is  
the finisher unit.  
or double-feeding of  
originals.  
Fuser error: [zzz].  
Please turn off then  
on  
There is a problem in  
Turn the machine off  
the fuser unit working. and turn it on again. If  
the problem persists,  
please call for service.  
Original paper jam  
in front of scanner  
The originals are  
jammed in DADF.  
Open the DADF cover  
and remove the  
jammed original. (See  
Fuser unit is not  
installed correctly.  
Install it  
The fuser unit is not  
installed or correctly.  
Install the fuser unit.  
Call for service.  
Original paper jam  
in front of scanner  
duplex path  
Paper has jammed  
Clear the jam. (See  
Imaging unit is  
empty. Replace it  
The toner in the  
imaging unit has run  
out.  
Replace the imaging  
unit with a Samsung-  
genuine toner cartridge.  
during duplex printing "Clearing document  
in the DADF.  
Original paper jam  
inside of scanner  
The lead edge of the  
document failed to  
actuate the gate  
sensor within the  
correct time after  
actuating the scan  
sensor.  
Open the DADF cover  
and remove the  
jammed original. (See  
Imaging unit is not  
compatible. Check  
user’s guide  
The imaging unit you  
have installed is not  
for your machine.  
Install a Samsung-  
genuine imaging unit,  
designed for your  
machine.  
When the machine is  
on, jammed paper is  
detected in the DADF.  
Imaging unit is not  
installed. Install it  
The imaging unit is  
not installed, or the  
CRUM (Consumer  
Replaceable Unit  
Monitor) in the  
cartridge is not  
connected.  
Install the imaging unit.  
If it is already installed,  
try to reinstall the  
imaging unit.  
Original paper jam  
while reversing  
paper in scanner  
The lead edge of the  
document failed to  
actuate the duplex  
sensor within the  
Lift up the document  
input tray and remove  
the jammed original.  
If the problem persists,  
please call for service.  
correct time when the document jams" on  
document was fed the page 100.)  
wrong way.  
Imaging unit is  
worn. Replace with  
new one  
The imaging unit is at  
the end of its life.  
When the imaging unit genuine imaging unit.  
replacement message (See "Replacing the  
appears on the screen imaging unit" on  
and if you select  
Continue, this  
message displays.  
Replace a imaging unit  
with a Samsung-  
Paper jam at exit of  
finisher  
Paper jammed in the  
stacker exit part.  
Pull jammed paper  
from the stacker exit.  
Paper Jam at the  
bottom of duplex  
path  
Paper has jammed  
Clear the jam. (See "In  
during duplex printing. the duplex unit area" on  
LSU error: [zzz].  
Please turn off then  
on  
There is a problem in  
the control of LSU  
unit.  
Turn the machine off  
and turn it on again. If  
the problem persists,  
please call for service.  
Paper Jam at the top  
of duplex path  
Paper Jam in exit  
area  
Paper has jammed in  
the fuser area.  
Clear the jam. (See "In  
the fuser area or  
cartridge" on  
Motor does not  
operate: [zzz].  
Please turn off then  
on  
There is a problem in  
the control of motor  
unit.  
Turn the machine off  
and turn it on again. If  
the problem persists,  
please call for service.  
Original paper does  
not feed in scanner  
The lead edge of the  
document failed to  
actuate the scan  
sensor within the  
correct time after  
actuating the  
Open the DADF cover  
and remove jammed  
Paper jam in front of Paper jammed in the  
finisher  
Open the stacker door  
and remove jammed  
paper by lowering  
guide 1a or 1b.  
stacker.  
Paper jam inside  
finisher  
registration sensor.  
109 _Troubleshooting  
SUGGESTED  
SOLUTIONS  
SUGGESTED  
SOLUTIONS  
MESSAGE  
MEANING  
MESSAGE  
MEANING  
Paper Jam in MP  
tray  
Paper Misfed from  
multi-purpose tray  
Clear the jam. (See "In  
Staple cartridge is  
not installed. Install  
it in finisher  
The staple cartridge is Install the staple  
not installed.  
cartridge following the  
steps explained on the  
back of the finisher  
to continue the print job  
and disregard of this  
error message, go to  
Admin Setting to  
Paper Jam in tray 1  
Paper Jam in tray 2  
Paper misfed from  
tray  
Or paper has jammed  
in the tray feed area.  
Or the tray cover is  
opened.  
Clear the jam. (See "In  
see "In the optional  
Paper Jam in tray 2  
(HCF)  
adjust the option. (See  
Paper Jam in tray 3  
Paper Jam in tray 3  
(HCF)  
System error: [zzz].  
Please turn off then  
on  
There is a problem in  
Turn the machine off  
the system operation. and turn it on again. If  
the problem persists,  
Paper Jam in tray 4  
please call for service.  
Paper jam inside  
finisher’s duplex  
Paper jammed in the  
stacker.  
Open the stacker door  
and remove jammed  
paper by lowering  
guide 1a or 1b.  
This IP address  
conflicts with an IP  
address already in  
use. Check it  
The IP address is  
used in other place  
elsewhere.  
Check the IP address  
or obtain a new IP  
address.  
Paper Jam inside of Paper has jammed  
duplex path  
Clear the jam. (See "In  
during duplex printing. the duplex unit area" on  
Toner cartridge is  
not compatible.  
Check user’s guide  
The toner cartridge  
you have installed is  
not for your machine.  
Install a Samsung-  
genuine tonercartridge,  
designed for your  
machine.  
Paper Jam inside of Paper has jammed in  
machine  
Clear the jam. (See "In  
the registration area.  
Toner cartridge is  
not installed. Install  
it  
The toner cartridge is  
not installed or the  
CRUM (Consumer  
Replaceable Unit  
Monitor) in the  
Try to reinstall the toner  
cartridge.  
Scanner locking  
switch is locked or  
another problem  
occurred  
The CCD (Charged  
Couple Device) lock  
has been locked. The page 18.) Or turn off  
CCD does not detect  
its home location or  
move.  
Unlock the CCD lock.  
the machine and on  
again. Try again. If the  
problem persists, call  
for service.  
cartridge is not  
properly connected.  
Toner cartridge is  
worn. Replace with  
new one  
The toner cartridge is  
at the end of its life.  
When the toner  
Rplace a toner  
cartridge with a  
Samsung-genuine  
Shake toner  
cartridge  
The toner supply is  
low.  
Thoroughly roll the new  
cartridge five or six  
times to distribute the  
toner evenly inside the  
cartridge.  
cartridge replacement toner cartridge. (See  
message appears on  
the screen and if you  
select Continue, this  
message displays.  
Staple cartridge is  
empty. Replace it  
Stapler is run out.  
Order Staple Cartridge.  
page 121.) And replace  
Toner is empty.  
Replace toner  
cartridge  
The lifespan of the  
toner cartridge which  
the arrow indicates is  
reached.  
This message appears  
when the toner is  
completely empty, and  
your machine stops  
printing. Replace the  
toner cartridge with a  
Samsung-genuine  
toner cartridge. (See  
Toner is low. Order  
new toner cartridge  
The toner cartridge is  
almost empty.  
Ensure a replacement  
cartridge is in stock.  
Too much paper in  
finisher stacker.  
Remove printed  
paper  
The stacker is full of  
printouts.  
Remove printouts from  
the stacker.  
Troubleshooting_ 110  
SOLVING OTHER PROBLEMS  
The following chart lists some conditions that may occur and the  
recommended solutions. Follow the suggested solutions until the problem is  
corrected. If the problem persists, please call for service.  
SUGGESTED  
SOLUTIONS  
MESSAGE  
MEANING  
Too much paper in  
output bin tray.  
Remove printed  
paper  
The printed papers  
are full on the output  
tray.  
Remove printed outs  
from the output tray.  
Touch screen problem  
CONDITION  
SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS  
Use Auxiliary  
Access  
The credit is not  
enough to access the  
job according to  
Foreign Device.  
Insert credit into the  
Foreign Device.  
The touch screen  
does not show  
anything.  
Turn the machine off and turn it on again. If the  
problem persists, please call for service.  
Paper feeding problems  
CONDITION  
SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS  
Paper is jammed  
during printing.  
Clear the paper jam. (See "Clearing paper  
Paper sticks  
together.  
Check the maximum paper capacity of the tray.  
Make sure that you are using the correct type  
Remove paper from the tray and flex or fan the  
paper.  
Humid conditions may cause some paper to  
stick together.  
Multiple sheets of  
paper do not feed.  
Different types of paper may be stacked in the  
tray. Load paper of only one type, size, and  
weight.  
If multiple sheets have caused a paper jam,  
clear the paper jam. (See "Clearing paper  
Paper does not feed  
into the machine.  
Remove any obstructions from inside the  
machine.  
Paper has not been loaded correctly. Remove  
paper from the tray and reload it correctly.  
There is too much paper in the tray. Remove  
excess paper from the tray.  
The paper is too thick. Use only paper that  
meets the specifications required by the  
If an original does not feed into the machine,  
the DADF rubber pad may require to be  
replaced. Contact a service representative.  
111 _Troubleshooting  
         
Printing problems  
CONDITION  
SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS  
CONDITION  
POSSIBLE CAUSE  
SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS  
The paper keeps  
jamming.  
There is too much paper in the tray. Remove  
excess paper from the tray. If you are printing  
on special materials, use the multi-purpose  
tray.  
An incorrect type of paper is being used. Use  
only paper that meets the specifications  
required by the machine. (See "Specification  
There may be debris inside the machine. Open  
the front cover and remove the debris.  
If an original does not feed into the machine,  
the DADF rubber pad may need to be  
replaced. Contact a service representative.  
The machine  
does not print.  
The machine is not  
receiving power.  
Check the power cord  
connections. Check the  
power switch and the power  
source.  
The machine is not  
selected as the  
default printer.  
Select Samsung SCX-6545  
Series PCL 6 (or Samsung  
SCX-6545 Series PS) as  
your default printer in your  
Windows.  
Check the machine for the following:  
The side cover is not closed. Close the side  
cover.  
Paper is jammed. Clear the paper jam. (See  
No paper is loaded. Load paper. (See "Loading  
The toner cartridge or the imaging unit is not  
installed. Install the toner cartridge or the imaging  
unit.  
Transparencies  
stick together in the  
paper exit.  
Use only transparencies specifically designed for  
laser printers. Remove each transparency as it  
exits from the machine.  
Envelopes skew or  
fail to feed correctly.  
Ensure that the paper guides are against both  
sides of the envelopes.  
If a system error occurs, contact your service  
representative.  
The connection  
Disconnect the printer cable  
and reconnect it.  
cable between the  
computer and the  
machine is not  
connected properly.  
The connection  
cable between the  
computer and the  
machine is  
If possible, attach the cable  
to another computer that is  
working properly and print a  
job. You can also try using a  
different printer cable.  
defective.  
The port setting is  
incorrect.  
Check the Windows printer  
setting to make sure that the  
print job is sent to the correct  
port. If the computer has  
more than one port, make  
sure that the machine is  
attached to the correct one.  
The machine may  
be configured  
incorrectly.  
Check the printer properties  
to ensure that all of the print  
settings are correct.  
The printer driver  
may be incorrectly  
installed.  
Repair the printer software.  
See Software section.  
The machine is  
malfunctioning.  
Check the display message  
on the control panel to see if  
the machine is indicating a  
system error. Contact a  
service representative.  
Troubleshooting_ 112  
   
CONDITION  
POSSIBLE CAUSE  
SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS  
CONDITION  
POSSIBLE CAUSE  
SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS  
The machine  
does not print.  
(Continued)  
The document size  
is so big that the  
hard disk space of  
the computer is not  
enough to access  
the print job.  
Get more hard disk space  
and print the document  
again.  
Pages print, but  
they are blank.  
The toner cartridge  
Redistribute the toner, if  
is defective or out of necessary.  
toner.  
If necessary, replace the  
toner cartridge.  
The file may have  
blank pages.  
Check the file to ensure that  
it does not contain blank  
pages.  
The machine  
selects print  
materials from  
the wrong paper  
source.  
The paper option  
that was selected in  
For many software  
applications, the paper  
the printerproperties source selection is found  
Some parts, such as Contact a service  
may be incorrect.  
under the Paper tab within  
the printer properties. Select  
the correct paper source.  
See the printer driver help  
screen.  
the controller or the  
board, may be  
defective.  
representative.  
The printer does Incompatibility  
Printing the PDF file as an  
image may enable the file to  
print. Turn on Print As Image  
from the Acrobat printing  
options.  
between the PDF  
file and the Acrobat  
products.  
not print PDF file  
correctly. Some  
parts of  
graphics, text, or  
illustrations are  
missing.  
A print job is  
extremely slow.  
The job may be very Reduce the complexity of the  
complex.  
page or try adjusting the print  
quality settings.  
It will take longer to  
print when you print a  
PDF file as an image.  
Half the page is  
blank.  
The page orientation Change the page orientation  
setting may be  
incorrect.  
in your application. See the  
printer driver help screen.  
Your machine  
has an odd smell  
during initial  
use.  
The oil used to  
protect the fuser is  
evaporating.  
After printing about 100 color  
pages, there will be no more  
smell. It is a temporary issue.  
The paper size and  
the paper size  
settings do not  
match.  
Ensure that the paper size in  
the printer driver settings  
matches the paper in the  
tray.  
Or, ensure that the paper  
size in the printer driver  
settings matches the paper  
selection in the software  
application settings you use.  
The print quality The resolution of the Reduce the photo size. If you  
photo is very low.  
increase the photo size in the  
software application, the  
resolution will be reduced.  
of photos is not  
good. Images  
are not clear.  
The machine  
prints, but the  
text is wrong,  
garbled, or  
The printer cable is  
loose or defective.  
Disconnect the printer cable  
and reconnect. Try a print job  
that you have already printed  
successfully. If possible,  
attach the cable and the  
machine to another computer  
and try a print job that you  
know works. Finally, try a  
new printer cable.  
The machine  
prints, but the  
text is wrong,  
garbled, or  
If you are under the  
DOS environment,  
the font setting for  
your machine may  
be set incorrectly.  
Suggested solutions: Change  
the language setting. (See  
incomplete.  
incomplete.  
Before printing,  
the machine  
emits vapor near  
the output tray.  
Using damp paper  
can cause vapor  
during printing.  
This is not a problem. Just  
keep printing.  
The wrong printer  
Check the application’s  
driver was selected. printer selection menu to  
ensure that your machine is  
selected.  
The software  
application is  
malfunctioning.  
Try printing a job from  
another application.  
The operating  
system is  
malfunctioning.  
Exit Windows and reboot the  
computer. Turn the machine  
off and then back on again.  
113 _Troubleshooting  
Printing quality problems  
If the inside of the machine is dirty or paper has been loaded improperly,  
you may notice a reduction in print quality. See the table below to clear the  
problem.  
CONDITION  
White Spots  
SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS  
White spots appears on the page:  
The paper is too rough and a lot of dirt from  
a paper falls to the inner devices within the  
machine, so the transfer roller may be dirty.  
Clean the inside of your machine. (See  
Contact a service representative.  
CONDITION  
SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS  
Light or faded print If a vertical white streak or faded area appears  
on the page:  
The paper path may need cleaning.  
Contact a service representative.  
The toner supply is low. You may be able  
to temporarily extend the toner cartridge  
life. If this does not improve the print  
quality, install a new toner cartridge.  
The paper may not meet paper  
specifications; for example, the paper may  
be too moist or rough. (See "Specification  
Vertical lines  
If black vertical streaks appear on the page:  
The surface(drum part) of the imaging unit  
inside the machine has probably been  
scratched. Remove the imaging unit and  
install a new one. (See "Replacing the  
If the entire page is light, the print  
resolution setting is too low or the toner  
save mode is on. Adjust the print resolution  
and turn the toner save mode off. See the  
help screen of the printer driver and refer to  
Software section, respectively.  
If white vertical streaks appear on the page:  
The surface of the LSU part inside the  
machine may be dirty. Clean the LSU.  
Contact a service representative.  
A combination of faded or smeared defects  
may indicate that the toner cartridge needs  
cleaning. Contact a service representative.  
The surface of the LSU part inside the  
machine may be dirty. Clean the LSU,  
contact a service representative.  
Color or Black  
background  
If the amount of background shading becomes  
unacceptable:  
Change to a lighter weight paper. (See  
Check the environmental conditions: very  
dry conditions (low humidity) or a high level  
of humidity (higher than 80% RH) can  
increase the amount of background  
shading.  
Toner specks  
The paper may not meet specifications; for  
example, the paper may be too moist or  
The transfer roller may be dirty. Clean the  
inside of your machine. Contact a service  
representative.  
Remove the old imaging unit and then,  
install a new one. (See "Replacing the  
Toner smear  
Clean the inside of the machine. Contact a  
service representative.  
The paper path may need cleaning. Contact  
a service representative.  
Check the paper type and quality. (See  
Remove the imaging unit and then, install a  
Dropouts  
If faded areas, generally rounded, occur  
randomly on the page:  
A single sheet of paper may be defective.  
Try reprinting the job.  
The moisture content of the paper is  
uneven or the paper has moist spots on its  
surface. Try a different brand of paper.  
The paper lot is bad. The manufacturing  
processes can cause some areas to reject  
toner. Try a different kind or brand of  
paper.  
Change the printer option and try again. Go  
to printer properties, click Paper tab, and  
set type to Thick Paper. Refer to the  
Software section for details.  
If these steps do not correct the problem,  
contact a service representative.  
Troubleshooting_ 114  
   
CONDITION  
SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS  
CONDITION  
Curl or wave  
SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS  
Vertical repetitive  
defects  
If marks repeatedly appear on the printed side  
of the page at even intervals:  
Ensure that the paper is loaded properly.  
Check the paper type and quality. Both high  
temperature and humidity can cause paper  
Turn the stack of paper over in the tray. Also  
try rotating the paper 180° in the tray.  
The imaging unit may be damaged. If a  
repetitive mark occurs on the page, run a  
cleaning sheet through several times to  
clean the cartridge; contact a service  
representative. After the printout, if you still  
have the same problems, remove the  
imaging unit and then, install a new one.  
Parts of the machine may have toner on  
them. If the defects occur on the back of  
the page, the problem will likely correct  
itself after a few more pages.  
The fusing assembly may be damaged.  
Contact a service representative.  
Wrinkles or creases  
Ensure that the paper is loaded properly.  
Check the paper type and quality. (See  
Turn the stack of paper over in the tray. Also  
try rotating the paper 180° in the tray.  
Background scatter Background scatter results from bits of toner  
randomly distributed on the printed page.  
The paper may be too damp. Try printing  
with a different batch of paper. Do not open  
packages of paper until necessary so that  
the paper does not absorb too much  
moisture.  
If background scatter occurs on an  
envelope, change the printing layout to  
avoid printing over areas that have  
overlapping seams on the reverse side.  
Printing on seams can cause problems.  
If background scatter covers the entire  
surface area of a printed page, adjust the  
print resolution through your software  
application or in printer properties.  
Back of printouts  
are dirty  
Check for leaking toner. Clean the inside of the  
machine. Contact a service representative.  
A
Solid Color or  
Black pages  
The imaging unit may not be installed  
properly. Remove the cartridge and reinsert  
it.  
The imaging unit may be defective and need  
replacing. Remove the imaging unit and  
Misformed  
characters  
If characters are improperly formed and  
producing hollow images, the paper stock  
may be too slick. Try different paper. (See  
If characters are improperly formed and  
producing a wavy effect, the scanner unit  
may need service. Contact a service  
representative.  
The machine may require repair. Contact a  
service representative.  
Loose toner  
Clean the inside of the machine. Contact a  
service representative.  
Check the paper type and quality. (See  
Remove the imaging unit and then, install a  
If the problem persists, the machine may  
require repair. Contact a service  
representative.  
Page skew  
Ensure that the paper is loaded properly.  
Check the paper type and quality. (See  
Ensure that the paper or other material is  
loaded correctly and the guides are not too  
tight or too loose against the paper stack.  
115 _Troubleshooting  
CONDITION  
SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS  
CONDITION  
SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS  
Character Voids  
Character voids are white areas within parts of  
characters that should be solid black:  
Copy image is  
skewed.  
Ensure that the original is face down on the  
scanner glass or face up in the DADF.  
Check that the copy paper is loaded  
correctly.  
If you are using transparencies, try another  
type of transparency. Because of the  
composition of transparencies, some  
character voids are normal.  
Blank copies print  
out.  
Ensure that the original is face down on the  
scanner glass or face up in the DADF.  
You may be printing on the wrong surface  
of the paper. Remove the paper and turn it  
around.  
The paper may not meet paper  
A
Image rubs off the  
copy easily.  
Replace the paper in the tray with paper  
from a new package.  
In high humidity areas, do not leave paper  
in the machine for extended periods of  
time.  
Horizontal stripes  
If horizontally aligned black streaks or smears  
appear:  
Frequent copy paper  
jams occur.  
Fan the stack of paper, then turn it over in  
the tray. Replace the paper in the tray with  
a fresh supply. Check/adjust the paper  
guides, if necessary.  
The imaging unit may be installed  
improperly. Remove the cartridge and  
reinsert it.  
The imaging unit may be defective.  
Remove the toner cartridge and install a  
If the problem persists, the machine may  
require repair. Contact a service  
representative.  
Ensure that the paper is the proper paper  
weight. 80 g/m2 bond paper is  
recommended.  
Check for copy paper or pieces of copy  
paper remaining in the machine after a  
paper jam has been cleared.  
Toner cartridge  
produces fewer  
copies than expected  
before running out of  
toner.  
Your originals may contain pictures, solids,  
or heavy lines. For example, your originals  
may be forms, newsletters, books, or other  
documents that use more toner.  
The machine may be turned on and off  
frequently.  
Curl  
If the printed paper is curled or paper does not  
feed into the machine:  
Turn the stack of paper over in the tray.  
Also try rotating the paper 180° in the tray.  
Change the printer option and try again. Go  
to printer properties, click Paper tab, and  
set type to Thin Paper. Refer to the  
Software section for details.  
The scanner lid may be left open while  
copies are being made.  
Scanning problems  
An unknown  
image repetitively  
appears on a next  
few sheets or  
loose toner, light  
print, or  
Your printer is probably being used at an  
altitude of 1,000 m (3,281 ft) or above.  
The high altitude may affect the print quality  
such as loose toner or light imaging. You can  
set this option through Paper or Printer tab in  
printer driver’s properties. (See "Altitude  
CONDITION  
SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS  
The scanner does  
not work.  
Make sure that you place the original to be  
scanned face down on the scanner glass, or  
face up in the DADF.  
contamination  
occurs.  
There may not be enough available memory  
to hold the document you want to scan. Try  
the Prescan function to see if that works. Try  
lowering the scan resolution rate.  
Check that the printer cable is connected  
properly.  
Make sure that the printer cable is not  
defective. Switch the cable with a known  
good cable. If necessary, replace the cable.  
Check that the scanner is configured  
correctly. Check scan setting in the  
SmarThru Configuration or the application  
you want to use to make certain that the  
scanner job is being sent to the correct port.  
In case of use of account feature, make sure  
that you have extra scan count remained.  
For example, if you try to scan 10-page  
document while you have 5 scan count left,  
the scan job would be canceled.  
Copying problems  
CONDITION  
SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS  
Copies are too light  
or too dark.  
Use Light and Dark arrows to darken or  
lighten the backgrounds of copies.  
Smears, lines,  
If the defects are on the original, press  
Light and Dark arrows to lighten the  
background of your copies.  
If there are no defects on the original, clean  
marks, or spots  
appears on copies.  
Troubleshooting_ 116  
       
CONDITION  
SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS  
CONDITION  
SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS  
The unit scans very  
slowly.  
Check if the machine is printing received  
data. If so, scan the document after the  
received data has been printed.  
The numbers stored  
in memory do not  
dial correctly.  
Make sure that the numbers are stored in  
memory correctly. Print a Fax Phone Book  
Graphics are scanned more slowly than text.  
Communication speed slows in scan mode  
because of the large amount of memory  
required to analyze and reproduce the  
scanned image. Set your computer to the  
ECP printer mode through BIOS setting. It  
will help to increase the speed. For details  
about how to set BIOS, refer to your  
computer user’s guide.  
The original does not  
feed into the  
machine.  
Make sure that the paper is not wrinkled and  
you are inserting it in correctly. Check that  
the original is the right size, not too thick or  
thin.  
Make sure that the DADF is firmly closed.  
The DADF rubber pad may need to be  
replaced. Contact a service representative.  
Faxes are not  
received  
automatically.  
The receiving mode should be set to Fax.  
Make sure that there is paper in the tray.  
Check to see if the display shows any error  
message. If it does, clear the problem.  
Message appears on  
your computer  
screen:  
There may be a copying or printing job in  
progress. Try your job again when that job is  
finished, try your job again.  
“Device can't be  
set to the H/W  
mode you want.”  
“Port is being used  
by another  
The selected port is currently being used.  
Restart your computer and try again.  
The printer cable may be improperly  
connected or the power may be off.  
The scanner driver is not installed or the  
operating environment is not set up properly.  
Ensure that the machine is properly  
connected and the power is on, then restart  
your computer.  
The machine does  
not send.  
Make sure that the original is loaded in the  
DADF or on the scanner glass.  
Check the fax machine you are sending to,  
to see if it can receive your fax.  
program.”  
“Port is Disabled.”  
“Scanner is busy  
receiving or  
The incoming fax has  
blank spaces or is of  
poor-quality.  
The fax machine sending you the fax may  
be faulty.  
A noisy phone line can cause line errors.  
Check your machine by making a copy.  
The toner cartridge may be empty. Replace  
the toner cartridge. (See "Replacing the  
printing data.  
When the current  
job is completed,  
try again.”  
“Invalid handle.”  
“Scanning has  
failed.”  
The USB cable may be improperly  
connected or the power may be off.  
Some of the words  
on an incoming fax  
are stretched.  
The fax machine sending the fax had a  
temporary document jam.  
Samsung Scan Manager Problem  
There are lines on  
the originals you  
sent.  
Check your scan unit for marks and clean it.  
CONDITION  
SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS  
Samsung Scan  
Manager does not  
work.  
Check your system requirements. Samsung  
Scan Manager works in Window and  
page 26.)  
The machine dials a  
number, but the  
connection with the  
other fax machine  
fails.  
The other fax machine may be turned off, out  
of paper, or cannot answer incoming calls.  
Speak with the other machine operator and  
ask her/him to solve out the problem.  
Fax problems  
Faxes do not store in There may not be enough memory space to  
store the fax. If the display shows the low Fax  
memory is full. Print or remove received fax  
Job message, delete any faxes you no longer  
need from the memory and then try to store the  
fax again. Please call for service.  
memory.  
CONDITION  
SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS  
The machine is not  
working, there is no  
display and the  
buttons are not  
working.  
Unplug the power cord and plug it in again.  
Ensure that there is power being supplied to  
the electrical outlet.  
Blank areas appear  
at the bottom of each  
page or on other  
pages, with a small  
strip of text at the  
top.  
You may have chosen the wrong paper  
settings in the user option setting. For details  
No dial tone sounds.  
Check that the phone line is properly  
connected.  
Check that the phone socket on the wall is  
working by plugging in another phone.  
Common PostScript problems  
The following situations are PS language specific and may occur when  
several printer languages are being used.  
117 _Troubleshooting  
           
Common Windows problems  
To receive a printed or screen-displayed message when PostScript  
errors occur, open the Print Options window and click the desired  
selection next to the PostScript errors section.  
CONDITION  
SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS  
“File in Use”  
message appears  
during installation.  
Exit all software applications. Remove all  
software from the StartUp Group, then restart  
Windows. Reinstall the printer driver.  
POSSIBLE  
CAUSE  
PROBLEM  
SOLUTION  
PostScript file  
cannot be  
printed.  
The PostScript  
Install the PostScript  
driver, referring to  
Software section.  
Print a configuration page  
and verify that the PS  
version is available for  
printing.  
If the problem persists,  
contact a service  
representative.  
“General Protection  
Fault”, “Exception  
OE”, “Spool32”, or  
“Illegal Operation”  
messages appear.  
Close all other applications, reboot Windows  
and try printing again.  
driver may not be  
installed correctly.  
“Fail To Print”, “A  
printer timeout error  
occurred.messages  
appear.  
These messages may appear during printing.  
Just keep waiting until the machine finishes  
printing. If the message appears in standby  
mode or after printing has been completed,  
check the connection and/or whether an error  
has occurred.  
“Limit Check  
Error” message  
appears.  
The print job was  
too complex.  
You might need to reduce the  
complexity of the page or  
install more memory.  
Refer to Microsoft Windows User’s Guide that came with your  
computer for further information on Windows error messages.  
A PostScript  
error page prints.  
The print job may  
not be PostScript.  
Make sure that the print job is  
a PostScript job. Check to  
see whether the software  
application expected a setup  
or PostScript header file to be  
sent to the machine.  
The optional tray The printer driver  
Open the PostScript driver  
properties, select the Device  
Settings tab, and set the Tray  
option of the Installable  
has not been  
configured to  
recognize the  
optional tray.  
is not selected in  
the driver.  
Options section to Installed  
.
The machine  
does not staple  
correctly when  
printing more  
than one copy  
from Acrobat  
Reader with a  
collate option.  
(only in Window/  
Macintosh)  
It might take  
longer to print  
when you print a  
PDF file as an  
image.  
Try to print with the latest  
Adobe Reader program or  
print with turning on "Print as  
Image" option from Acrobat  
printing options. It might take  
longer to print when you print  
a PDF file as an image.  
The machine  
does not staple  
correctly when  
printing more  
than one copy  
with a collate  
option. (only in  
Linux)  
Turning off  
If you want to use the  
collation options  
on applications  
(including CUPS  
pstops collation  
option) may solve  
this problem.  
collation option, go to printer  
driver’s advanced option and  
turn the collation on.  
Troubleshooting_ 118  
     
Common Linux problems  
CONDITION  
SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS  
CONDITION  
SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS  
I cannot scan via  
Gimp Front-end.  
Check if Gimp Front-end has “Xsane: Device  
dialog.” on the “Acquire” menu. If not, you  
should install Xsane plug-in for Gimp on the  
your computer. You can find Xsane plug-in  
package for Gimp on Linux distribution CD or  
Gimp home page. For the detail information,  
refer to the Help for Linux distribution CD or  
Gimp Front-end application.  
The machine does  
not print.  
Check if the printer driver is installed in your  
system. Open Unified Driver configurator  
and switch to the Printers tab in Printers  
configuration window to look at the list of  
available printers. Make sure that your  
machine is displayed on the list. If not, invoke  
Add new printer wizard to set up your device.  
Check if the printer is started. Open Printers  
configuration and select your machine on the  
printers list. Look at the description in the  
Selected printer pane. If its status contains  
“(stopped)” string, press the Start button.  
After that normal operation of the printer  
should be restored. The “stopped” status  
might be activated when some problems in  
printing occurred. For instance, this could be  
an attempt to print document when port is  
claimed by a scanning application.  
Check if the port is not busy. Since functional  
components of MFP (printer and scanner)  
share the same I/O interface (port), the  
situation of simultaneous access of different  
“consumer” application to the same port is  
possible. To avoid possible conflicts, only  
one of them at a time is allowed to gain  
control over the device. The other  
If you wish to use other kind of scan application,  
refer to the Help for application.  
I encounter error  
“Cannot open port  
device file” when  
printing a document.  
Avoid changing print job parameters (via LPR  
GUI, for example) while a print job is in  
progress. Known versions of CUPS server  
break the print job whenever print options are  
changed and then try to restart the job from the  
beginning. Since Unified Linux Driver locks port  
while printing, the abrupt termination of the  
driver keeps the port locked and therefore  
unavailable for subsequent print jobs. If this  
situation occurred, try to release the port.  
The machine does  
not appear on the  
scanners list.  
Check if your machine is attached to your  
computer. Make sure that it is connected  
properly via the USB port and is turned on.  
Check if the scanner driver for your machine  
is installed in your system. Open Unified  
Driver configurator, switch to Scanners  
configuration, then press Drivers. Make sure  
that driver with a name corresponding to  
your machine's name is listed in the window.  
Check if the port is not busy. Since functional  
components of MFP (printer and scanner)  
share the same I/O interface (port), the  
situation of simultaneous access of different  
“consumer” application to the same port is  
possible. To avoid possible conflicts, only  
one of them at a time is allowed to gain  
control over the device. The other  
“consumer” will encounter “device busy”  
response. You should open ports  
configuration and select the port assigned to  
your printer. In the Selected port pane you  
can see if the port is occupied by some other  
application. If this is the case, you should  
wait for completion of the current job or  
should press Release port button, if you are  
sure that the present owner is not functioning  
properly.  
Check if your application has special print  
option such as “-oraw”. If “-oraw” is specified  
in the command line parameter then remove  
it to print properly. For Gimp front-end, select  
“print” -> “Setup printer” and edit command  
line parameter in the command item.  
The CUPS (Common Unix Printing System)  
version distributed with SuSE Linux 9.2  
(cups-1.1.21) has a problem with ipp  
“consumer” will encounter “device busy”  
response. This can usually happen while  
starting scan procedure, and appropriate  
message box appears.  
To identify the source of the problem, you  
should open ports configuration and select the  
port assigned to your scanner. port's symbol /  
dev/mfp0 corresponds to LP:0 designation  
displayed in the scanners’ options, /dev/mfp1  
relates to LP:1 and so on. USB ports start at /  
dev/mfp4, so scanner on USB:0 relates to /dev/  
mfp4 respectively and so forth sequentially. In  
the Selected port pane you can see if the port is  
occupied by some other application. If this is  
the case, you should wait for completion of  
the current job or should press Release port  
button, if you are sure that the present port's  
owner is not functioning properly.  
(Internet Printing Protocol) printing.Use the  
socket printing instead of ipp or install later  
version of CUPS (cups-1.1.22 or higher).  
The machine does  
not print whole pages  
and its output is half  
page printed.  
It is a known problem that occurs when a color  
printer is used on version 8.51 or earlier of  
Ghostscript, 64-bit Linux OS, and reported to  
bugs.ghostscript.com as Ghostscript Bug  
688252.  
The problem is solved in AFPL Ghostscript v.  
8.52 or above. Download the latest version of  
AFPL Ghostscript from http://sourceforge.net/  
projects/ghostscript/ and install it to solve this  
problem.  
119 _Troubleshooting  
   
CONDITION  
SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS  
CONDITION  
SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS  
The machine does  
not scan.  
Check if a document is loaded into the  
machine.  
Check if your machine is connected to the  
computer. Make sure if it is connected properly  
if I/O error is reported while scanning.  
The document has  
printed, but the print job  
has not disappeared  
from the spooler in Mac  
OS 10.3.2.  
Update your Mac OS to OS 10.3.3. or  
higher.  
Check if the port is not busy. Since functional  
components of MFP (printer and scanner)  
share the same I/O interface (port), the  
situation of simultaneous access of different  
“consumer” application to the same port is  
possible. To avoid possible conflicts, only one  
of them at a time is allowed to gain control over  
the device. The other “consumer” will  
encounter “device busy” response. This can  
usually happen while starting scan procedure,  
and appropriate message box will be displayed.  
To identify the source of the problem, you  
should open ports configuration and select the  
port assigned to your scanner. port’s symbol /  
dev/mfp0 corresponds to LP:0 designation  
displayed in the scanners’ options, /dev/mfp1  
relates to LP:1 and so on. USB ports start at /  
dev/mfp4, so scanner on USB:0 relates to /dev/  
mfp4 respectively and so forth sequentially. In  
the Selected port pane you can see if the port is  
occupied by some other application. If this is  
the case, you should wait for completion of the  
current job or should press Release port  
button, if you are sure that the present port’s  
owner is not functioning properly.  
Some letters are not  
displayed normally  
during the Cover page  
printing.  
This problem is caused because Mac OS  
cannot create the font during the Cover  
page printing. English alphabet and  
numbers are displayed normally at the  
Cover page.  
When printing a  
Make sure that the resolution setting in  
your printer driver matches the one in  
Acrobat Reader.  
document in Macintosh  
with Acrobat Reader 6.0  
or higher, colors print  
incorrectly.  
Refer to Mac OS User’s Guide that came with your computer for  
further information on Mac OS error messages.  
Refer to Linux User’s Guide that came with your computer for further  
information on Linux error messages.  
Common Macintosh problems  
CONDITION  
SUGGESTED SOLUTIONS  
The printer does not  
print PDF file correctly.  
Some parts of graphics,  
text, or illustrations are  
missing.  
Incompatibility between the PDF file and  
the Acrobat products:  
Printing the PDF file as an image may  
solve this problem. Turn on Print As  
Image from the Acrobat printing options.  
It will take longer to print when  
you print a PDF file as an image.  
Troubleshooting_ 120  
 
ordering supplies and accessories  
This chapter provides information on purchasing cartridges and accessories available for your machine.  
This chapter includes:  
The optional parts or features may differ by countries. Contact your  
sales representatives whether the part you want is available in your  
country.  
ACCESSORY  
DESCRIPTION  
PART NUMBER  
SCX-S6555A  
Optional tray 2/3/4 If you are experiencing  
paper supply problems  
frequently, you can  
SUPPLIES  
attach an additional 520  
sheet tray. You can  
When the toner cartridge or imaging unit runs out, you can order the  
following type of toner or imaging unit for your machine:  
print documents in  
various sizes and types  
of print materials.  
AVERAGE YIELDA  
TYPE  
PART NUMBER  
SCX-D6555A  
SCX-R6555A  
High capacity  
feeder  
If you are frequently  
experiencing paper  
supply problems, you  
can attach an additional  
2,100 sheet tray.  
SCX-HCF100  
SCX-FAX210a  
Toner cartridgea  
Imaging unitb  
Approx. 25,000  
Approx. 80,000  
Fax option kit  
This kit lets you use  
your machine as a fax  
machine.  
a.Declared yield value in accordance with ISO/IEC 19752.  
b.Declared yield value is based on a single side of A4- or letter-sized  
paper.  
After installing  
the kit, you have  
to set up your  
machine to  
Depending on the options and job mode, the imaging unit’s lifespan  
may differ.  
activate this  
machine. (See  
Page 125)  
When purchasing new print cartridges or other supplies, these must  
be purchased in the same country where the machine was  
purchased. Otherwise, print cartridges or other supplies will be  
incompatible with your machine, as configurations of print cartridges  
and other supplies vary, depending on the specific country.  
Stand  
You can place the  
machine on the  
ergonomically-  
Tall Stand: SCX-  
DSK10T  
Short Stand: SCX-  
designed cabinet which  
lets you reach the  
machine conveniently.  
Also, you can easily  
move the cabinet with  
its wheels, if necessary,  
and store  
miscellaneous items  
like papers into the  
cabinet.  
DSK10S  
If you do not use  
the optional tray  
then Tall Stand is  
recommended. In  
case you add  
three optional  
trays, use Short  
Stand.  
ACCESSORIES  
You can purchase and install accessories to enhance your machine’s  
performance and capacity.  
ACCESSORY  
DESCRIPTION  
PART NUMBER  
ML-MEM160: 256 MB  
Memory module  
Extends your  
machine’s memory  
capacity.  
Stacker & Stapler  
(Finisher)  
500 sheets  
SCX-FIN10S  
This machine  
comes with  
256 MB DIMM.  
To expand the  
memory of your  
machine, you  
must remove the  
existing DIMM  
and purchase a  
larger one.  
Staple Cartridge  
3 x 5,000 staples per  
package, covers  
maximum thickness of  
50 sheets, 1 staple  
position.  
SCX-STP000  
SmarThru  
WorkFlow  
This feature lets you  
send additional  
information along with  
the scanned document  
to a specified network  
location.  
SCX-KIT11S  
121 _Ordering supplies and accessories  
                   
ACCESSORY  
DESCRIPTION  
PART NUMBER  
SCX-KIT20F  
FDI (Foreign  
Device Interface)  
kit  
This card is installed  
inside the machine to  
allow a third party  
device such as a coin  
operated device or a  
card reader. Those  
devices allow the pay-  
for-print service on your  
machine.  
a.Countries which supports the serial telephone system are Germany,  
Italia, France, Sweden, Denmark, Finland, Austria, Switzerland,  
Belgium, Hungary.  
HOW TO PURCHASE  
To order Samsung-authorized supplies or accessories, contact your local  
Samsung dealer or the retailer where you purchased your machine, or visit  
www.samsungprinter.com and select your country/region to obtain  
information on calling for technical support.  
Ordering supplies and accessories_ 122  
   
installing accessories  
Your machine is a full-featured model that has been optimized to meet most of your printing needs. Recognizing that each user  
may have different requirements, however, Samsung makes several accessories available to enhance your machine’s capabilities.  
This chapter includes  
4. Holding the memory module by the edges, align the memory module on  
the slot at about a 30-degree tilt. Make sure that the notches of the  
module and the grooves on the slot fit each other.  
PRECAUTIONS TO TAKE WHEN INSTALLING  
ACCESSORIES  
Disconnect the power cord  
Never remove the control board cover while the power is turned on.  
To avoid the possibility of an electrical shock, always disconnect the  
power cord when installing or removing ANY internal or external  
accessories.  
Discharge static electricity  
The control board and internal accessories (network interface card or  
memory module) are sensitive to static electricity. Before installing or  
removing any internal accessories, discharge static electricity from your  
body by touching something metal, such as the metal back plate on any  
device plugged into a grounded power source. If you walk around before  
finishing the installation, repeat this procedure to discharge any static  
electricity again.  
The notches and grooves illustrated above may not match those  
on an actual DIMM and its slot.  
5. Press the memory module into the slot with care until you hear a “click”.  
INSTALLING A MEMORY DIMM  
Your machine has a dual in-line memory module (DIMM) slot. Use this  
DIMM slot to install additional memory.  
Your machine has 256 MB of memory which can be expanded to 512 MB.  
The order information is provided for optional memory DIMM. (See "Memory  
Installing a memory module  
1. Turn the machine off and unplug all cables from the machine.  
2. Open the control board cover by grasping it and slide toward you.  
Do not press the memory module strongly or the module may be  
damaged. If the module does not seem to fit into the slot properly,  
carefully try the previous procedure again.  
1 control board  
cover  
3. Take out a new memory DIMM from the plastic bag.  
123 _Installing accessories  
             
6. Replace the control board cover.  
1. Open the finisher cover.  
7. Reconnect the power cord and printer cable, and turn the machine on.  
2. Pull the stapler unit out.  
Activating the added memory in the PS printer  
properties  
After installing the memory module, you need to select it in the printer  
properties of the PostScript printer driver in order to use it.  
1. Make sure that the PostScript printer driver is installed on your  
computer. For details about installing the PS printer driver, see Software  
section.  
2. Click the Windows Start menu.  
3. For Windows 2000, select Settings and then Printers.  
For Windows XP/2003, select Printers and Faxes.  
For Windows Vista/2008, select Control Panel > Hardware and Sound  
> Printers.  
For Windows 7, select Control Panel > Hardware and Sound >  
Devices and Printers.  
For Windows Server 2008 R2, select Control Panel > Hardware >  
Devices and Printers.  
3. Lift the empty staple cartridge from the stapler unit.  
4. Select the Samsung SCX-6545 Series PS printer.  
5. Click the right mouse button on the printer icon and select Properties.  
6. Select Device Settings.  
7. Select the amount of memory you installed from Printer Memory in the  
Installable Options section.  
8. Click OK.  
REPLACING THE STAPLER  
When the stapler is completely empty, the message for installing the staple  
cartridge appears on the display screen.  
4. Unpack the new staple cartridge.  
5. Place the staple cartridge back into the stapler unit.  
6. Slide the stapler unit in until it locks in place.  
Installing accessories_ 124  
     
7. Close the finisher cover.  
ENABLING FAX FEATURE AFTER INSTALLING  
THE FAX OPTION KIT  
After installing the Fax kit, you have to set up the machine in order to use  
this function.  
1. Press Machine Setup on the control panel.  
2. Press Admin Setting.  
3. When the login message appears, enter password with number keypad  
4. Press the General tab.  
5. Press Country.  
Change the country, then some the values for fax and paper size will be  
changed automatically for your country.  
125 _Installing accessories  
     
specifications  
This chapter guides you about this machine’s specifications such as various features.  
This chapter includes;  
GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS  
Item  
Description  
Approx. 80,000 pages  
Imaging unit  
yieldc  
Item  
Description  
Up to 100 sheets 75 g/m2 (20 lb bond)  
DADF  
Memory  
256 MB (max. 512 MB)  
DADF document  
size  
Width: 145 to 216 mm  
Length: 145 to 356 mm  
External  
dimension  
(W x D x H)  
641 x 494 x 607 mm (25.2 x 19.4 x 23.9 inches)  
without optional trays  
Tray 1: 500 multi-page for plain paper (80 g/m2)  
Multi-purpose tray: 100 multi-page for plain paper  
(80 g/m2)  
optional tray 2/3/4: 520 multi-page for plain paper  
(80 g/m2)  
Paper input  
capacity  
Weight  
48.2 Kg (including consumables)  
Paper: 5.4 Kg, Plastic: 1.2 Kg  
Package weight  
Duty cycle  
Monthly print volume: Up to 200,000 pages  
optional high capacity feeder: 2,100 multi-page  
for plain paper (80 g/m2)  
a.Sound Pressure Level, ISO 7779  
For details about paper input capacity, see  
b.Average cartridge yield declared in accordance with ISO/IEC 19752.  
The number of pages may be affected by the operating environment,  
printing interval, media type, and media size.  
c. May be affected by operating environment, optional, printing interval,  
media type and media size.  
Face down: 500 sheets 80 g/m2 (20 lb bond)  
Optional stacker: 500 sheets 80 g/m2 (20 lb  
bond)  
Paper output  
capacity  
PRINTER SPECIFICATIONS  
Consumables  
Power rating  
2-piece toner cartridge and imaging unit system  
110 - 127 VAC, or 220 - 240 VAC  
See the Rating label on the machine for the correct  
voltage, frequency (hertz) and type of current for  
your machine.  
Item  
Description  
Laser Beam Printing  
Printing method  
Printing speeda  
Up to 43 ppm in A4 (45 ppm in Letter)  
Up to 38 ppm in A4 (40 ppm in Letter)  
Power  
consumption  
Average operation mode: Less than 750 W  
Power save mode: Less than 30 W  
Stand by mode: Less than 120 W  
Duplex printing  
speed  
Noise levela  
First print out  
time  
8 seconds (from ready)  
Standby mode: Less than 37 dBA  
Printing mode: Less than 55 dBA  
Copying mode: Less than 57 dBA  
Print resolution  
Printer language  
Up to 1,200 x 1,200 dpi Effective output  
PCL 6, PS 3, PDF Direct V1.4, TIFF, JPEG  
Boot-up time  
Less than 25 seconds (from sleep mode)  
The boot-up time will be longer, if data volume is a  
lot in the HDD  
OS compatibilityb  
Interface  
PCL Driver: 2000/XP/2003/2008/Vista/7/Server  
2008 R2  
PS Driver: 2000/XP/2003/2008/Vista/7/Server  
2008 R2, Various Linux OS,  
Mac OS 10.3 ~ 10.6  
Operating  
environment  
Temperature: 10 °C to 32 °C  
Humidity: 20% to 80% RH  
Display  
wVGA (800 x 480 x RGB) color  
Toner cartridge  
yieldb  
Average Cartridge Yield 25,000 standard pages.  
Declared yield value in accordance with ISO/IEC  
19752.  
High Speed USB 2.0  
High Speed USB 2.0 HOST  
Ethernet 10/100/1000 Base TX  
Specifications_ 126  
           
a.Print speed will be affected by operating system used, computing  
performance, application software, connect on method, media type,  
media size, and job complexity.  
b.Please visit www.samsungprinter.com to download the latest software  
version.  
Item  
Description  
Color bit depth  
Internal: 36 bits  
External: 24 bits  
Mono bit depth  
1 bit for Linearity & Halftone  
8 bits (External), 12 bits (Internal) for Gray scale  
COPIER SPECIFICATIONS  
Grayscale  
256 levels  
Item  
Description  
a.Due to the applications for scanning, the maximum resolution might  
differ.  
b.JPEG is not available when you select the mono mode in Color Mode.  
Copy speeda  
Up to 43 cpm in A4 (45 cpm in Letter)  
Duplex copy  
speed  
Simplex to Duplex (1-2): Up to 38 cpm in A4  
(40 cpm in Letter)  
Duplex to Duplex (2-2): Up to 28 cpm in A4  
FACSIMILE SPECIFICATIONS (OPTIONAL)  
(30 cpm in Letter)  
Item  
Description  
ITU-T G3, Super G3  
First copy out  
time  
Scanner glass: Less than 5 seconds  
DADF: Less than 8 seconds  
Compatibility  
Applicable line  
Copy resolution  
Scan:up to 600 x 300 (text, text/photo),  
up to 600 x 600 (photo)  
Print:up to 600 x 600 (text, text/photo),  
up to 600 x 600 (photo)  
Public Switched Telephone Network (PSTN) or  
behind PABX  
Data coding  
MH/MR/MMR/JBIG/JPEG (Tx only)  
33.6 Kbps  
Zoom rate  
Scanner glass: 25 to 400%  
DADF: 25 to 200%  
Modem speed  
Up to 3 seconds/pagea  
Transmission  
speed  
Multiple copies  
1 to 999 pages  
a.Copy speed is based on single document multiple copy.  
Maximum  
document length  
Scanner glass: 356 mm (14 inches)  
Duplex automatic document glass: 356 mm  
(14 inches)  
SCANNER SPECIFICATIONS  
Resolution  
Standard: 203 x 98 dpi (mono), 200 x 200 dpi  
(color)  
Fine: 203 x 196 dpi (mono), 200 x 200 dpi (color)  
Super Fine: 300 x 300 dpi (mono), 200 x 200 dpi  
(color)  
Item  
Description  
Compatibility  
TWAIN standard / WIA standard  
Scanning method DADF and Flat-bed Color CCD (Charge Coupled  
Memory  
Max 2 GB (uses HDD)  
256 levels  
Device) module  
Halftone  
Auto dialer  
Resolutiona  
TWAIN standard: 1,200 x 1,200 dpi (Up to 4,800 x  
4,800 dpi by software enhancement)  
up to 200 numbers  
WIA standard: Up to 600 x 600 dpi  
a.Standard resolution, MMR(JBIG), Maximum modem speed, Phase"C"  
by ITU-T No.1 chart, Memory Tx, ECM.  
Scan to USB, Scan to PC: 100, 200, 300 dpi  
Scan to E-mail, Scan to Server: 100, 200, 300, 400,  
600 dpi  
PDF, TIFF, JPEGb  
Network Scan File  
format  
Effective  
scanning length  
Scanner glass: 348 mm (13.7 inches)  
DADF: 348 mm (13.7 inches)  
Effective  
Max. 208 mm (8.2 inches)  
scanning width  
127 _Specifications  
     
glossary  
DADF  
The following glossary helps you get familiar with the product by  
understanding the terminologies commonly used with printing as well  
as mentioned in this user's guide.  
A Duplex Automatic Document Feeder (DADF) is a mechanism that will  
automatically feed and flip over an original sheet of paper so that the  
machine can scan on both sides of the paper.  
ADF  
Default  
An Automatic Document Feeder (ADF) is a mechanism that will  
automatically feed an original sheet of paper so that the machine can  
scan some amount of the paper at once.  
The value or setting that is in effect when taking a printer out of its box  
state, reset, or initialized.  
DHCP  
AppleTalk  
A Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) is a client-server  
networking protocol. A DHCP server provides configuration parameters  
specific to the DHCP client host requesting, generally, information  
required by the client host to participate on an IP network. DHCP also  
provides a mechanism for allocation of IP addresses to client hosts.  
AppleTalk is a proprietary suite of protocols developed by Apple, Inc for  
computer networking. It was included in the original Macintosh (1984)  
and is now deprecated by Apple in favor of TCP/IP networking.  
BIT Depth  
A computer graphics term describing the number of bits used to  
represent the color of a single pixel in a bitmapped image. Higher color  
depth gives a broader range of distinct colors. As the number of bits  
increases, the number of possible colors becomes impractically large for  
a color map. 1-bit color is commonly called as monochrome or black and  
white.  
DIMM  
Dual Inline Memory Module (DIMM), a small circuit board that holds  
memory. DIMM stores all the data within the machine like printing data,  
received fax data.  
DNS  
BMP  
The Domain Name Server (DNS) is a system that stores information  
associated with domain names in a distributed database on networks,  
such as the Internet.  
A bitmapped graphics format used internally by the Microsoft Windows  
graphics subsystem (GDI), and used commonly as a simple graphics file  
format on that platform.  
Dot Matrix Printer  
BOOTP  
A dot matrix printer refers to a type of computer printer with a print head  
that runs back and forth on the page and prints by impact, striking an  
ink-soaked cloth ribbon against the paper, much like a typewriter.  
Bootstrap Protocol. A network protocol used by a network client to  
obtain its IP address automatically. This is usually done in the bootstrap  
process of computers or operating systems running on them. The  
BOOTP servers assign the IP address from a pool of addresses to each  
client. BOOTP enables 'diskless workstation' computers to obtain an IP  
address prior to loading any advanced operating system.  
DPI  
Dots Per Inch (DPI) is a measurement of resolution that is used for  
scanning and printing. Generally, higher DPI results in a higher  
resolution, more visible detail in the image, and a larger file size.  
CCD  
DRPD  
Charge Coupled Device (CCD) is a hardware which enables the scan  
job. CCD Locking mechanism is also used to hold the CCD module to  
prevent any damage when you move the machine.  
Distinctive Ring Pattern Detection. Distinctive Ring is a telephone  
company service which enables a user to use a single telephone line to  
answer several different telephone numbers.  
Collation  
Duplex  
Collation is a process of printing a multiple-copy job in sets. When  
collation is selected, the device prints an entire set before printing  
additional copies.  
A mechanism that will automatically flip over a sheet of paper so that the  
machine can print (or scan) on both sides of the paper. A printer  
equipped with a Duplex can print double-sided of paper.  
Control Panel  
A control panel is a flat, typically vertical, area where control or  
monitoring instruments are displayed. They are typically found in front of  
the machine.  
Duty Cycle  
Duty cycle is the page quantity which does not affect printer  
performance for a month. Generally the printer has the lifespan limitation  
such as pages per year. The lifespan means the average capacity of  
print-outs, usually within the warranty period. For example, if the duty  
cycle is 48,000 pages per month assuming 20 working days, a printer  
limits 2,400 pages a day.  
Coverage  
It is the printing term used for a toner usage measurement on printing.  
For example, 5% coverage means that an A4 sided paper has about 5%  
image or text on it. So, if the paper or original has complicated images or  
lots of text on it, the coverage will be higher and at the same time, a  
toner usage will be as much as the coverage.  
ECM  
Error Correction Mode (ECM) is an optional transmission mode built into  
Class 1 fax machines or fax modems. It automatically detects and  
corrects errors in the fax transmission process that are sometimes  
caused by telephone line noise.  
CSV  
Comma Separated Values (CSV). A type of file format, CSV is used to  
exchange data between disparate applications. The file format, as it is  
used in Microsoft Excel, has become a pseudo standard throughout the  
industry, even among non-Microsoft platforms.  
Emulation  
Emulation is a technique of one machine obtaining the same results as  
another.  
Glossary_ 128  
 
An emulator duplicates the functions of one system with a different  
system, so that the second system behaves like the first system.  
Emulation focuses on exact reproduction of external behavior, which is  
in contrast to simulation, which concerns an abstract model of the  
system being simulated, often considering its internal state.  
Intranet  
A private network that uses Internet Protocols, network connectivity, and  
possibly the public telecommunication system to securely share part of  
an organization's information or operations with its employees.  
Sometimes the term refers only to the most visible service, the internal  
website.  
Ethernet  
Ethernet is a frame-based computer networking technology for local  
area networks (LANs). It defines wiring and signaling for the physical  
layer, and frame formats and protocols for the media access control  
(MAC)/data link layer of the OSI model. Ethernet is mostly standardized  
as IEEE 802.3. It has become the most widespread LAN technology in  
use during the 1990s to the present.  
IP address  
An Internet Protocol (IP) address is a unique number that devices use in  
order to identify and communicate with each other on a network utilizing  
the Internet Protocol standard.  
IPM  
The Images Per Minute (IPM) is a way of measuring the speed of a  
printer. An IPM rate indicates the number of single-sided sheets a printer  
can complete within one minute.  
EtherTalk  
A suite of protocols developed by Apple Computer for computer  
networking. It was included in the original Macintosh (1984) and is now  
deprecated by Apple in favor of TCP/IP networking.  
IPP  
The Internet Printing Protocol (IPP) defines a standard protocol for  
printing as well as managing print jobs, media size, resolution, and so  
forth. IPP can be used locally or over the Internet to hundreds of  
printers, and also supports access control, authentication, and  
encryption, making it a much more capable and secure printing solution  
than older ones.  
FDI  
Foreign Device Interface (FDI) is a card installed inside the machine to  
allow a third party device such as a coin operated device or a card  
reader. Those devices allow the pay-for-print service on your machine.  
FTP  
A File Transfer Protocol (FTP) is a commonly used protocol for  
exchanging files over any network that supports the TCP/IP protocol  
(such as the Internet or an intranet).  
IPX/SPX  
IPX/SPX stands for Internet Packet Exchange/Sequenced Packet  
Exchange. It is a networking protocol used by the Novell NetWare  
operating systems. IPX and SPX both provide connection services  
similar to TCP/IP, with the IPX protocol having similarities to IP, and  
SPX having similarities to TCP. IPX/SPX was primarily designed for  
local area networks (LANs), and is a very efficient protocol for this  
purpose (typically its performance exceeds that of TCP/IP on a LAN).  
Fuser Unit  
The part of a laser printer that melts the toner onto the print media. It  
consists of a hot roller and a back-up roller. After toner is transferred  
onto the paper, the fuser unit applies heat and pressure to ensure that  
the toner stays on the paper permanently, which is why paper is warm  
when it comes out of a laser printer.  
ISO  
The International Organization for Standardization (ISO) is an  
international standard-setting body composed of representatives from  
national standards bodies. It produces world-wide industrial and  
commercial standards.  
Gateway  
A connection between computer networks, or between a computer  
network and a telephone line. It is very popular, as it is a computer or a  
network that allows access to another computer or network.  
ITU-T  
Grayscale  
The International Telecommunication Union is an international  
organization established to standardize and regulate international radio  
and telecommunications. Its main tasks include standardization,  
allocation of the radio spectrum, and organizing interconnection  
arrangements between different countries to allow international phone  
calls. A -T out of ITU-T indicates telecommunication.  
A shades of gray that represent light and dark portions of an image  
when color images are converted to grayscale; colors are represented  
by various shades of gray.  
Halftone  
An image type that simulates grayscale by varying the number of dots.  
Highly colored areas consist of a large number of dots, while lighter  
areas consist of a smaller number of dots.  
ITU-T No. 1 chart  
Standardized test chart published by ITU-T for document facsimile  
transmissions.  
HDD  
JBIG  
Hard Disk Drive (HDD), commonly referred to as a hard drive or hard  
disk, is a non-volatile storage device which stores digitally-encoded data  
on rapidly rotating platters with magnetic surfaces.  
Joint Bi-level Image Experts Group (JBIG) is an image compression  
standard with no loss of accuracy or quality, which was designed for  
compression of binary images, particularly for faxes, but can also be  
used on other images.  
IEEE  
The Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers (IEEE) is an  
international non-profit, professional organization for the advancement  
of technology related to electricity.  
JPEG  
Joint Photographic Experts Group (JPEG) is a most commonly used  
standard method of lossy compression for photographic images. It is the  
format used for storing and transmitting photographs on the World Wide  
Web.  
IEEE 1284  
The 1284 parallel port standard was developed by the Institute of  
Electrical and Electronics Engineers (IEEE). The term "1284-B" refers to  
a specific connector type on the end of the parallel cable that attaches to  
the peripheral (for example, a printer).  
LDAP  
The Lightweight Directory Access Protocol (LDAP) is a networking  
protocol for querying and modifying directory services running over TCP/  
IP.  
129 _Glossary  
LED  
PABX  
LED  
A private automatic branch exchange (PABX) is an automatic telephone  
switching system within a private enterprise.  
A Light-Emitting Diode (LED) is a semiconductor device that indicates  
the status of a machine.  
PCL  
MAC address  
Printer Command Language (PCL) is a Page Description Language  
(PDL) developed by HP as a printer protocol and has become an  
industry standard. Originally developed for early inkjet printers, PCL has  
been released in varying levels for thermal, matrix printer, and page  
printers.  
Media Access Control (MAC) address is a unique identifier associated  
with a network adapter. MAC address is a unique 48-bit identifier usually  
written as 12 hexadecimal characters grouped in pairs (e. g., 00-00-0c-  
34-11-4e). This address is usually hard-coded into a Network Interface  
Card (NIC) by its manufacturer, and used as an aid for routers trying to  
locate machines on large networks.  
PDF  
Portable Document Format (PDF) is a proprietary file format developed  
by Adobe Systems for representing two dimensional documents in a  
device independent and resolution independent format.  
MFP  
Multi Function Peripheral (MFP) is an office machine that includes the  
following functionality in one physical body, so as to have a printer, a  
copier, a fax, a scanner and etc.  
PostScript  
PostScript (PS) is a page description language and programming  
language used primarily in the electronic and desktop publishing areas. -  
that is run in an interpreter to generate an image.  
MH  
Modified Huffman (MH) is a compression method for decreasing the  
amount of data that needs to be transmitted between the fax machines  
to transfer the image recommended by ITU-T T.4. MH is a codebook-  
based run-length encoding scheme optimized to efficiently compress  
white space. As most faxes consist mostly of white space, this  
minimizes the transmission time of most faxes.  
Printer Driver  
A program used to send commands and transfer data from the computer  
to the printer.  
Print Media  
MMR  
The media like paper, envelopes, labels, and transparencies which can  
be used on a printer, a scanner, a fax or, a copier.  
Modified Modified READ (MMR) is a compression method  
recommended by ITU-T T.6.  
PPM  
Modem  
Pages Per Minute (PPM) is a method of measurement for determining  
how fast a printer works, meaning the number of pages a printer can  
produce in one minute.  
A device that modulates a carrier signal to encode digital information,  
and also demodulates such a carrier signal to decode transmitted  
information.  
PRN file  
MR  
An interface for a device driver, this allows software to interact with the  
device driver using standard input/output system calls, which simplifies  
many tasks.  
Modified Read (MR) is a compression method recommended by ITU-T  
T.4. MR encodes the first scanned line using MH. The next line is  
compared to the first, the differences determined, and then the  
differences are encoded and transmitted.  
Protocol  
A convention or standard that controls or enables the connection,  
communication, and data transfer between two computing endpoints.  
NetWare  
A network operating system developed by Novell, Inc. It initially used  
cooperative multitasking to run various services on a PC, and the  
network protocols were based on the archetypal Xerox XNS stack.  
Today NetWare supports TCP/IP as well as IPX/SPX.  
PS  
See PostScript.  
PSTN  
OPC  
The Public-Switched Telephone Network (PSTN) is the network of the  
world's public circuit-switched telephone networks which, on industrial  
premises, is usually routed through the switchboard.  
Organic Photo Conductor (OPC) is a mechanism that makes a virtual  
image for print using a laser beam emitted from a laser printer, and it is  
usually green or gray colored and a cylinder shaped.  
An exposing unit of a imaging is slowly worn away by its usage of the  
printer, and it should be replaced appropriately since it gets scratches  
from grits of a paper.  
Resolution  
The sharpness of an image, measured in Dots Per Inch (DPI). The  
higher the dpi, the greater the resolution.  
Originals  
SMB  
The first example of something, such as a document, photograph or text,  
etc, which is copied, reproduced or translated to produce others, but  
which is not itself copied or derived from something else.  
Server Message Block (SMB) is a network protocol mainly applied to  
share files, printers, serial ports, and miscellaneous communications  
between nodes on a network. It also provides an authenticated Inter-  
process communication mechanism.  
OSI  
SMTP  
Open Systems Interconnection (OSI) is a model developed by the  
International Organization for Standardization (ISO) for communications.  
OSI offers a standard, modular approach to network design that divides  
the required set of complex functions into manageable, self-contained,  
functional layers. The layers are, from top to bottom, Application,  
Presentation, Session, Transport, Network, Data Link and Physical.  
Simple Mail Transfer Protocol (SMTP) is the standard for e-mail  
transmissions across the Internet. SMTP is a relatively simple, text-  
based protocol, where one or more recipients of a message are  
specified, and then the message text is transferred. It is a client-server  
protocol, where the client transmits an email message to the server.  
Glossary_ 130  
Subnet Mask  
The subnet mask is used in conjunction with the network address to  
determine which part of the address is the network address and which  
part is the host address.  
TCP/IP  
The Transmission Control Protocol (TCP) and the Internet Protocol (IP);  
the set of communications protocols that implement the protocol stack  
on which the Internet and most commercial networks run.  
TCR  
Transmission Confirmation Report (TCR) provides details of each  
transmission such as job status, transmission result and number of  
pages sent. This report can be set to print after each job or only after  
failed transmissions.  
TIFF  
Tagged Image File Format (TIFF) is a variable-resolution bitmapped  
image format. TIFF describes image data that typically come from  
scanners. TIFF images make use of tags, keywords defining the  
characteristics of the image that is included in the file. This flexible and  
platform-independent format can be used for pictures that have been  
made by various image processing applications.  
Toner Cartridge  
A kind of bottle within a machine like printer which contains toner. Toner  
is a powder used in laser printers and photocopiers, which forms the text  
and images on the printed paper. Toner can be melted by the heat of the  
fuser, causing it to bind to the fibers in the paper.  
TWAIN  
An industry standard for scanners and software. By using a TWAIN-  
compliant scanner with a TWAIN-compliant program, a scan can be  
initiated from within the program.; an image capture API for Microsoft  
Windows and Apple Macintosh operating systems.  
UNC Path  
Uniform Naming Convention (UNC) is a standard way to access network  
shares in Window NT and other Microsoft products. The format of a  
UNC path is: \\<servername>\<sharename>\<Additional directory>  
URL  
Uniform Resource Locator (URL) is the global address of documents  
and resources on the Internet. The first part of the address indicates  
what protocol to use, the second part specifies the IP address or the  
domain name where the resource is located.  
USB  
Universal Serial Bus (USB) is a standard that was developed by the  
USB Implementers Forum, Inc., to connect computers and peripherals.  
Unlike the parallel port, USB is designed to concurrently connect a  
single computer USB port to multiple peripherals.  
Watermark  
A watermark is a recognizable image or pattern in paper that appears  
lighter when viewed by transmitted light. Watermarks were first  
introduced in Bologna, Italy in 1282; they have been used by  
papermakers to identify their product, and also on postage stamps,  
currency, and other government documents to discourage  
counterfeiting.  
WIA  
Windows Imaging Architecture (WIA) is an imaging architecture that is  
originally introduced in Windows Me and Windows XP. A scan can be  
initiated from within these operating systems by using a WIA-compliant  
scanner.  
131 _Glossary  
index  
extension telephone 65  
A
D
ADF, load 33  
DADF  
F
adjustment  
input tray 18  
output tray 18  
width guides 18  
fax option kit  
enabling option feature after installing  
the kit 125  
admin setting 83  
darkness  
ordering 121  
altitude adjustment 85  
answering machine/fax 64  
fax receiving  
scanning 58, 75  
changing the receive mode 64  
extension telephone 65  
in answering machine/fax 64  
in memory 65  
authentication  
date & time 29, 84  
network accounting 89  
printing date&time in copied out 84, 86  
default settings 30  
altitude adjustment 85  
secure receiving 65  
fax sending  
auto center 48  
automatic resending 63  
delay sending 63  
duplex sending 62  
sending a fax 62  
changing the default settings 30  
language 84  
loading paper 30  
B
Book copy 47  
machine test 85  
sending a fax manually 63  
sending a priority fax 64  
setting a fax header 62  
measurements 84  
output option 85  
setting a fax header 62  
supplies management 85  
tray management 85  
tray setting 30  
C
checking stored document 94  
fax setup 86  
faxing  
cleaning  
outside 95  
scan unit 95  
transfer unit 95  
color mode 66  
enabling the fax kit option 92, 125  
erasing background 65  
original type 65  
phonebook 66  
printing a fax report 94  
solving faxing problems 117  
driver  
installation 27  
Clone copy 46  
collated 44  
duplex  
scanning 57, 74  
color mode  
faxing 66  
FDI (Foreign Interface Device)  
ordering 122  
E
control panel 18, 19  
copy  
finisher (Stacker & Stapler)  
ordering 121  
email address  
entering email addresses to input field  
Global 54  
Individual 54  
storing 54  
front cover 18  
FTP 56  
erasing background 48  
erasing edge 48  
making a booklet 47  
reduce/enlarge 43  
shifting margin 48  
solving copy problems 116  
energy saver 29  
G
erasing background  
general settings 84  
scanning 58, 75  
Gray scan 58, 74  
the size of the originals 42  
time & date 86  
Group  
erasing punch hole 48  
error correction mode 86  
error message 108  
transparencies 47  
Group fax number 66  
copy setup 86  
132  
 
Mailbox  
creating Mailbox 68  
I
P
paper  
ID copy 45  
deleting the data of the Mailbox 69  
changing the size 37  
imaging unit 18  
loading in the multi-purpose tray 39  
loading in the optional tray 38  
loading in the tray1 38  
Mailbox Passcode 68  
polling 68  
printing a Mailbox 69  
sending to remote Mailbox 69  
storing the originals 68  
imaging unit reorder notification 94  
Individual  
paper feeding problems 111  
email addresses for scanning 54  
individual fax number 66  
paper type  
setting 40  
Maintenance  
J
jam  
imaging unit 97  
maintenance parts 99  
toner cartridge 95, 97  
phonebook  
fax phonebook from SyncThru Web  
clearing paper from the duplex unit area  
memory DIMM  
clearing paper from the exit area 106  
clearing paper from the fuser unit 106  
clearing paper from the multi-purpose  
clearing paper from the optional tray  
clearing paper from the stacker  
clearing paper from the toner cartridge  
installing 123  
polling  
deleting the polling document 67  
polling from remote Mailbox 68  
printing the polling document 67  
storing the originals for polling 67  
memory module  
installing 123  
ordering 121  
message on the display screen 108  
Mono 58, 75  
PostScript  
problems 117  
multi-purpose tray 18  
clearing paper from the tray1 102  
clearing the original from scanner glass  
Power Save 29  
N
network  
Power Saver 20  
tips for avoiding paper jams 100  
using power save mode 29, 84  
setting up 25, 87  
jam, clear  
print quality problems, solve 114  
document 100  
notification  
print/report  
receiving a fax in Mailbox 68  
JPEG 59, 75  
accounting reports 93  
configuration report 93  
network auth. log report 93  
network configuration 93  
N-up copy 46  
K
keyboard 31  
O
OCR 59, 75  
L
On Hook Dial  
PS3 font list 93  
sending a fax 63  
language 29  
Schedule jobs report 93  
supplies information 93  
optional service 91, 92  
optional tray 18, 121  
original size  
LED  
printing  
scanning 57, 74  
Linux problems 119  
problem solving 112  
loading originals  
original type  
problem, solve  
scanning 58, 74  
scanner glass 33  
printing quality 114  
M
originals  
loading 33  
Machine Info 83  
Machine Setup 83  
output options 85  
133  
problems  
scanning  
terminal ID 86  
TIFF 59, 75  
display message 108  
faxing 117  
paper feeder 111  
printing 112  
Windows 118  
darkness 58, 75  
enabling the scan kit option 92  
erasing background 58, 75  
original size 57, 74  
original type 58, 74  
printing an email report 94  
toner cartridge 18  
toner reorder notification 94  
touch screen  
problem solving 111  
tray  
adjusting the width and length 37  
optional tray 18  
scan preset 59  
Q
quality  
sending it via email 52  
sending it via FTP 56  
sending it via SMB 56  
solving scanning problems 116  
USB flash memory 73, 78  
U
USB flash memory  
R
serial number 94  
remote code 86  
scanning 73, 78  
service center registration 84  
service contact numbers 135  
replacing components  
imaging unit 97  
using  
SetIP  
toner cartridge 96  
macintosh 31  
replacing stapler 124  
Report 93  
W
Windows  
shifting margin 48  
side cover 18  
SMB 56  
problems 118  
Resolution  
faxing 65  
sound 85  
S
speed dial no. 66  
Stacker 121  
scan preset 59  
Scan to Email 52  
confirmation 93  
Scan to Server 56  
confirmation 93  
staple cartridge  
ordering 121  
replacing 124  
scanned file format 59, 75  
stored documents 94  
supplies  
scanner glass  
loading documents 33  
browsing the supplies life 83  
checking the supplies life 94  
expected imaging unit life 85, 97  
expected toner cartridge life 85  
management 85  
scanner lid 18  
Scanner lock switch 18  
Supplies Management 85  
SyncThru Web Service  
email address 52  
fax settings 67  
System timeout 29  
T
telephone 64  
134  
contact samsung worldwide  
If you have any comments or questions regarding Samsung products, contact the Samsung customer care center.  
COUNTRY/REG  
ION  
CUSTOMER CARE  
CENTER  
COUNTRY/REG  
ION  
CUSTOMER CARE  
CENTER  
WEB SITE  
WEB SITE  
HUNGARY  
06-80-SAMSUNG  
(726-7864)  
ARGENTINE  
AUSTRALIA  
AUSTRIA  
0800-333-3733  
1300 362 603  
INDIA  
3030 8282  
1800 110011  
1800 3000 8282  
0810-SAMSUNG (7267864, www.samsung.com/at  
€ 0.07/min)  
INDONESIA  
ITALIA  
0800-112-8888  
BELARUS  
BELGIUM  
810-800-500-55-500  
800-SAMSUNG (726-7864) www.samsung.com/it  
02 201 2418  
www.samsung.com/be  
www.samsung.com/be_fr  
JAMAICA  
JAPAN  
1-800-234-7267  
0120-327-527  
8000-7267  
LATVIA  
BRAZIL  
0800-124-421  
4004-0000  
LITHUANIA  
LUXEMBURG  
MALAYSIA  
MEXICO  
8-800-77777  
02 261 03 710  
1800-88-9999  
CANADA  
1-800-SAMSUNG  
(726-7864)  
CHILE  
CHINA  
800-SAMSUNG (726-7864) www.samsung.com/cl  
01-800-SAMSUNG  
(726-7864)  
400-810-5858  
010-6475 1880  
MOLDOVA  
00-800-500-55-500  
COLOMBIA  
01-8000112112  
0-800-507-7267  
NETHERLANDS 0900-SAMSUNG  
(0900-7267864) (€  
COSTA RICA  
CZECH  
REPUBLIC  
800-SAMSUNG  
(800-726786)  
0,10/min)  
NEW ZEALAND  
0800 SAMSUNG (0800 726 www.samsung.com/nz  
786)  
Samsung Zrt., česká organizační složka, Oasis Florenc,  
Sokolovská394/17, 180 00, Praha 8  
NICARAGUA  
NORWAY  
00-1800-5077267  
3-SAMSUNG (7267864)  
800-7267  
DENMARK  
ECUADOR  
EL SALVADOR  
ESTONIA  
8-SAMSUNG (7267864)  
1-800-10-7267  
800-6225  
PANAMA  
PHILIPPINES  
1800-10-SAMSUNG  
(726-7864)  
800-7267  
1-800-3-SAMSUNG  
(726-7864)  
1-800-8-SAMSUNG  
(726-7864)  
02-5805777  
KAZAKHSTAN  
KYRGYZSTAN  
FINLAND  
8-10-800-500-55-500  
00-800-500-55-500  
30-6227 515  
FRANCE  
01 4863 0000  
POLAND  
0 801 1SAMSUNG  
(172678)  
GERMANY  
01805 - SAMSUNG  
(726-7864 € 0,14/min)  
022-607-93-33  
PORTUGAL  
80820-SAMSUNG  
(726-7864)  
GUATEMALA  
HONDURAS  
HONG KONG  
1-800-299-0013  
800-7919267  
3698-4698  
PUERTO RICO  
1-800-682-3180  
REP. DOMINICA 1-800-751-2676  
EIRE 0818 717 100  
135 _Contact SAMSUNG worldwide  
 
COUNTRY/REG  
ION  
CUSTOMER CARE  
CENTER  
WEB SITE  
RUSSIA  
8-800-555-55-55  
SINGAPORE  
1800-SAMSUNG  
(726-7864)  
SLOVAKIA  
0800-SAMSUNG  
(726-7864)  
SOUTH AFRICA 0860 SAMSUNG  
(726-7864)  
SPAIN  
902-1-SAMSUNG(902 172  
678)  
SWEDEN  
0771 726 7864  
(SAMSUNG)  
SWITZERLAND  
0848-SAMSUNG (7267864, www.samsung.com/ch  
CHF 0.08/min)  
TADJIKISTAN  
TAIWAN  
8-10-800-500-55-500  
0800-329-999  
THAILAND  
1800-29-3232  
02-689-3232  
TRINIDAD &  
TOBAGO  
1-800-SAMSUNG  
(726-7864)  
TURKEY  
U.A.E  
444 77 11  
800-SAMSUNG (726-7864) www.samsung.com/ae  
8000-4726  
U.K  
0845 SAMSUNG  
(726-7864)  
U.S.A  
1-800-SAMSUNG  
(7267864)  
UKRAINE  
8-800-502-0000  
UZBEKISTAN  
VENEZUELA  
VIETNAM  
8-10-800-500-55-500  
0-800-100-5303  
1 800 588 889  
Contact SAMSUNG worldwide_ 136  
© 2009 Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. All rights reserved.  
This user’s guide is provided for information purposes only. All information included herein is subject to change without notice.  
Samsung Electronics is not responsible for any direct or indirect damages, arising from or related to use of this user’s guide.  
Samsung and Samsung logo are trademarks of Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd.  
PCL and PCL 6 are trademarks of Hewlett-Packard Company.  
Microsoft, Windows, Windows Vista, Windows 7 and Windows 2008 Server R2 are either registered trademarks or trademarks of Microsoft Corporation.  
PostScript 3 is a trademark of Adobe System, Inc.  
UFST® and MicroType™ are registered trademarks of Monotype Imaging Inc.  
TrueType, LaserWriter and Macintosh are trademarks of Apple Computer, Inc.  
All other brand or product names are trademarks of their respective companies or organizations.  
Refer to the 'LICENSE.txt' file in the provided CD-ROM for the open source license information.  
REV 4.02  
Samsung Printer  
Software section  
Software section  
Contents  
1
2
3
4
Typical Installation  
1
Installing Printer Software in  
Windows  
This is recommended for most users. All components necessary for  
printer operations will be installed.  
1
2
Make sure that the printer is connected to your computer and  
powered on.  
This chapter includes:  
Insert the supplied CD-ROM into your CD-ROM drive.  
The CD-ROM should automatically run, and an installation window  
appears.  
If the installation window does not appear, click Start and then  
Run. Type X:\Setup.exe, replacing “  
represents your drive and click OK  
X” with the letter which  
.
NOTE: The following procedure is based on Windows XP, for other  
operating systems, refer to the corresponding Windows user's guide or  
online help.  
If you use Windows vista, Windows 7 and Windows Server 2008  
R2, click Start  
All programs  
Accessories  
Run, and type  
X:\Setup.exe  
.
If the AutoPlay window appears in Windows vista, Windows 7 and  
Windows Server 2008 R2, click Run Setup.exe in Install or run  
program field, and click Continue in the User Account Control  
window.  
Installing Printer Software  
3
Click Next.  
You can install the printer software for local printing or network printing.  
To install the printer software on the computer, perform the appropriate  
installation procedure depending on the printer in use.  
A printer driver is software that lets your computer communicate with  
your printer. The procedure to install drivers may differ depending on the  
operating system you are using.  
All applications should be closed on your PC before beginning  
installation.  
Installing Software for Local Printing  
A local printer is a printer directly attached to your computer using the  
printer cable supplied with your printer, such as a USB or parallel cable.  
If your printer is attached to a network, skip this step and go to “Installing  
• If necessary, select a language from the drop-down list.  
You can install the printer software using the typical or custom method.  
4
Select Typical installation for a local printer. Click Next.  
NOTE: If the “New Hardware Wizard” window appears during the  
installation procedure, click  
in the upper right corner of the box to  
close the window, or click Cancel  
.
5
Installing Printer Software in Windows  
         
NOTE: After setup is complete, if your printer driver doesn’t work  
properly, reinstall the printer driver. See “Reinstalling Printer Software”  
NOTE: If your printer is not already connected to the computer, the  
following window will appear.  
Custom Installation  
You can choose individual components to install.  
1
2
Make sure that the printer is connected to your computer and  
powered on.  
Insert the supplied CD-ROM into your CD-ROM drive.  
The CD-ROM should automatically run, and an installation window  
appears.  
If the installation window does not appear, click Start and then  
Run. Type X:\Setup.exe, replacing “  
represents your drive and click OK  
X” with the letter which  
.
• After connecting the printer, click Next  
.
If you use Windows vista, Windows 7 and Windows Server 2008  
• If you don’t want to connect the printer at this time, click Next, and No  
on the following screen. Then the installation will start and a test page  
will not be printed at the end of the installation.  
R2, click Start  
All programs  
Accessories  
Run, and type  
X:\Setup.exe  
.
• The installation window that appears in this User’s Guide may  
differ depending on the printer and interface in use.  
If the AutoPlay window appears in Windows vista, Windows 7 and  
Windows Server 2008 R2, click Run Setup.exe in Install or run  
program field, and click Continue in the User Account Control  
window.  
5
After the installation is finished, a window asking you to print a test  
page appears. If you choose to print a test page, select the  
3
Click Next.  
checkbox and click Next  
.
Otherwise, just click Next and skip to step 7.  
6
7
If the test page prints out correctly, click Yes.  
If not, click No to reprint it.  
To register yourself as a user of Samsung Printers in order to  
receive information from Samsung, select the checkbox and click  
Finish. You are now sent to the Samsung web site.  
Otherwise, just click Finish  
.
• If necessary, select a language from the drop-down list.  
6
Installing Printer Software in Windows  
 
4
Select Custom installation. Click Next  
.
• The installation window that appears in this User’s Guide may  
differ depending on the printer and interface in use.  
6
Select the components to be installed and click Next.  
5
Select your printer and click Next.  
NOTE: You can change the desired installation folder by clicking  
Browse].  
[
7
After the installation is finished, a window asking you to print a test  
page appears. If you choose to print a test page, select the  
checkbox and click Next  
.
Otherwise, just click Next and skip to step 9.  
8
9
If the test page prints out correctly, click Yes.  
If not, click No to reprint it.  
To register yourself as a user of Samsung Printers in order to  
receive information from Samsung, select the checkbox and click  
Finish. You are now sent to the Samsung web site.  
NOTE: If your printer is not already connected to the computer, the  
following window will appear.  
Otherwise, just click Finish  
.
• After connecting the printer, click Next  
.
• If you don’t want to connect the printer at this time, click Next, and No  
on the following screen. Then the installation will start and a test page  
will not be printed at the end of the installation.  
7
Installing Printer Software in Windows  
 
4
Select Typical installation for a network printer. Click Next.  
Installing Software for Network Printing  
When you connect your printer to a network, you must first configure the  
TCP/IP settings for the printer. After you have assigned and verified the  
TCP/IP settings, you are ready to install the software on each computer  
on the network.  
You can install the printer software using the typical or custom method.  
Typical Installation  
This is recommended for most users. All components necessary for  
printer operations will be installed.  
1
Make sure that the printer is connected to your network and  
powered on. For details about connecting to the network, see the  
supplied printer’s User’s Guide.  
2
Insert the supplied CD-ROM into your CD-ROM drive.  
5
The list of printers available on the network appears. Select the  
printer you want to install from the list and then click Next  
The CD-ROM should automatically run, and an installation window  
appears.  
.
If the installation window does not appear, click Start and then  
Run. Type X:\Setup.exe, replacing “X” with the letter which  
represents your drive and click OK  
.
If you use Windows vista, Windows 7 and Windows Server 2008  
R2, click Start  
All programs  
Accessories  
Run, and type  
X:\Setup.exe  
.
If the AutoPlay window appears in Windows vista, Windows 7 and  
Windows Server 2008 R2, click Run Setup.exe in Install or run  
program field, and click Continue in the User Account Control  
window.  
3
Click Next.  
•If you do not see your printer on the list, click Update to refresh  
the list, or select Add TCP/IP Port to add your printer to the  
network. To add the printer to the network, enter the port name  
and the IP address for the printer.  
To verify your printer’s IP address or the MAC address, print a  
Network Configuration page.  
To find a shared network printer (UNC Path), select Shared  
Printer [UNC] and enter the shared name manually or find a  
shared printer by clicking the Browse button.  
NOTE: If you cannot find your machine in network, please turn off the  
firewall and click Update  
For Windows operating system, click Start  
windows firewall, and set this option unactivated. For other operating  
system, refer to its on-line guide.  
.
Control Panel and start  
• If necessary, select a language from the drop-down list.  
8
Installing Printer Software in Windows  
 
6
After the installation is finished, a window appears asking you to  
print a test page and to register yourself as a user of Samsung  
Printers in order to receive information from Samsung. If you so  
3
Click Next.  
desire, select the corresponding checkbox(es) and click Finish  
.
Otherwise, just click Finish  
.
• If necessary, select a language from the drop-down list.  
Select Custom installation. Click Next  
4
.
NOTE: After setup is complete, if your printer driver doesn’t work  
properly, reinstall the printer driver. See “Reinstalling Printer Software”  
Custom Installation  
You can choose individual components to install and set a specific IP  
address.  
1
Make sure that the printer is connected to your network and  
powered on. For details about connecting to the network, see the  
supplied printer’s User’s Guide.  
2
Insert the supplied CD-ROM into your CD-ROM drive.  
5
The list of printers available on the network appears. Select the  
printer you want to install from the list and then click Next  
.
The CD-ROM should automatically run, and an installation window  
appears.  
If the installation window does not appear, click Start and then  
Run. Type X:\Setup.exe, replacing “X” with the letter which  
represents your drive and click OK  
.
If you use Windows vista, Windows 7 and Windows Server 2008  
R2, click Start  
All programs  
Accessories  
Run, and type  
X:\Setup.exe  
.
If the AutoPlay window appears in Windows vista, Windows 7 and  
Windows Server 2008 R2, click Run Setup.exe in Install or run  
program field, and click Continue in the User Account Control  
window.  
•If you do not see your printer on the list, click Update to refresh  
the list, or select Add TCP/IP Port to add your printer to the  
network. To add the printer to the network, enter the port name  
and the IP address for the printer.  
9
Installing Printer Software in Windows  
To verify your printer’s IP address or the MAC address, print a  
Network Configuration page.  
NOTE: You can change the desired installation folder by clicking  
Browse].  
[
To find a shared network printer (UNC Path), select Shared  
Printer [UNC] and enter the shared name manually or find a  
shared printer by clicking the Browse button.  
7
Select the components to be installed. After selecting the  
components, the following window appears. You can also change  
the printer name, set the printer to be shared on the network, set  
the printer as the default printer, and change the port name of each  
NOTE: If you cannot find your machine in network, please turn off the  
firewall and click Update  
.
For Windows operating system, click Start  
Control Panel and start  
printer. Click Next  
.
windows firewall, and set this option unactivated. For other operating  
system, refer to its on-line guide.  
TIP: If you want to set a specific IP address on a specific network  
printer, click the Set IP Address button. The Set IP Address window  
appears. Do as follows:  
To install this software on a server, select the Setting up this  
printer on a server checkbox.  
8
After the installation is finished, a window appears asking you to  
print a test page and to register yourself as a user of Samsung  
Printers in order to receive information from Samsung. If you so  
desire, select the corresponding checkbox(es) and click Finish  
.
a. Select a printer to be set with a specific IP address from the list.  
b. Configure an IP address, subnet mask, and gateway for the printer  
manually and click Configure to set the specific IP address for the  
network printer.  
Otherwise, just click Finish  
.
• Click Next  
.
6
Select the components to be installed and click Next.  
NOTE: After setup is complete, if your printer driver doesn’t work  
properly, reinstall the printer driver. See “Reinstalling Printer Software”  
10  
Installing Printer Software in Windows  
NOTE: If your printer is not already connected to the computer, the  
following window will appear.  
Reinstalling Printer Software  
You can reinstall the software if installation fails.  
1
2
Start Windows.  
From the Start menu select Programs or All Programs  
your  
printer driver name  
Select Repair and click Next  
The list of printers available on the network appears. Select the  
Maintenance.  
3
4
.
printer you want to install from the list and then click Next  
.
• After connecting the printer, click Next  
.
• If you don’t want to connect the printer at this time, click Next, and No  
on the following screen. Then the installation will start and a test page  
will not be printed at the end of the installation.  
The reinstallation window that appears in this User’s Guide may  
differ depending on the printer and interface in use.  
5
Select the components you want to reinstall and click Next.  
If you installed the printer software for local printing and you  
select your printer driver name, the window asking you to print a  
test page appears. Do as follows:  
•If you do not see your printer on the list, click Update to refresh  
the list, or select Add TCP/IP Port to add your printer to the  
network. To add the printer to the network, enter the port name  
and the IP address for the printer.  
a. To print a test page, select the check box and click Next  
.
b. If the test page prints out correctly, click Yes  
.
To find a shared network printer (UNC Path), select Shared  
Printer [UNC] and enter the shared name manually or find a  
shared printer by clicking the Browse button.  
If it doesn’t, click No to reprint it.  
6
When the reinstallation is done, click Finish.  
You will see a component list so that you can reinstall any item  
individually.  
11  
Installing Printer Software in Windows  
   
Removing Printer Software  
1
2
Start Windows.  
From the Start menu select Programs or All Programs  
printer driver name  
your  
Maintenance.  
3
Select Remove and click Next  
.
You will see a component list so that you can remove any item  
individually.  
4
5
Select the components you want to remove and then click Next.  
When your computer asks you to confirm your selection, click Yes  
.
The selected driver and all of its components are removed from  
your computer.  
6
After the software is removed, click Finish.  
12  
Installing Printer Software in Windows  
   
1
2
Open the document you want to print.  
Select Print from the File menu. The Print window is displayed. It  
may look slightly different depending on your application.  
2
Basic Printing  
This chapter explains the printing options and common printing tasks in  
Windows.  
The basic print settings are selected within the Print window. These  
settings include the number of copies and print range.  
This chapter includes:  
Make sure that your  
printer is selected.  
3
4
Select your machine from the Select Printer list.  
The basic print settings including the number of copies and print  
range are selected within the Print window.  
Printing a Document  
To take advantage of the printer features provided by your printer  
driver, click Properties or Preferences in the application’s Print  
window. For details, see “Printer Settings” on page 14.  
NOTES  
:
To start the print job, click OK or Print in the Print window.  
Your printer driver Properties window that appears in this User’s  
Guide may differ depending on the printer in use. However the  
composition of the printer properties window is similar.  
NOTE: If you are using Windows Internet Explorer, the AnyWeb Print  
too will save your time for screen-captured images or printing the  
image. Click Start  
AnyWeb Print to link the website where the tool is available for the  
Check the Operating System(s) that are compatible with your  
printer. Please refer to the OS Compatibility section of Printer  
Specifications in your Printer User’s Guide.  
>
All programs  
>
your printer driver name  
>
• If you need to know the exact name of your printer, you can check the  
supplied CD-ROM.  
download.  
• When you select an option in printer properties, you may see an  
exclamationmark  
or  
mark. An exclamation mark means you  
can select that certain option but it is not recommended, and  
mark means you cannot select that option due to the machine’s  
setting or environment.  
The following procedure describes the general steps required for printing  
from various Windows applications. The exact steps for printing a  
document may vary depending on the application program you are  
using. Refer to the User’s Guide of your software application for the  
exact printing procedure.  
13  
Basic Printing  
     
Printing to a file (PRN)  
Printer Settings  
You will sometimes need to save the print data as a file for your purpose.  
To create a file:  
You can use the printer properties window, which allows you to access  
all of the printer options you need when using your printer. When the  
printer properties are displayed, you can review and change the settings  
needed for your print job.  
1
Check the Print to file box at the Print window.  
Your printer properties window may differ, depending on your operating  
system. This Software User’s Guide shows the Properties window for  
Windows XP.  
Your printer driver Properties window that appears in this User’s Guide  
may differ depending on the printer in use.  
If you access printer properties through the Printers folder, you can view  
additional Windows-based tabs (refer to your Windows User’s Guide).  
NOTES  
:
• Most Windows applications will override settings you specify in the  
printer driver. Change all print settings available in the software  
application first, and change any remaining settings using the printer  
driver.  
• The settings you change remain in effect only while you are using the  
current program. To make your changes permanent, make them in  
the Printers folder.  
• The following procedure is for Windows XP. For other Windows OS,  
refer to the corresponding Windows User's Guide or online help.  
2
Select the folder and assign a name of the file and then click OK.  
1. Click the Windows Start button.  
2. Select Printers and Faxes.  
3. Select your printer driver icon.  
4. Right-click on the printer driver icon and select  
Printing Preferences.  
5. Change the settings on each tab, click OK.  
14  
Basic Printing  
       
Poster Printing: This option allows you to print your document  
into a poster-size document. This option prints your document into  
several pages. Paste printed pages together to form one poster-  
Booklet Printing: This option allows you to print your document  
on both sides of the paper to make into a booklet. (See “Printing  
Basic Tab  
Use Basic tab to adjust how the document appear on the printed page.  
Click the Basic tab to display the options shown below.  
Double-Sided Printing  
This option allows you to print on both sides of paper. (See “Printing  
Paper Tab  
Use the Paper tab options to set the basic paper handling specifications  
.
Click the Paper tab to display the options shown below.  
Orientation  
This option allows you to select the direction in which information is  
printed on a page.  
Portrait: This option prints across the width of the page, letter  
style.  
Landscape: This option prints across the length of the page,  
spreadsheet style.  
Rotate 180 Degrees: This option allows you to rotate the page,  
180 degrees.  
Copies  
This option allows you to choose the number of copies to be printed.  
You can select 1 to 999 copies.  
Landscape  
Portrait  
Paper Options  
This option allows you to choose paper tray you want to use.  
Quality  
The available Quality options may vary depending on your  
machine. The higher the setting, the sharper the clarity of printed  
characters and graphics. The higher setting may also increase the  
printing time of a document.  
NOTE: When printing on an envelope, select the Envelope tab to set  
the options.  
Size: This option allows you to set the size of paper to be loaded  
in the tray. This setting appears in the list, so that you can select it.  
Source: Make sure that Source is set to the corresponding paper  
tray. Use MP Tray when printing on special materials, such as  
envelopes and transparencies.  
Type: This option allows you to set the type of paper to be loaded  
in the tray. This setting appears in the list, so that you can select it.  
This will let you get the best quality printout. If not, the desired  
print quality may not be achieved.  
Layout Options  
This option allows you to select various ways to layout your  
document.  
Single Page Per Side: This option is a basic layout option. This  
option allows you to print a page on one side of a paper.  
Multiple Pages Per Side: This option allows you to print several  
pages on one side of a paper. (See “Printing Multiple Pages on  
15  
Basic Printing  
         
- Plain: Normal plain paper. Select this type if your machine is  
Graphics Tab  
2
monochrome and printing on the 60 g./m (16 lb) cotton paper.  
Use the Graphics tab options to adjust the print quality for your specific  
printing needs.  
2
- Thick: 90 to 105 g/m (24 to 28 lb) thick paper.  
2
- Thin: 60 to 70 g/m (16 to 19 lb) thin paper.  
2
Click the Graphics tab to display the options shown below.  
- Cotton: 75 to 90 g/m (20 to 24 lb) cotton paper such as Gilbert  
25 % and Gilbert 100 %.  
2
- Color: 75 to 90 g/m (20 to 24 lb) color-backgrounded paper.  
2
- Preprinted: 75 to 90 g/m (20 to 24 lb) preprinted paper.  
2
- Recycled: 75 to 90 g/m (20 to 24 lb) recycled paper.  
2
- Envelope: 75 to 90 g/m (20 to 24 lb) envelope.  
2
- Transparency: 138 to 146 g/m (37 to 39 lb) transparency  
paper.  
2
- Labels: 120 to 150 g/m (32 to 40 lb) label.  
2
- CardStock: 90 to 163 g/m (24 to 43 lb) cardstock.  
2
- Bond: 105 to 120 g/m (28 to 32 lb) bond.  
2
- Archive: 70 to 90 g/m (19 to 24 lb) If you need to keep the  
print-out for a long period time, such as archives, select this  
option.  
Advanced: This option allows you to print the first page using a  
different paper type from the rest of the document by choosing the  
tray to use for printing the first page. For example, if you want to  
print the first page using color paper, load color paper into the MP  
Tray, and plain paper into Tray 1. Then, select Tray 1. in the  
Source option and MP Tray in this Advanced option.  
Font/Text  
Check All Text Black box to print all the texts in your document in  
solid black, regardless of the color it appears on the screen.  
NOTE If you click Reset, settings in the Advanced option returns to  
the default setting.  
:
Advanced  
Download as Outline: This option allows the driver to download  
any TrueType fonts that are used in your document not stored  
(resident) on your machine. If, after printing a document, you find  
that the fonts did not print correctly, choose Download as Bit  
Image and resubmit your print job. This feature is available only  
when you use the PCL printer driver.  
Download as Bit Image: This option allows the driver to  
download the font data as bitmap images. Documents with  
complicated fonts, such as Korean or Chinese, or various other  
fonts, will print faster in this setting. Download as Bit Image is  
useful when printing from Adobe programs.  
Scaling Options  
This option allows you to automatically or manually scale your print  
job on a page. This option can be grayed out according to the  
Layout Options setting in the Basic tab.  
Fit to Page: This option allows you to scale your print job to any  
selected paper size regardless of the document size. (See “Fitting  
Percentage: This option allows you to change the size of a page’s  
contents to appear larger or smaller on the printed page by typing  
in a percentage you want. (See “Change percentage of your  
Print as Graphics: This option allows the driver to download any  
fonts as graphics. When printing documents with high graphic  
content and relatively few TrueType fonts, printing performance  
(speed) may be enhanced in this setting.  
Use Printer Fonts: When Use Printer Fonts is checked, the  
printer uses the fonts that are stored in its memory (resident fonts)  
to print your document, rather than downloading the fonts used in  
your document. Because downloading fonts takes time, selecting  
this option can speed up your printing time. When using Printer  
fonts, the printer will try to match the fonts used in your document  
to those stored in its memory. If, however, you use fonts in your  
document that are very different from those resident in the printer,  
your printed output will appear very different from what it looks like  
on the screen.  
16  
Basic Printing  
     
Print Even Pages: This option allows you to print only the even  
numbered pages of the document.  
Advanced: This option allows you to set advanced output options  
for printing, such as printing an information page, and saving as a  
form to later use as an overlay.  
NOTE If you click Reset, settings in the Advanced option returns to  
the default setting.  
:
Staple: Do the stapling on the printouts.  
Toner Save  
Request Offset: If you want the printouts to be sorted the same  
way as the original, the machine places printout sets slightly offset  
from one another.  
This option allows you to extend the life of your toner cartridge and  
reduces the cost per page without a significant reduction in print  
quality.  
On: This option to allows the printer to use less toner on each  
page.  
Off: If you do not need to save toner when printing a document,  
NOTE: If you click Reset, settings in the Advanced option returns to  
the default setting.  
select this option.  
Job Settings  
This option allows you to choose how to print or save the printing file  
by using the HDD.  
Print Mode: The default Print Mode is Normal which is for  
printing without saving the printing file in the HDD.  
User ID: This option is used when you need to find a saved file  
using the control panel.  
Advanced Tab  
Use the Advanced tab to set various printing options.  
Click the Advanced tab to display the options shown below.  
Job Name: This option is used when you need to find a saved file  
using the control panel.  
Samsung Tab  
Use the Samsung tab to display the copyright and the version number  
of the driver. If your computer is connected to the Internet, you can have  
access to following services:  
Click the Samsung tab to display the options.  
Help  
This option allows you to open the Help file by searching a keyword.  
Service  
Buy Supplies: This option allows you to order supplies on-line.  
Samsung Website: This option directly connects you to  
Samsung Website.  
Registration: This option allows you to register your machine.  
Check for updates: This option allows you to download updates  
for your printer driver.  
Watermark  
This option allows you to print text over an existing document. (See  
Using a Favorite Setting  
Overlay  
Overlays are often used to take the place of letterhead paper. (See  
The Presets option, which is visible on each preferences tab except for  
Samsung tab, allows you to save the current preferences settings for  
future use.  
Output options  
This options allows you to set the sequence in which the pages will  
print. Select the print order from the drop-down list.  
Normal: This option allows you to print all pages from the first  
page to the last page.  
To save a Presets item:  
1
Change the settings as needed on each tab.  
Reverse All Pages: This option allows you to print all pages from  
the last page to the first page.  
Print Odd Pages: This option allows you to print only the odd  
numbered pages of the document.  
17  
Basic Printing  
                 
2
Enter a name for the item in the Presets input box.  
3
Click Save. When you save Presets, all current driver settings are  
saved.  
To use a saved setting, select it from the Presets drop down list. The  
machine is now set to print according to the setting you selected.  
To delete saved setting, select it from the Presets drop down list and  
click Delete  
.
You can also restore the printer driver’s default settings by selecting  
Printer Default from the Presets drop down list.  
Using Help  
Click  
from the upper-right corner of the window, and then click on any  
option. The help screen gives detailed information about the printing  
features provided by the printer driver.  
18  
Basic Printing  
   
3
Advanced Printing  
This chapter explains printing options and advanced printing tasks.  
Printing Multiple Pages on One Sheet  
of Paper (N-Up Printing)  
You can select the number of pages to print on a single sheet of paper.  
To print more than one page per sheet, the pages will be reduced in size  
and arranged in the order you specify. You can print up to 16 pages on  
one sheet.  
1
3
2
4
NOTE  
:
Your printer driver Properties window that appears in this User’s  
Guide may differ depending on the printer in use. However the  
composition of the printer properties window is similar.  
1
2
3
4
To change the print settings from your software application, access  
• If you need to know the exact name of your printer, you can check the  
supplied CD-ROM.  
From the Basic tab, choose Multiple Pages Per Side in the Type  
drop-down list.  
This chapter includes:  
Select the number of pages you want to print per sheet  
(1, 2, 4, 6, 9, or 16) in the Pages per Side drop-down list.  
Select the page order from the Page Order drop-down list, if  
necessary.  
Check Print Page Border to print a border around each page on  
the sheet.  
5
6
Click the Paper tab, select the Size Source, and Type.  
,
Click OK and print the document.  
19  
Advanced Printing  
         
Printing Posters  
Printing Booklets  
This feature allows you to print a single-page document onto 4, 9, or 16  
sheets of paper, for the purpose of pasting the sheets together to form  
one poster-size document.  
9
9
8
8
1
2
3
To change the print settings from your software application, access  
This printer feature allows you to print your document on both sides of  
the paper and arranges the pages so that the paper can be folded in half  
after printing to produce a booklet.  
Click the Basic tab, select Poster Printing in the Type drop-down  
list.  
Configure the poster option:  
You can select the page layout from Poster<2x2> Poster<3x3>,  
,
NOTE: If you want to make a booklet, you need to print on Letter,  
or Poster<4x4>. If you select Poster<2x2>, the output will be  
Legal, A4, Us Folio, or Oficio sized print media.  
automatically stretched to cover 4 physical pages.  
1
2
3
To change the print settings from your software application, access  
From the Basic tab, choose Booklet Printing from the Type drop-  
down list.  
Click the Paper tab, select the Size Source, and Type.  
,
Specify an overlap in millimeters or inches to make it easier to  
pasting the sheets together.  
NOTE: The Booklet Printing option is not available for all paper sizes.  
In order to find out the available paper size for this feature, select the  
available paper size in the Size option on the Paper tab.  
0.15 inches  
If you select an unavailable paper size, this option can be automatically  
canceled. Select only available paper. (paper without  
mark).  
or  
0.15 inches  
4
5
Click OK and print the document.  
4
5
Click the Paper tab, select the Size, Source, and Type.  
After printing, fold and staple the pages.  
Click OK and print the document. You can complete the poster by  
pasting the sheets together.  
20  
Advanced Printing  
         
Printing on Both Sides of Paper  
Change percentage of your document  
You can print on both sides of a paper; duplex. Before printing, decide  
how you want your document oriented. You can only use this feature with  
Letter, Legal, A4, US Folio, or Oficio sized paper.  
You can change the size of a page’s content to appear larger or smaller  
on the printed page.  
1
To change the print settings from your software application, access  
The options are:  
Printer Setting, if you select this option, this feature is  
determined by the setting you’ve made on the control panel of the  
printer.  
None  
Long Edge, which is the conventional layout used in book  
binding.  
Short Edge, which is the type often used with calendars.  
2
3
From the Paper tab.  
Enter the scaling rate in the Percentage input box.  
You can also click the up/down arrows to select the scaling rate.  
4
5
Select the Size  
,
Source, and Type in Paper Options.  
Click OK and print the document.  
2
2
3
2
5
3
Fitting Your Document to a Selected  
Paper Size  
3
2
5
5
3
5
Long Edge  
Short Edge  
This printer feature allows you to scale your print job to any selected  
paper size regardless of the digital document size. This can be useful  
when you want to check fine details on a small document.  
Reverse Duble-Sided Printing, allows you to select general  
print order compare to duplex print order.  
A
1
To change the print settings from your software application, access  
NOTE: Do not print on both sides of labels, transparencies, envelopes,  
or thick paper. Paper jamming and damage to the printer may result.  
2
3
4
5
From the Paper tab.  
Select the paper size you want from the Fit to page  
Select the Size Source, and Type in Paper Options  
Click OK and print the document.  
.
1
To change the print settings from your software application, access  
,
.
2
3
From the Basic tab, select the paper orientation.  
From the Double-sided Printing section, select the binding option  
you want.  
4
5
Click the Paper tab, select the Size Source, and Type.  
,
Click OK and print the document.  
NOTE: If your printer does not have a duplex unit, you should complete  
the printing job manually. The printer prints every other page of the  
document first. After printing the first side of your job, the Printing Tip  
window appears. Follow the on-screen instructions to complete the  
printing job.  
21  
Advanced Printing  
           
Editing a Watermark  
Using Watermarks  
1
2
3
To change the print settings from your software application, access  
The Watermark option allows you to print text over an existing document.  
For example, you may want to have large gray letters reading “DRAFT”  
or “CONFIDENTIAL” printed diagonally across the first page or all pages  
of a document.  
From the Advanced tab, select Edit from the Watermark drop-  
down list. The Edit Watermarks window appears.  
Select the watermark you want to edit from the Current  
Watermaks list and change the watermark message and options.  
There are several predefined watermarks that come with the printer, and  
they can be modified, or you can add new ones to the list.  
4
5
Click Update to save the changes.  
Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window.  
Using an Existing Watermark  
1
To change the print settings from your software application, access  
Deleting a Watermark  
1
2
3
4
To change the print settings from your software application, access  
2
Click the Advanced tab, and select the desired watermark from the  
Watermark drop-down list. You will see the selected watermark in  
the preview image.  
From the Advanced tab, select Edit from the Watermark drop-  
down list. The Edit Watermarks window appears.  
3
Click OK and start printing.  
Select the watermark you want to delete from the Current  
Watermaks list and click Delete  
.
NOTE: The preview image shows how the page will look when it is  
printed.  
Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window.  
Creating a Watermark  
1
2
3
To change the print settings from your software application, access  
From the Advanced tab, select Edit from the Watermark drop-  
down list. The Edit Watermarks window appears.  
Enter a text message in the Watermark Message box. You can  
enter up to 256 characters. The message displays in the preview  
window.  
When the First Page Only box is checked, the watermark prints on  
the first page only.  
4
Select watermark options.  
You can select the font name, style, size, and shade from the Font  
Attributes section, as well as set the angle of the watermark from  
the Message Angle section.  
5
6
Click Add to add a new watermark to the Current Watermaks list.  
When you have finished editing, click OK or Print until you exit the  
Print window.  
To stop printing the watermark, select None from the Watermark drop-  
down list.  
22  
Advanced Printing  
                 
Using a Page Overlay  
Using Overlays  
After an overlay has been created, it is ready to be printed with your  
document. To print an overlay with a document:  
1
2
Create or open the document you want to print.  
What is an Overlay?  
To change the print settings from your software application, access  
An overlay is text and/or images stored in the computer hard disk drive  
(HDD) as a special file format that can be printed on any document.  
Overlays are often used to take the place of preprinted forms and  
letterhead paper. Rather than using preprinted letterhead, you can  
create an overlay containing the exact same information that is currently  
on your letterhead. To print a letter with your company’s letterhead, you  
do not need to load preprinted letterhead paper in the printer. You need  
only tell the printer to print the letterhead overlay on your document.  
Dear ABC  
3
4
5
Click the Advanced tab.  
Select the desired overlay from the Text drop-down list.  
Regards  
WORLD BEST  
If the overlay file you want does not appear in the Text drop-down  
list, select Edit from the list and click Load. Select the overlay file  
you want to use.  
If you have stored the overlay file you want to use in an external  
source, you can also load the file when you access the Load  
window.  
Creating a New Page Overlay  
After you select the file, click Open. The file appears in the Overlay  
List box and is available for printing. Select the overlay from the  
Overlay List box.  
To use a page overlay, you must create a new page overlay containing  
your logo or image.  
1
Create or open a document containing text or an image for use in a  
new page overlay. Position the items exactly as you wish them to  
appear when printed as an overlay.  
6
7
If necessary, check Confirm Page Overlay When Printing box. If  
this box is checked, a message window appears each time you  
submit a document for printing, asking you to confirm your wish to  
print an overlay on your document.  
WORLD BEST  
2
3
To save the document as an overlay, access printer properties. See  
If this box is not checked and an overlay has been selected, the  
overlay automatically prints with your document.  
From the Advanced tab, select Edit from the Text drop-down list.  
The Edit Overlay window appears.  
Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window.  
4
5
In the Edit Overlay window, click Create.  
The selected overlay prints on your document.  
In the Save As window, type a name of up to eight characters in  
the File name box. Select the destination path, if necessary. (The  
default is C:\Formover.)  
NOTE: The resolution of the overlay document must be the same as  
that of the document you will print with the overlay.  
6
7
Click Save. The name appears on the Overlay List.  
Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window.  
The file is not printed. Instead it is stored on your computer hard  
disk drive.  
Deleting a Page Overlay  
You can delete page overlays that you no longer use.  
NOTE: The overlay document size must be the same as the documents  
1
2
3
4
5
6
In the printer properties window, click the Advanced tab.  
Select Edit in the Overlay drop down list.  
you print with the overlay. Do not create an overlay with a watermark.  
Select the overlay you want to delete from the Overlay List box.  
Click Delete  
.
When a confirming message window appears, click Yes  
.
Click OK or Print until you exit the Print window.  
23  
Advanced Printing  
                 
Layout tab  
4
Using Windows PostScript  
Driver  
The Layout tab provides options to adjust how the document appears  
on the printed page.  
If you want to use the PostScript driver provided with your system CD-  
ROM to print a document.  
PPDs, in combination with the PostScript driver, access printer features  
and allow the computer to communicate with the printer. An installation  
program for the Windows PostScript drivers is provided on the supplied  
software CD-ROM.  
Printer Settings  
You can use the printer properties window, which allows you to access  
all of the printer options you need when using your printer. When the  
printer properties are displayed, you can review and change the settings  
needed for your print job.  
Orientation  
This option allows you to select the direction in which the  
information is printed on a page.  
Your printer properties window may differ, depending on your operating  
system. This Software User’s Guide shows the Properties window for  
Windows XP.  
Portrait: This option prints across the width of the page, letter  
style.  
Landscape: This option prints across the length of the page,  
spreadsheet style.  
Your printer driver Properties window that appears in this User’s Guide  
may differ depending on the printer in use.  
Rotate Landscape: This option allows you to rotate the page, 180  
degrees.  
NOTES  
:
• Most Windows applications will override settings you specify in the  
printer driver. Change all print settings available in the software  
application first, and change any remaining settings using the printer  
driver.  
• The settings you change remain in effect only while you are using the  
current program. To make your changes permanent, make them in  
the Printers folder.  
Print on Both Sides  
You can print on both sides of a sheet of paper. Before printing,  
decide how you want your document oriented.  
None  
Flip on Long Edge: This option is the conventional layout used in  
bookbinding.  
Flip on Short Edge: This option is the type often used with  
calendars.  
• The following procedure is for Windows XP. For other Windows OS,  
refer to the corresponding Windows User's Guide or online help.  
1. Click the Windows Start button.  
2. Select Printers and Faxes.  
3. Select your printer driver icon.  
2
2
4. Right-click on the printer driver icon and select  
3
2
5
3
3
Printing Preferences.  
2
5
5
3
5
5. Change the settings on each tab, click OK.  
Long Edge  
Short Edge  
NOTE Do not print on both sides of labels, transparencies,  
:
envelopes, or thick papers. It may result in paper jam and damage  
to the machine.  
24  
Using Windows PostScript Driver  
             
Pages Per Sheet  
Using Help  
You can select the number of pages to print on a single sheet of  
paper. To print more than one page per sheet, the pages will be  
reduced in size and arranged in the order you specify. You can print  
up to 16 pages on one sheet.  
You can click  
click on any setting.  
from the upper right corner of the window, and then  
Advanced  
You can select Paper Size Graphic, and Document Options.  
,
Paper/Output: This option allows you to select the size of the  
paper loaded in the tray.  
Graphic: This option allows you to adjust the print quality for your  
specific printing needs.  
Document Options: This options allow you to set the PostScript  
options or printer features.  
Paper/Quality tab  
You can select paper tray and media type.  
Paper Source: This option allows you to choose which tray to use.  
Media: This option allows you to choose which media to use.  
25  
Using Windows PostScript Driver  
     
5
Using Direct Printing Utility  
This chapter explains how to use Direct Printing Utility to print PDF files  
without having to open the files.  
Printing  
There are several ways you can print using Direct Printing Utility.  
From the Direct Printing Utility window  
CAUTION  
• HDD should be installed on your machine, to print PDF files using this  
program.  
You cannot print PDF files that are restricted to print. Deactivate the  
printing restriction feature, and retry printing.  
1
From the Start menu select Programs or All Programs  
Samsung Printers Direct Printing Utility Direct Printing  
Utility  
.
Or, double-click the Direct Printing Utility shortcut icon on your desk  
top.  
You cannot print PDF files that are restricted by a password.  
Deactivate the password feature, and retry printing.  
• Whether or not a PDF file can be printed using the Direct Printing  
Utility program depends on how the PDF file was created.  
The Direct Printing Utility window opens.  
2
3
Select the printer you will use in the Select Printer section and click  
• The Direct Printing Utility program supports the PDF version  
1.4 and below. For a higher version, you must open the file to print it.  
Browse  
.
Select the PDF file you will print and click Open  
.
The PDF file is added in the Select Files section.  
4
5
Customize the printer settings for your needs. See the next column.  
Click Print  
.
Overview Direct Printing Utility  
The selected PDF file is sent to the printer.  
Direct Printing Utility is a program that sends a PDF file directly to your  
printer without having to open the file. It sends data through the Windows  
spooler using the port of the printer driver. It only supports PDF format.  
Using the shortcut icon  
To installing this program, you should select Custom installation and  
put a check mark in this program when you install the printer driver.  
1
Select the PDF file you will print and by dragging drop it to the  
Direct Printing Utility shortcut icon on your desk top.  
The selected PDF file is sent to the default printer.  
NOTE  
:
If the default printer does not support Direct Printing Utility,  
the message window alerting you to select the appropriate printer  
opens. Select the appropriate printer in the Select Printer section.  
2
3
Customize the printer settings for your needs.  
Click Print  
The selected PDF file is sent to the printer.  
.
Using the right-click menu  
1
Right-click on the PDF file you will print and select Direct Printing.  
The Direct Printing Utility window opens with the PDF file is added.  
Select the printer you will use.  
2
3
4
Customize the printer settings for your needs. See the below part.  
Click Print  
.
The selected PDF file is sent to the printer.  
26  
Using Direct Printing Utility  
             
6
Sharing the Printer Locally  
You can connect the printer directly to a selected computer, which is  
called “host computer,” on the network.  
Setting Up a Host Computer  
1
2
3
4
5
6
Start Windows.  
From the Start menu select Printers and Faxes  
.
The following procedure is for Windows XP. For other Windows OS, refer  
to the corresponding Windows User's Guide or online help.  
Double-click your printer driver icon  
.
From the Printer menu, select Sharing  
.
NOTES  
:
Check the Share this printer box.  
• Check the Operating System(s) that are compatible with your printer.  
Please refer to the OS Compatibility section of Printer Specifications  
in your Printer User’s Guide.  
Fill in the Shared Name field, and then click OK  
.
• If you need to know the exact name of your printer, you can check the  
supplied CD-ROM.  
Setting Up a Client Computer  
1
2
Right-click the Windows Start button and select Explore  
.
Select My Network Places and then right-click Search for  
Computers  
.
3
Fill in the IP address of host computer in Computer name field,  
and click Search. (In case host computer requires User name and  
Password, fill in User ID and password of host computer account.)  
4
5
6
Double-click Printers and Faxes  
Right-click printer driver icon, select Connect  
Click Yes, if the installation confirm message appears.  
.
.
27  
Sharing the Printer Locally  
     
7
Scanning  
Scanning with your machine lets you turn pictures and text into digital  
files on your computer. Then you can fax or e-mail the files, display them  
on your web site or use them to create projects that you can print using  
Samsung SmarThru software or the WIA driver.  
Scanning Using SmarThru Office  
Samsung SmarThru Office is the accompanying software for your  
machine. You can use SmarThru Office to scan images or documents  
from local or network scanners.  
This chapter includes:  
Starting SmarThru Office  
Follow the steps below to start SmarThru Office  
:
1
2
3
Make sure that your machine and computer are turned on and  
properly connected to each other.  
Once you have installed SmarThru Office, you will see the  
SmarThru Office icon on your desktop.  
NOTES  
:
Check the Operating System(s) that are compatible with your  
printer. Please refer to the OS Compatibility section of Printer  
Specifications in your Printer User’s Guide.  
Double-click the SmarThru Office icon.  
You can check your printer name in the supplied CD-ROM.  
The maximum resolution that can be achieved depends upon  
various factors, including computer speed, available disk space,  
memory, the size of the image being scanned, and bit depth  
settings. Thus, depending on your system and what you are  
scanning, you may not be able to scan at certain resolutions,  
especially using enhanced dpi.  
4
The SmarThru Office appears.  
For more information, click Help  
>
SmarThru Office Help.  
Quick Start Guide  
This menu displays direct buttons for some features. The direct buttons  
include: Categories Binder Life Cycle Scan and OCR Fix and  
,
,
,
,
Enhance, and Samsung Website. You can disable this menu by  
checking “Do not show this diaglog again”.  
Using SmarThru Office  
Scanning  
1
Click Scan icon.  
NOTES  
:
• In Windows XP operating system, you can use SmarThru Office  
launcher, which is on the right end of taskbar, to easily open the Scan  
Setting window.  
In other operating systems beside Windows XP, click the  
SmarThru Office icon in the tray area of the windows taskbar  
28  
Scanning  
           
1
Select File  
An email client opens.  
Type in necessary information and send your email.  
>
Send to  
>
Send By E-mail.  
to activate the SmarThru Office launcher.  
2
3
Fax  
You can send emails while working on SmarThru Office  
.
2
Scan Setting window opens.  
1
2
3
Select File  
Send Fax window opens.  
Type in necessary information and click Send Fax  
>
Send to  
>
Send By Fax.  
.
NOTE: For more information about SmarThru Office, click Help  
>
SmarThru Office Help. The SmarThru Office Help window appears;  
you can view on screen help supplied on the SmarThru program.  
Uninstalling SmarThru Office  
NOTE: Before beginning uninstallation, ensure that all applications are  
closed on your computer.  
Select Scanner: Allows you to select between the Local or  
Network scanner.  
Select Profile: Allows you to save settings frequently used for  
future use. Click New Profile to save the setting.  
1
From the Start menu select Programs or All Programs  
Samsung Printers SmarThru Office Uninstall SmarThru  
Office  
Scan Settings: Allows you to customize settings for Scan Size  
.
and Paper Source  
.
2
3
When your computer asks you to confirm, read the statement and  
click OK  
Scan To: Allows you to customize settings for File Name and  
location to send scanned data.  
.
Click Finish  
.
NOTE: Click Advanced button to set more scan options.  
3
Set scan settings and click Scan  
.
For more information, click Help  
>
SmarThru Office Help.  
Scan To  
FTP  
You can upload files to an FTP server while working on SmarThru  
Office  
.
1
2
3
Select File  
>
Send to  
>
Send By FTP.  
Send By FTP window opens.  
Add your file and click Upload  
.
Email  
You can send email while working on SmarThru Office  
.
NOTE  
:
You need an email client program, such as Outlook Express,  
to send email in SmarThru Office. Procedure for sending email may  
differ depending on email client program you are using.  
29  
Scanning  
 
5
6
Click Next.  
Enter a picture name, and select a file format and destination to  
save the picture.  
Scanning Process with TWAIN-  
enabled Software  
7
Follow the on-screen instructions to edit the picture after it is copied  
to your computer.  
If you want to scan documents using other software, you will need to use  
TWAIN-compliant software, such as Adobe Photoshop. The first time  
you scan with your machine, select it as your TWAIN source in the  
application you use.  
Windows Vista  
1
Load the document(s) face up into the DADF (or ADF).  
The basic scanning process involves a number of steps:  
OR  
1
2
Make sure that your machine and computer are turned on and  
properly connected to each other.  
Place a single document face down on the document glass.  
Load the document(s) face up into the DADF (or ADF).  
OR  
2
3
Click Start  
Scanners and Cameras  
Control Panel  
Hardware and Sound  
.
Click on Scan a document or picture. Then Windows Fax and  
Scan application is opened automatically.  
Place a single document face down on the document glass.  
Open an application, such as Photoshop.  
Open the TWAIN window and set the scan options.  
Scan and save your scanned image.  
3
4
5
NOTE  
:
To view scanners, user can click on View scanners and cameras  
.
• If there is not Scan a document or picture, open the MS paint  
program and click From Scanner or Camera... on File menu.  
NOTE: You need to follow the program’s instructions for acquiring an  
image. Please refer to the user’s guide of the application.  
4
5
Click Scan and then scan driver is opened.  
Choose your scanning preferences and click Preview to see your  
preferences affect the picture.  
6
Click Scan.  
Scanning Using the WIA Driver  
NOTE: If you want to cancel the scan job, press the Cancel button on  
the Scanners and Cameras Wizard.  
Your machine also supports the Windows Image Acquisition (WIA) driver  
for scanning images. WIA is one of the standard components provided  
by Microsoft® Windows® XP and works with digital cameras and  
scanners. Unlike the TWAIN driver, the WIA driver allows you to scan  
and easily manipulate images without using additional software.  
Windows 7  
1
Load the document(s) face up into the DADF (or ADF).  
NOTE: The WIA driver works only on Windows XP/Server 2003/Vista/7  
with USB port.  
OR  
Place a single document face down on the document glass.  
2
3
4
5
Click Start  
Control Panel  
Hardware and Sound  
Devices and Printers  
.
Windows XP/Server 2003  
Click right button of mouse on device driver icon in Printers and  
Faxes Start Scan New Scan application appears.  
1
Load the document(s) face up into the DADF (or ADF).  
.
OR  
Choose your scanning preferences and click Preview to see your  
preferences affect the picture.  
Place a single document face down on the document glass.  
From the Start menu on your desktop window, select Settings  
2
3
4
,
Click Scan  
.
Control Panel, and then Scanners and Cameras  
.
Double click your scanner driver icon. The Scanner and Camera  
Wizard launches.  
Choose your scanning preferences and click Preview to see how  
your preferences affect the picture.  
30  
Scanning  
             
NOTES  
:
8
Using Smart Panel  
• If you have already installed more than one Samsung printer, first  
select the printer model you want in order to use the corresponding  
Smart Panel. Right-click (in Windows or Linux) or click (in Mac OS X)  
Smart Panel is a program that monitors and informs you of the status of  
the printer, and allows you to customize the printer’s settings. If you are  
a Windows or Macintosh OS user, Smart Panel is installed automatically  
download Smart Panel from the Samsung website (www.samsung.com/  
printer) and install.  
the Smart Panel icon and select your printer name  
.
• The Smart Panel window and its contents shown in this Software  
User’s Guide may differ depending on the printer or Operating  
System in use.  
The Smart Panel program displays the current status of the printer, the  
level of toner remaining in the toner cartridge(s) and various other  
information. You can also change settings.  
NOTES  
:
To use this program, you need:  
- Windows. Check for windows operating system(s) compatible with  
your printer, refer to Printer Specifications in your Printer User’s  
Guide.  
- Mac OS X 10.3 or higher  
- Linux. To check for Linux systems that are compatible with your  
printer, refer to Printer Specifications in your Printer User’s Guide.  
- Internet Explorer version 5.0 or higher for flash animation in HTML  
Help.  
1
• If you need to know the exact name of your printer, you can check the  
supplied CD-ROM.  
1
Toner Level  
You can view the level of toner remaining in the toner cartridge(s).  
The printer and the number of toner cartridge(s) shown in the above  
window may differ depending on the printer in use. Any printers do  
not have this feature.  
Understanding Smart Panel  
If an error occurs while printing, Smart Panel appears automatically,  
showing the error.  
Buy Now  
You can also launch Smart Panel manually. Double-click the Smart  
Panel icon on the Windows task bar (in Windows), or Notification Area  
(in Linux). You can also click it on the status bar (in Mac OS X).  
You can order replacement toner cartridge(s) online.  
Troubleshooting Guide  
You can view Help to solve problems.  
Double-click this icon in Windows.  
Driver Setting (Only for Windows)  
You can use the printer properties window, which allows you to access  
all of the printer options you need for using your printer. For details,  
Click this icon in Mac OS X.  
Click this icon in Linux.  
If you are a Windows user, from the Start menu, select Programs or All  
Programs  
your printer driver name  
Smart Panel.  
31  
Using Smart Panel  
     
Opening the Troubleshooting Guide  
Using the troubleshooting guide, you can view solutions for error status  
problems.  
Right-click (in Windows or Linux) or click (in Mac OS X) the Smart Panel  
icon and select Troubleshooting Guide  
.
Changing the Smart Panel Program  
Settings  
Right-click (in Windows or Linux) or click (in Mac OS X) the Smart Panel  
icon and select Options. Select the settings you want from the Options  
window.  
32  
Using Smart Panel  
   
9
Using Your Printer in Linux  
You can use your machine in a Linux environment.  
Installing the Unified Linux Driver  
Installing the Unified Linux Driver  
This chapter includes:  
1
Make sure that you connect your machine to your computer. Turn  
both the computer and the machine on.  
2
When the Administrator Login window appears, type in root in the  
Login field and enter the system password.  
NOTE: You must log in as a super user (root) to install the printer  
software. If you are not a super user, ask your system administrator.  
3
4
From the Samsung website, download and unpack the Unified  
Linux Driver package to your computer.  
Click the  
icon at the bottom of the desktop. When the Terminal  
Getting Started  
screen appears, type in:  
[root@localhost root]#tar zxf [FilePath]/  
UnifiedLinuxDriver.tar.gz[root@localhost root]#cd [FilePath]/cdroot/  
Linux[root@localhost Linux]#./install.sh  
You need to download Linux software package from the Samsung  
Samsung’s Unified Linux Driver package contains printer and scanner  
drivers, providing the ability to print documents and scan images. The  
package also delivers powerful applications for configuring your machine  
and further processing of the scanned documents.  
NOTE: If you do not use the graphical interface and failed to install the  
software, you have to use the driver in the text mode. Follow the steps 3  
to 4, and then follow the instructions on the terminal screen.  
After the driver is installed on your Linux system, the driver package  
allows you to monitor a number of machine devices via fast ECP parallel  
ports and USB simultaneously.  
5
When the welcome screen appears, click Next.  
The acquired documents can then be edited, printed on the same local  
or network machine devices, sent by e-mail, uploaded to an FTP site, or  
transferred to an external OCR system.  
The Unified Linux Driver package is supplied with a smart and flexible  
installation program. You don't need to search for additional components  
that might be necessary for the Unified Linux Driver software: all required  
packages will be carried onto your system and installed automatically;  
this is possible on a wide set of the most popular Linux clones.  
33  
Using Your Printer in Linux  
           
6
When the installation is complete, click Finish.  
Uninstalling the Unified Linux Driver  
1
When the Administrator Login window appears, type in root in the  
Login field and enter the system password.  
NOTE: You must log in as a super user (root) to uninstall the printer  
software. If you are not a super user, ask your system administrator.  
2
Click the  
screen appears, type in:  
icon at the bottom of the desktop. When the Terminal  
[root@localhost root]#cd /opt/Samsung/mfp/uninstall/  
[root@localhost uninstall]#./uninstall.sh  
3
4
Click Uninstall  
Click Next  
.
The installation program has added the Unified Driver Configurator  
desktop icon and Samsung Unified Driver group to the system  
menu for your convenience. If you have any difficulties, consult the  
onscreen help that is available through your system menu or can  
otherwise be called from the driver package windows applications,  
.
such as Unified Driver Configurator or Image Manager  
.
NOTE: Installing the driver in the text mode:  
• If you do not use the graphical interface or have failed the driver  
installation, you have to use the driver in the text mode.  
• Follow the step 1 to 3, then type [root@localhost Linux]# ./install.sh,  
than follow the instruction on the terminal screen. Then the  
installation completes.  
• When you wan to uninstall the driver, follow the installation instruction  
above, but type [root@localhost Linux]# ./uninstall.sh on the terminal  
screen.  
5
Click Finish.  
34  
Using Your Printer in Linux  
   
Printers Configuration  
Using the Unified Driver Configurator  
Printers configuration has the two tabs: Printers and Classes  
.
Unified Linux Driver Configurator is a tool primarily intended for  
configuring Printer or MFP devices. Since an MFP device combines the  
printer and scanner, the Unified Linux Driver Configurator provides  
options logically grouped for printer and scanner functions. There is also  
a special MFP port option responsible for the regulation of access to an  
MFP printer and scanner via a single I/O channel.  
Printers Tab  
You can see the current system’s printer configuration by clicking on the  
printer icon button on the left side of the Unified Driver Configurator  
window.  
Switches to Printer  
configuration.  
After installing the Unified Linux driver, the Unified Linux Driver  
Configurator icon will automatically be created on your desktop.  
Shows all of the  
installed printer.  
Opening the Unified Driver Configurator  
1
Double-click Unified Driver Configurator on the desktop.  
You can also click the Startup Menu icon and select Samsung  
Unified Driver and then Unified Driver Configurator  
.
Shows the status,  
model name and URI of  
your printer.  
2
Press each button on the Modules pane to switch to the  
corresponding configuration window.  
Printers Configuration button  
You can use the following printer control buttons:  
Refresh: renews the available printers list.  
Scanners Configuration button  
Ports Configuration button  
Add Printer: allows you to add a new printer.  
Remove Printer: removes the selected printer.  
Set as Default: sets the current printer as a default printer.  
Stop/Start: stops/starts the printer.  
Test: allows you to print a test page to check if the machine is  
working properly.  
Properties: allows you to view and change the printer properties.  
For details, see page 37.  
You can use the onscreen help by clicking Help  
.
3
After changing the configurations, click Exit to close the Unified  
Driver Configurator.  
35  
Using Your Printer in Linux  
     
Classes Tab  
Ports Configuration  
The Classes tab shows a list of available printer classes.  
In this window, you can view the list of available ports, check the status  
of each port and release a port that is stalled in busy state when its owner  
is terminated for any reason.  
Shows all of the  
printer classes.  
Switches to  
ports  
configuration.  
Shows all of the  
available ports.  
Shows the status of the class  
and the number of printers in  
the class.  
Shows the port type,  
device connected to the  
port and status  
Refresh : Renews the classes list.  
Refresh : Renews the available ports list.  
Add Class... : Allows you to add a new printer class.  
Remove Class : Removes the selected printer class.  
Release port : Releases the selected port.  
Sharing Ports Between Printers and Scanners  
Your machine may be connected to a host computer via the parallel port  
or USB port. Since the MFP device contains more than one device  
(printer and scanner), it is necessary to organize proper access of  
“consumer” applications to these devices via the single I/O port.  
Scanners Configuration  
In this window, you can monitor the activity of scanner devices, view a  
list of installed Samsung MFP devices, change device properties, and  
scan images.  
The Samsung Unified Linux Driver package provides an appropriate port  
sharing mechanism that is used by Samsung printer and scanner  
drivers. The drivers address their devices via so-called MFP ports. The  
current status of any MFP port can be viewed via the Ports  
Configuration. The port sharing prevents you from accessing one  
functional block of the MFP device, while another block is in use.  
Switches to  
Scanners  
configuration.  
Shows all of the  
When you install a new MFP device onto your system, it is strongly  
recommended you do this with the assistance of an Unified Driver  
Configurator. In this case you will be asked to choose I/O port for the new  
device. This choice will provide the most suitable configuration for MFP’s  
functionality. For MFP scanners I/O ports are being chosen by scanner  
drivers automatically, so proper settings are applied by default.  
installed scanners.  
Shows the vendor, model  
name and type of your  
scanner.  
Properties... : Allows you to change the scan properties and scan  
a document. See page 38.  
Drivers... : Allows you to monitor the activity of the scan drivers.  
36  
Using Your Printer in Linux  
   
Configuring Printer Properties  
Printing a Document  
Using the properties window provided by the Printers configuration, you  
can change the various properties for your machine as a printer.  
Printing from Applications  
1
Open the Unified Driver Configurator.  
There are a lot of Linux applications that you are allowed to print from  
using Common UNIX Printing System (CUPS). You can print on your  
machine from any such application.  
If necessary, switch to Printers configuration.  
2
3
Select your machine on the available printers list and click  
Properties  
.
1
From the application you are using, select Print from the File  
menu.  
The Printer Properties window opens.  
2
3
Select Print directly using lpr  
.
In the LPR GUI window, select the model name of your machine  
from the Printer list and click Properties  
.
Click.  
The following five tabs display at the top of the window:  
General: allows you to change the printer location and name.  
The name entered in this tab displays on the printer list in  
Printers configuration.  
Connection: allows you to view or select another port. If you  
change the printer port from USB to parallel or vice versa while in  
use, you must re-configure the printer port in this tab.  
4
Change the printer and print job properties.  
Driver: allows you to view or select another printer driver. By  
clicking Options, you can set the default device options.  
Jobs: shows the list of print jobs. Click Cancel job to cancel the  
selected job and select the Show completed jobs check box to  
see previous jobs on the job list.  
Classes: shows the class that your printer is in. Click Add to  
Class to add your printer to a specific class or click Remove  
from Class to remove the printer from the selected class.  
4
Click OK to apply the changes and close the Printer Properties  
Window.  
The following four tabs display at the top of the window.  
General - allows you to change the paper size, the paper type,  
and the orientation of the documents, enables the duplex feature,  
adds start and end banners, and changes the number of pages  
per sheet.  
37  
Using Your Printer in Linux  
               
Text - allows you to specify the page margins and set the text  
options, such as spacing or columns.  
Scanning a Document  
Graphics - allows you to set image options that are used when  
printing images/files, such as color options, image size, or image  
position.  
You can scan a document using the Unified Driver Configurator window.  
1
2
3
Double-click the Unified Driver Configurator on your desktop.  
Click the button to switch to Scanners Configuration.  
Device: allows you to set the print resolution, paper source, and  
destination.  
5
6
7
Click Apply to apply the changes and close the Properties window.  
Select the scanner on the list.  
Click OK in the LPR GUI window to start printing.  
The Printing window appears, allowing you to monitor the status of  
your print job.  
To abort the current job, click Cancel  
.
Click your  
scanner.  
Printing Files  
You can print many different types of files on the Samsung machine  
device using the standard CUPS way - directly from the command line  
interface. The CUPS lpr utility allows you do that. But the drivers  
package replaces the standard lpr tool by a much more user-friendly  
LPR GUI program.  
To print any document file:  
1
Type lpr <file_name> from the Linux shell command line and  
press Enter. The LPR GUI window appears.  
When you type only lpr and press Enter, the Select file(s) to print  
window appears first. Just select any files you want to print and  
When you have only one MFP device and it is connected to the  
computer and turned on, your scanner appears on the list and is  
automatically selected.  
click Open  
.
2
3
In the LPR GUI window, select your printer from the list, and  
change the printer and print job properties.  
If you have two or more scanners attached to your computer, you  
can select any scanner to work at any time. For example, while  
acquisition is in progress on the first scanner, you may select the  
second scanner, set the device options and start the image  
acquisition simultaneously.  
For details about the properties window, see page 37.  
Click OK to start printing.  
4
5
Click Properties.  
Load the document to be scanned face up into the ADF (Automatic  
Document Feeder) or face down on the document glass.  
6
Click Preview in the Scanner Properties window.  
38  
Using Your Printer in Linux  
       
The document is scanned and the image preview appears in the  
Preview Pane.  
11 Select the file directory where you want to save the image and  
enter the file name.  
12 Click Save.  
Adding Job Type Settings  
You can save your scan option settings to retrieve for a later scanning.  
To save a new Job Type setting:  
1
2
3
4
Change the options from the Scanner Properties window.  
Click Save As  
Enter the name for your setting.  
Click OK  
Your setting is added to the Saved Settings drop-down list.  
To save a Job Type setting for the next scan job:  
.
Drag the pointer to set  
the image area to be  
scanned.  
.
1
2
Select the setting you want to use from the Job Type drop-down  
list.  
7
Change the scan options in the Image Quality and Scan Area  
sections.  
The next time you open the Scanner Properties window, the saved  
setting is automatically selected for the scan job.  
Image Quality: allows you to select the color composition and  
the scan resolution for the image.  
To delete a Job Type setting:  
1
2
Select the setting you want to delete from the Job Type drop-down  
list.  
Scan Area: allows you to select the page size. The Advanced  
button enables you to set the page size manually.  
Click Delete  
.
If you want to use one of the preset scan option settings, select  
from the Job Type drop-down list. For details about the preset Job  
The setting is deleted from the list  
You can restore the default setting for the scan options by clicking  
Using the Image Manager  
Default  
.
The Image Manager application provides you with menu commands and  
tools to edit your scanned image.  
8
9
When you have finished, click Scan to start scanning.  
The status bar appears on the bottom left of the window to show  
you the progress of the scan. To cancel scanning, click Cancel  
.
The scanned image appears in the new Image Manager tab.  
Use these tools to  
edit the image.  
You can use the following tools to edit the image:  
Tools  
Function  
If you want to edit the scanned image, use the toolbar. For further  
details about editing an image, see page 39.  
Saves the image.  
10 When you are finished, click Save on the toolbar.  
39  
Using Your Printer in Linux  
   
Tools  
Function  
Cancels your last action.  
Restores the action you canceled.  
Allows you to scroll through the image.  
Crops the selected image area.  
Zooms the image out.  
Zooms the image in.  
Allows you to scale the image size; you can enter  
the size manually, or set the rate to scale  
proportionally, vertically, or horizontally.  
Allows you to rotate the image; you can select the  
number of degrees from the drop-down list.  
Allows you to flip the image vertically or  
horizontally.  
Allows you to adjust the brightness or contrast of  
the image, or to invert the image.  
Shows the properties of the image.  
For further details about the Image Manager application, refer to the  
onscreen help.  
40  
Using Your Printer in Linux  
10 Using Your Printer with a  
Macintosh  
Installing Software  
The PostScript driver CD-ROM that came with your machine provides  
you with the PPD file to use the PS driver, Apple LaserWriter driver, for  
printing on a Macintosh computer.  
Your machine supports Macintosh systems with a built-in USB interface  
or a 10/100 Base-TX network interface card. When you print a file from  
a Macintosh computer, you can use the PostScript driver by installing the  
PPD file.  
Also, it provides you with the Twain driver for scanning on a Macintosh  
computer.  
Installing the printer software  
NOTE: Some printers do not support a network interface. Make  
sure that your printer supports a network interface by referring to  
Printer Specifications in your Printer User’s Guide.  
1
Connect your machine to the computer using the USB cable or the  
Ethernet cable.  
2
3
Turn on your computer and the machine.  
This chapter includes:  
Insert the supplied software CD-ROM which came with your  
machine into the CD-ROM drive.  
4
Double-click CD-ROM icon that appears on your Macintosh  
desktop.  
5
6
7
8
9
Double-click the MAC_Installer folder.  
Double-click the Installer OS X icon.  
Enter the password and click OK  
The Samsung Installer window opens. Click Continue  
Select Easy Install and click Install Easy Install is recommended  
.
.
.
for most users. All components necessary for machine operations  
will be installed.  
If you select Custom Install, you can choose individual  
components to install.  
10 When the message which warns that all applications will close on  
your computer appears, click Continue  
.
11 After the installation is finished, click Quit.  
NOTE: If you have installed scan driver, click Restart  
.
Uninstalling the printer software  
1
Insert the CD-ROM which came with your printer into the CD-ROM  
drive.  
2
Double-click CD-ROM icon that appears on your Macintosh  
desktop.  
3
4
5
6
7
Double-click the MAC_Installer folder.  
Double-click the Installer OS X icon.  
Enter the password and click OK  
The Samsung Installer window opens. Click Continue  
Select Uninstall and click Uninstall  
.
.
.
41  
Using Your Printer with a Macintosh  
             
8
9
When the message which warns that all applications will close on  
your computer appears, click Continue  
.
Setting Up the Printer  
When the uninstall is done, click Quit  
.
Set up for your printer will be different depending on which cable you use  
to connect the printer to your computer—the network cable or the USB  
cable.  
For a Network-connected  
NOTE Some printers do not support a network interface. Before  
:
connecting your printer, make sure that your printer supports a  
network interface by referring to Printer Specifications in your  
Printer User’s Guide.  
1
2
the PPD file on your computer.  
Open the Applications folder  
• For MAC OS 10.5~10.6, open System Preferences from the  
Applications folder, and click Printer & Fax  
Click Add on the Printer List  
Utilities, and Print Setup Utility.  
.
3
4
.
• For MAC OS 10.5~10.6, press the “+” icon then a display window  
will pop up.  
For Mac OS X 10.3, select the IP Printing tab.  
• For Mac OS X 10.4, click IP Printer  
• For Mac OS X 10.5~10.6, click IP  
Select Socket/HP Jet Direct in Printer Type  
.
.
5
.
When printing a document containing many pages, printing  
performance may be enhanced by choosing Socket for Printer  
Type option.  
6
7
Enter the machine’s IP address in the Printer Address field.  
Enter the queue name in the Queue Name field. If you cannot  
determine the queue name for your machine server, try using the  
default queue first.  
8
For MAC OS 10.3, if Auto Select does not work properly, select  
Samsung in Printer Model and your printer name in Model  
Name  
• For MAC OS 10.4, if Auto Select does not work properly, select  
Samsung in Print Using and your printer name in Model  
.
.
• For MAC OS 10.5~10.6, if Auto Select does not work properly,  
select Select a driver to use... and your printer name in Print  
Using  
.
Your machine appears on the Printer List and is set as the default  
printer.  
9
Click Add.  
42  
Using Your Printer with a Macintosh  
     
For a USB-connected  
1
Follow the instructions on “Installing Software” on page 41 to install  
the PPD file on your computer.  
2
Open the Applications folder  
• For MAC OS 10.5~10.6, open System Preferences from the  
Applications folder, and click Printer & Fax  
Click Add on the Printer List  
Utilities, and Print Setup Utility.  
.
3
4
.
• For MAC OS 10.5~10.6, press the “  
will pop up.  
+” icon then a display window  
For MAC OS 10.3, select the USB tab.  
• For MAC OS 10.4, click Default Browser and find the USB  
connection.  
• For MAC OS 10.5~10.6, click Default and find the USB  
connection.  
5
6
Select your printer name.  
For MAC OS 10.3, if Auto Select does not work properly, select  
Samsung in Printer Model and your printer name in Model  
Name  
• For MAC OS 10.4, if Auto Select does not work properly, select  
Samsung in Print Using and your printer name in Model  
.
.
• For MAC OS 10.5~10.6, if Auto Select does not work properly,  
select Select a driver to use... and your printer name in Print  
Using  
.
Your machine appears on the Printer List and is set as the default  
printer.  
7
Click Add.  
43  
Using Your Printer with a Macintosh  
 
Changing Printer Settings  
Printing  
You can use advanced printing features when using your printer.  
From your Macintosh application, select Print from the File menu. The  
printer name which appears in the printer properties window may differ  
depending on the printer in use. Except for the name, the composition of  
the printer properties window is similar.  
NOTES  
:
• The Macintosh printer’s properties window that appears in this User’s  
Guide may differ depending on the printer in use. However the  
composition of the printer properties window is similar.  
NOTES: The setting options may differ depending on printers and  
Macintosh OS version.  
You can check your printer name in the supplied CD-ROM.  
Layout  
Printing a Document  
The Layout tab provides options to adjust how the document appears  
on the printed page. You can print multiple pages on one sheet of paper.  
Select Layout from the drop-down list under Orientation to access the  
following features.  
When you print with a Macintosh, you need to check the printer software  
setting in each application you use. Follow these steps to print from a  
Macintosh.  
1
2
Open a Macintosh application and select the file you want to print.  
Open the File menu and click Page Setup (Document Setup in  
some applications).  
3
Choose your paper size, orientation, scaling, and other options and  
click OK  
.
Make sure that your  
printer is selected.  
Mac OS 10.5  
Pages per Sheet: This feature determines how many pages  
printed on one page. For details, see “Printing Multiple Pages on  
Layout Direction: You can select the printing direction on a page  
Mac OS 10.5  
as like the examples on UI.  
Border: This option allows you to print a border around each  
page on the sheet.  
4
5
Open the File menu and click Print.  
Two-Sided: This option allows you to print on both sides of a  
Choose the number of copies you want and indicate which pages  
you want to print.  
Reverse Page Orientation: This option allows you to rotate  
6
Click Print when you finish setting the options.  
paper 180 degrees.  
44  
           
Graphics  
Job Accounting  
The Graphics tab provides options for selecting Resolution. Select  
Graphics from the drop-down list under Orientation to access the  
graphic features.  
This feature lets you control and lock all outgoing data, or change the  
password.  
Mac OS 10.5  
Mac OS 10.5  
Resolution: You can select the printing resolution. The higher the  
setting, the sharper the clarity of printed characters and graphics.  
The higher setting also may increase the time it takes to print a  
document.  
Job Setting  
This option allows you to choose how to print or save the printing file  
by using the HDD.  
Paper  
Set Paper Type to correspond to the paper loaded in the tray from which  
you want to print. This will let you get the best quality printout. If you load  
a different type of print material, select the corresponding paper type.  
Mac OS 10.5  
Mac OS 10.5  
Print Mode: The default Print Mode is Normal which is for  
printing without saving the printing file in the optional HDD.  
User ID: This option is used when you need to find a saved file  
using the control panel.  
Job Name: This option is used when you need to find a saved file  
using the control panel.  
45  
Optional Finisher  
Printer Settings  
This option allows you to extend the life of your toner cartridge and  
reduces the cost per page without a significant reduction in print  
quality.  
Mac OS 10.5  
Mac OS 10.5  
Staple: Do the stapling on the printouts.  
Request Offset: If you want the printouts to be sorted the same  
way as the original, the machine places printout sets slightly offset  
from one another.  
Printer Features  
Printer Features tab provides Reverse Duplex Printing and Fit to  
Page options. Select Printer Features from the drop-down list under  
Orientation to access the following features.  
Advanced Options  
Mac OS 10.5  
Reverse Duplex Printing: This option allows you to select  
general print order compared to duplex print order. If this option  
does not appear, your machine does not have this feature.  
Fit to Page: This setting allows you to scale your print job to any  
selected paper size regardless of the digital document size. This  
can be useful when you want to check fine details on a small  
document.  
46  
 
Printing Multiple Pages on One Sheet of  
Paper  
Printing on both sides of paper  
You can print on both sides of the paper. Before printing in the duplex  
mode, decide on which edge you will be binding your finished document.  
The binding options are, as follows:  
You can print more than one page on a single sheet of paper. This  
feature provides a cost-effective way to print draft pages.  
Long-edge binding: This option is the conventional layout used  
in book binding.  
1
2
From your Macintosh application, select Print from the File menu.  
Short-edge binding: This option is the type often used with  
calendars.  
Select Layout from the drop-down list under Orientation. In the  
Pages per Sheet drop-down list, select the number of pages you  
want to print on one sheet of paper.  
1
2
3
4
5
From your Macintosh application, select Print from the File menu.  
Select Layout from the drop-down list under Orientation  
Select a binding orientation from Two-Sided option.  
Select the other options you want to use.  
.
Click Print, and the machine prints on both sides of the paper.  
Mac OS 10.5  
3
4
Select the other options you want to use.  
Click Print, then machine prints the selected number of pages you  
want to print on one sheet of paper.  
Mac OS 10.5  
CAUTION: If you print more than 2 copies, the first copy and the  
second copy might print on same sheet of paper. Avoid printing on both  
sides of paper when you are printing more than 1 copy.  
47  
     
NOTE: Refer to Scan Manager for Change Port.. use. (See "Setting  
scan information in Scan Manager" on page 48.)  
Scanning  
You can scan documents using Image Capture program. Macintosh OS  
offers Image Capture program.  
For Mac OS X 10.5~10.6:  
Make sure that Connected checkbox is checked beside your  
machine in Bonjour Devices  
.
Scanning with USB  
If you want to scan using TWAIN, refer to the Mac OS X10.4 steps  
above.  
1
2
3
Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and  
powered on.  
6
7
Set the scan options on this program.  
Scan and save your scanned image.  
Load originals face up into the document feeder, or place a single  
original face down on the scanner glass.  
Start Applications and click Image Capture  
.
NOTES  
:
• For more information about using Image Capture, refer to the Image  
Capture’s help.  
• Use TWAIN-compliant softwares to apply more scan options.  
You can also scan using TWAIN-compliant software, such as Adobe  
Photoshop.  
NOTE: If No Image Capture device connected message appears,  
disconnect the USB cable and reconnect it. If the problem persists,  
please refer to the Image Capture’s help.  
• If scanning does not operate in Image Capture, update Mac OS to  
the latest version. Image Capture operates properly in Mac OS X  
10.3.9 or higher and Mac OS X 10.4.7 or higher.  
4
5
Set the scan options on this program.  
Scan and save your scanned image.  
NOTES  
:
Setting scan information in Scan Manager  
• For more information about using Image Capture, refer to the Image  
Capture’s help.  
• Use TWAIN-compliant softwares to apply more scan options.  
You can also scan using TWAIN-compliant software, such as Adobe  
Photoshop.  
To find out about Scan Manager program information, to check the  
installed scan driver's condition, to change scan settings. and to add or  
delete the folders where scanned documents to computer are saved in  
Scan Manager program, follow these instructions:  
• If scanning does not operate in Image Capture, update Mac OS to  
the latest version. Image Capture operates properly in Mac OS X  
10.3.9 or higher and Mac OS X 10.4.7 or higher.  
1
2
3
4
From the Smart Panel menu on Status bar, click Scan Manager  
Select the appropriate machine from the Scan Manager  
Press Properties  
Use Set Scan Button to change the file destination or scan  
.
.
.
Scanning with network  
settings, to add or delete application programs, and to format files.  
You can change the scanning machine by using Change port  
.
1
Make sure that the machine is connected to your computer and  
powered on.  
(Local or Network)  
5
When done, press OK.  
2
Load originals face up into the document feeder, or place a single  
original face down on the scanner glass.  
3
4
5
Start Applications and click Image Capture.  
Click Devices and click Browse Devices  
.
For Mac OS X 10.4:  
Select your machine in Twain devices option. Make sure that Use  
TWAIN software checkbox is checked, and click Connect  
.
• If a warning message appears, click Change Port.. to select  
port.  
• If TWAIN UI appears, from the Preference tab, click Change  
Port.. to select port.  
48  
       
Software section  
Index  
installing  
paper type, set  
PostScript driver  
print  
A
L
Linux  
B
Basic properties, set  
N-up  
C
M
canceling  
Macintosh  
scan 30  
driver  
D
printer driver, install  
printer preferences  
printer properties  
printer properties, set  
printer software  
install  
document, print  
duplex printing  
MFP driver, install  
N
n-up printing  
F
O
overlay  
uninstall  
printing  
G
H
printing on both sides of paper  
P
I
paper size, set  
install  
printer driver  
R
paper tray, set  
resolution  
49  

Lexmark 387 User Manual
Mitsubishi Motors Automobile Parts F5m42 User Manual
Panasonic Cs E28jkr User Manual
Precisionaire Pb1900 0604 User Manual
Samsung Avmhh C User Manual
Samsung Multifunction Printer Scx5639fr User Manual 3
Sears Diehard 20071460 User Manual
Sharp Ar C250 User Manual
Sierra 730 User Manual
Toshiba Eo1 33056d User Manual